Language selection

Search

Patent 2604377 Summary

Third-party information liability

Some of the information on this Web page has been provided by external sources. The Government of Canada is not responsible for the accuracy, reliability or currency of the information supplied by external sources. Users wishing to rely upon this information should consult directly with the source of the information. Content provided by external sources is not subject to official languages, privacy and accessibility requirements.

Claims and Abstract availability

Any discrepancies in the text and image of the Claims and Abstract are due to differing posting times. Text of the Claims and Abstract are posted:

  • At the time the application is open to public inspection;
  • At the time of issue of the patent (grant).
(12) Patent Application: (11) CA 2604377
(54) English Title: COMPOSITIONS AND METHODS FOR THE DIAGNOSIS AND TREATMENT OF TUMOR
(54) French Title: COMPOSITIONS ET METHODES DE DIAGNOSTIC ET DE TRAITEMENT DE TUMEUR
Status: Dead
Bibliographic Data
(51) International Patent Classification (IPC):
  • C12N 15/52 (2006.01)
  • C12N 5/10 (2006.01)
  • C12N 9/48 (2006.01)
  • C12N 15/63 (2006.01)
(72) Inventors :
  • DOWD, PATRICK (United States of America)
  • FRANTZ, GRETCHEN (United States of America)
  • POLAKIS, PAUL (United States of America)
  • SMITH, VICTORIA (United States of America)
  • SPENCER, SUSAN (United States of America)
  • WU, THOMAS (United States of America)
  • ZHANG, ZEMIN (United States of America)
(73) Owners :
  • GENENTECH, INC. (United States of America)
(71) Applicants :
  • GENENTECH, INC. (United States of America)
(74) Agent: SMART & BIGGAR
(74) Associate agent:
(45) Issued:
(86) PCT Filing Date: 2006-04-05
(87) Open to Public Inspection: 2006-10-19
Availability of licence: N/A
(25) Language of filing: English

Patent Cooperation Treaty (PCT): Yes
(86) PCT Filing Number: PCT/US2006/013501
(87) International Publication Number: WO2006/110760
(85) National Entry: 2007-10-05

(30) Application Priority Data:
Application No. Country/Territory Date
11/102,501 United States of America 2005-04-08

Abstracts

English Abstract




The present invention is directed to compositions of matter useful for the
diagnosis and treatment of tumor in mammals and to methods of using those
compositions of matter for the same.


French Abstract

La présente invention concerne des compositions utilisées dans le diagnostic et le traitement de tumeur chez des mammaliens, et des méthodes associées d'utilisation de ces compositions.

Claims

Note: Claims are shown in the official language in which they were submitted.




WHAT IS CLAIMED IS:

1. Isolated nucleic acid comprising:
(a) a nucleotide sequence that encodes the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:2;
(b) a nucleotide sequence that encodes the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:2, lacking its
associated signal peptide;
(c) a nucleotide sequence that encodes an extracellular domain of the
polypeptide shown as SEQ ID
NO:2;
(d) the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1;
(e) the full-length coding region of the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1; or
(f) the complement of (a), (b), (c), (d) or (e).


2. An expression vector comprising the nucleic acid of Claim 1.


3. The expression vector of Claim 2, wherein said nucleic acid is operably
linked to control
sequences recognized by a host cell transformed with the vector.


4. A host cell comprising the expression vector of Claim 2.


5. The host cell of Claim 4 which is a CHO cell, an E. coli cell or a yeast
cell.


6. A process for producing a polypeptide comprising culturing the host cell of
Claim 4 under
conditions suitable for expression of said polypeptide and recovering said
polypeptide from the cell culture.

131

Description

Note: Descriptions are shown in the official language in which they were submitted.



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
COMPOSITIONS AND METHODS FOR THE DIAGNOSIS AND TREATMENT OF TUMOR
RELATED APPLICATIONS
This application is a continuation-in-part of and claims priority under 35
U.S.C. 120 to U.S. Patent
Application Serial No. 10/177,488, filed on June 19, 2002, which claims
priority under 35 U.S.C. 119(e) to U.S.
Provisional Patent Application Serial No. 60/299,500, filed on June 20, 2001,
the disclosures of which are herein
incorporated by reference.

FIELD OF THE INVENTION
The present invention is directed to compositions of matter useful for the
diagnosis and treatment of tumor
in mammals and to methods of using those compositions of matter for the same.

BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
Malignant tumors (cancers) are the second leading cause of death in the United
States, after heart disease
(Boring et al., CA Cancel J. Clin. 43:7 (1993)). Cancer is characterized by
the increase in the number of abnormal,
or neoplastic, cells derived from a normal tissue which proliferate to form a
tumor mass, the invasion of adjacent
tissues by these neoplastic tumor cells, and the generation of malignant cells
which eventually spread via the blood
or lymphatic system to regional lymph nodes and to distant sites via a process
called metastasis. In a cancerous
state, a cell proliferates under conditions in which normal cells would not
grow. Cancer manifests itself in a wide
variety of forms, characterized by different degrees of invasiveness and
aggressiveness.
In attempts to discover effective cellular targets for cancer diagnosis and
therapy, researchers have sought
to identify transmembrane or otherwise membrane-associated polypeptides that
are specifically expressed on the
surface of one or more particular type(s) of cancer cell as compared to on one
or more normal non-cancerous
cell(s). Often, such membrane-associated polypeptides are more abundantly
expressed on the surface of the cancer
cells as compared to on the surface of the non-cancerous cells. The
identification of such tumor-associated cell
surface antigen polypeptides has given rise to the ability to specifically
target cancer cells for destruction via
antibody-based therapies. In this regard, it is noted that antibody-based
therapy has proved very effective in the
treatment of certain cancers. For example, HERCEPTIN and RITUXAN (both from
Genentech Inc., South
San Francisco, California) are antibodies that have been used successfully to
treat breast cancer and non-Hodgkin's
lymphoma, respectively. More specifically, HERCEPTINO is a recombinant DNA-
derived humanized monoclonal
antibody that selectively binds to the extracellular domain of the human
epidermal growth factor receptor 2 (HER2)
proto-oncogene. HER2 protein overexpression is observed in 25-30% of primary
breast cancers. RITUXAN@
is a genetically engineered chimeric murine/human monoclonal antibody directed
against the CD20 antigen found
on the surface of normal and malignant B lymphocytes. B oth these antibodies
are recombinantly produced in CHO
cells.

1


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
In other attempts to discover effective cellular targets for cancer diagnosis
and therapy, researchers have
sought to identify (1) non-membrane-associated polypeptides that are
specifically produced by one or more
particular type(s) of cancer cell(s) as compared to by one or more particular
type(s) of non-cancerous normal
cell(s), (2) polypeptides that are produced by cancer cells at an expression
level that is significantly higher than
that of one or more normal non-cancerous cell(s), or (3) polypeptides whose
expression is specifically limited to
only a single (or very limited number of different) tissue type(s) in both the
cancerous and non-cancerous state
(e.g., normal prostate and prostate tumor tissue). Such polypeptides may
remain intracellularly located or may be
secreted by the cancer cell. Moreover, such polypeptides may be expressed not
by the cancer cell itself, but rather
by cells which produce and/or secrete polypeptides having a potentiating or
growth-enhancing effect on cancer
cells. Such secreted polypeptides are often proteins that provide cancer cells
with a growth advantage over normal
cells and include such things as, for example, angiogenic factors, cellular
adhesion factors, growth factors, and the
like. Identification of antagonists of such non-membrane associated
polypeptides would be expected to serve as
effective therapeutic agents for the treatment of such cancers. Furthermore,
identification of the expression pattern
of such polypeptides would be useful for the diagnosis of particular cancers
in mammals.
Despite the above identified advances in mammalian cancer therapy, there is a
great need for additional
diagnostic and therapeutic agents capable of detecting the presence of tumor
in a mammal and for effectively
inhibiting neoplastic'cell growth, respectively. Accordingly, it is an
objective of the present invention to identify:
(1) cell membrane-associated polypeptides that are more abundantly expressed
on one or more type(s) of cancer
cell(s) as compared to on normal cells or on other different cancer cells, (2)
non-membrane-associated polypeptides
that are specifically produced by one or more particular type(s) of cancer
cell(s) (or by other cells that produce
polypeptides having a potentiating effect on the growth of cancer cells) as
compared to by one or more particular
type(s) of non-cancerous normal cell(s), (3) non-membrane-associated
polypeptides that are produced by cancer
cells at an expression level that is significantly higher than that of one or
more normal non-cancerous cell(s), or
(4) polypeptides whose expression is specifically limited to only a single (or
very limited number of different)
tissue type(s) in both a cancerous and non-cancerous state (e.g., normal
prostate and prostate tumor tissue), and
to use those polypeptides, and their encoding nucleic acids, to produce
compositions of matter useful in the
therapeutic treatment and diagnostic detection of cancer in mammals. It is
also an objective of the present
invention to identify cell membrane-associated, secreted or intracellular
polypeptides whose expression is limited
to a single or very limited number of tissues, and to use those polypeptides,
and their encoding nucleic acids, to
produce compositions of matter useful in the therapeutic treatment and
diagnostic detection of cancer in mammals.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
A. Embodiments
In the present specification, Applicants describe for the first time the
identification of various cellular
polypeptides (and their encoding nucleic acids or fragments thereof) which are
expressed to a greater degree on
the surface of or by one or more types of cancer cell(s) as compared to on the
surface of or by one or more types
of normal non-cancer cells. Alternatively, such polypeptides are expressed by
cells which produce and/or secrete
polypeptides having a potentiating or growth-enhancing effect on cancer cells.
Again alternatively, such
polypeptides may not be overexpressed by tumor cells as compared to normal
cells of the same tissue type, but
2


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
rather may be specifically expressed by both tumor cells and normal cells of
only a single or very limited number
of tissue types (preferably tissues which are not essential for life, e.g.,
prostate, etc.). All of the above polypeptides
are herein referred to as Tumor-associated Antigenic Target polypeptides
("TAT" polypeptides) and are expected
to serve as effective targets for cancer therapy and diagnosis in mammals.
Accordingly, in one embodiment of the present invention, the invention
provides an isolated nucleic acid
molecule having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a tumor-associated
antigenic target polypeptide or fragment
thereof (a "TAT" polypeptide).
In certain aspects, the isolated nucleic acid molecule comprises a nucleotide
sequence having at least
about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81%,
82%, 83%, 84%, 85%, 86%, 87%,
88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100% nucleic
acid sequence identity, to
(a) a DNA molecule encoding a full-length TAT polypeptide having an amino acid
sequence as disclosed herein,
a TAT polypeptide amino acid sequence lacking the signal peptide as disclosed
herein, an extracellular domain
of a transmembrane TAT polypeptide, with or without the signal peptide, as
disclosed herein or any other
specifically defined fragment of a full-length TAT polypeptide amino acid
sequence as disclosed herein, or (b) the
complement of the DNA molecule of (a).
In other aspects, the isolated nucleic acid molecule comprises a nucleotide
sequence having at least about
80% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81%, 82%,
83%, 84%, 85%, 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%,
90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100% nucleic acid sequence
identity, to (a) a DNA
molecule comprising the coding sequence of a full-length TAT polypeptide eDNA
as disclosed herein, the coding
sequence of a TAT polypeptide lacking the signal peptide as disclosed herein,
the coding sequence of an
extracellular domain of a transmembrane TAT polypeptide, with or without the
signal peptide, as disclosed herein
or the coding sequence of any other specifically defined fragment of the full-
length TAT polypeptide amino acid
'sequence as disclosed herein, or (b) the complement of the DNA molecule of
(a).
In further aspects, the invention concerns an isolated nucleic acid molecule
comprising a nucleotide
sequence having at least about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity,
alternatively at least about 81%, 82%, 83%,
84%, 85%, 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99%
or 100% nucleic acid
sequence identity, to (a) a DNA molecule that encodes the same mature
polypeptide encoded by the full-length
coding region of any of the human protein cDNAs deposited with the ATCC as
disclosed herein, or (b) the
complement of the DNA molecule of (a).
Another aspect of the invention provides an isolated nucleic acid molecule
comprising a nucleotide
sequence encoding a TAT polypeptide which is either transmembrane domain-
deleted or transmembrane domain-
inactivated, or is complementary to such encoding nucleotide sequence, wherein
the transmembrane domain(s) of
such polypeptide(s) are disclosed herein. Therefore, soluble extracellular
domains of the herein described TAT
polypeptides are contemplated.
In other aspects, the present invention is directed to isolated nucleic acid
molecules which hybridize to
(a) a nucleotide sequence encoding a TAT polypeptide having a full-length
amino acid sequence as disclosed
herein, a TAT polypeptide amino acid sequence lacking the signal peptide as
disclosed herein, an extracellular
domain of a transmembrane TAT polypeptide, with or without the signal peptide,
as disclosed herein or any other
specifically defined fragment of a full-length TAT polypeptide amino acid
sequence as disclosed herein, or (b) the
3


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
complement of the nucleotide sequence of (a). In this regard, an embodiment of
the present invention is directed
to fragments of a full-length TAT polypeptide coding sequence, or the
complement thereof, as disclosed herein,
that may find use as, for example, hybridization probes useful as, for
example, diagnostic probes, PCR primers,
antisense oligonucleotide probes, or for encoding fragments of a full-length
TAT polypeptide that may optionally
encode a polypeptide comprising abinding site for an anti-TAT polypeptide
antibody, a TAT binding oligopeptide
or other small organic molecule that binds to a TAT polypeptide. Such nucleic
acid fragments are usually at least
about 5 nucleotides in length, alternatively at least about 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21,
22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, 65, 70, 75, 80,
85, 90, 95, 100, 105, 110, 115, 120, 125,
130,135, 140,145,150,155, 160,165, 170,175, 180,185,190,195,200, 210, 220,
230, 240, 250, 260, 270, 280,
290, 300, 310, 320, 330, 340, 350, 360, 370, 380, 390, 400, 410, 420, 430,
440, 450, 460, 470, 480, 490, 500, 510,
520, 530, 540, 550, 560, 570, 580, 590, 600, 610, 620, 630, 640, 650, 660,
670, 680, 690, 700, 710, 720, 730, 740,
750, 760, 770, 780, 790, 800, 810, 820, 830, 840, 850, 860, 870, 880, 890,
900, 910, 920, 930, 940, 950, 960, 970,
980, 990, or 1000 nucleotides in length, wherein in this context the term
"about" means the referenced nucleotide
sequence length plus or minus 10% of that referenced length. Moreover, such
nucleic acid fragments are usually
comprised of consecutive nucleotides derived from the full-length coding
sequence of a TAT polypeptide or the
complement thereof. It is noted that novel fragments of a TAT polypeptide-
encoding nucleotide sequence, or the
complement thereof, may be determined in a routine manner by aligning the TAT
polypeptide-encoding nucleotide
sequence with other known nucleotide sequences using any of a number of well
known sequence alignment
programs and determining which TAT polypeptide-encoding nucleotide sequence
fragment(s), or the complement
thereof, are novel. All of such novel fragments of TAT polypeptide-encoding
nucleotide sequences, or the
complement thereof, are contemplated herein. Also contemplated are the TAT
polypeptide fragments encoded
by these nucleotide molecule fragments, preferably those TAT polypeptide
fragments that comprise a binding site
for an anti-TAT antibody, a TAT binding oligopeptide or other small organic
molecule that binds to a TAT
polypeptide.
In another embodiment, the invention provides isolated TAT polypeptides
encoded by any of the isolated
nucleic acid sequences hereinabove identified.
In a certain aspect, the invention concerns an isolated TAT polypeptide,
comprising an amino acid
sequence having at least about 80% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively
at least about 81%, 82%, 83%,
84%, 85%, 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99%
or 100% amino acid
sequence identity, to a TAT polypeptide having a full-length amino acid
sequence as disclosed herein, a TAT
polypeptide amino acid sequence lacking the signal peptide as disclosed
herein, an extracellular domain of a
transmembrane TAT polypeptide protein, with or without the signal peptide, as
disclosed herein, an amino acid
sequence encoded by any of the nucleic acid sequences disclosed herein or any
other specifically defined fragment
of a full-length TAT polypeptide amino acid sequence as disclosed herein.
In a further aspect, the invention concerns an isolated TAT polypeptide
comprising an amino acid
sequence having at least about 80% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively
at least about 81%, 82%, 83%,
84%, 85%, 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or
99% amino acid
sequence identity, to an amino acid sequence encoded by any of the human
protein cDNAs deposited with the
ATCC as disclosed herein.

4


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
In a yet further aspect, the invention concerns an isolated TAT polypeptide
comprising an amino acid
sequence that is encoded by a nucleotide sequence that hybridizes to the
complement of a DNA molecule encoding
(a) a TAT polypeptide having a full-length amino acid sequence as disclosed
herein, (b) a TAT polypeptide amino
acid sequence lacking the signal peptide as disclosed herein, (c) an
extracellular domain of a transmembrane TAT
polypeptide protein, with or without the signal peptide, as disclosed herein,
(d) an amino acid sequence encoded
by any of the nucleic acid sequences disclosed herein or (e) any other
specifically defined fragment of a full-length
TAT polypeptide aniino acid sequence as disclosed lierein.
In a specific aspect, the invention provides an isolated TAT polypeptide
without the N-terminal signal
sequence and/or without the initiating methionine and is encoded by a
nucleotide sequence that encodes such an
amino acid sequence as hereinbefore described. Processes for producing the
same are also herein described,
wherein those processes comprise culturirig a host cell comprising a vector
which comprises the appropriate
encoding nucleic acid molecule under conditions suitable for expression of the
TAT polypeptide and recovering
the TAT polypeptide from the cell culture.
Another aspect of the invention provides an isolated TAT polypeptide which is
either transmembrane
domain-deleted or transmembrane domain-inactivated. Processes for producing
the same are also herein described,
wherein those processes comprise culturing a host cell comprising a vector
which comprises the appropriate
encoding nucleic acid molecule under conditions suitable for expression of the
TAT polypeptide and recovering
the TAT polypeptide from the cell culture.
In other embodiments of the present invention, the invention provides vectors
comprising DNA encoding
any of the herein described polypeptides. Host cells comprising any such
vector are also provided. By way of
example, the host cells may be CHO cells, E. coli cells, or yeast cells. A
process for producing any of the herein
described polypeptides is further provided and comprises culturing host cells
under conditions suitable for
expression of the desired polypeptide and recovering the desired polypeptide
from the cell culture.
In other embodiments, the invention provides isolated chimeric polypeptides
comprising any of the herein
described TATpolypeptides fused to a heterologous (non-TAT) polypeptide.
Example of such chimeric molecules
comprise any of the herein described TAT polypeptides fused to a heterologous
polypeptide such as, for example,
an epitope tag sequence or a Fc region of an immunoglobulin.
In another embodiment, the invention provides an antibody which binds,
preferably specifically, to any
of the above or below described polypeptides. Optionally, the antibody is a
monoclonal antibody, antibody
fragment, chimeric antibody, humanized antibody, single-chain antibody or
antibody that competitively inhibits
the binding of an anti-TAT polypeptide antibody to its respective antigenic
epitope. Antibodies of the present
invention may optionally be conjugated to a growth inhibitory agent or
cytotoxic agent such as a toxin, including,
for example, a maytansinoid or calicheamicin, an antibiotic, a radioactive
isotope, a nucleolytic enzyme, or the like.
The antibodies of the present invention may optionally be produced in CHO
cells or bacterial cells and preferably
inhibit the growth or proliferation of or induce the death of a cell to which
they bind. For diagnostic purposes, the
antibodies of the present invention may be detectably labeled, attached to a
solid support, or the like.
In other embodiments of the present invention, the invention provides vectors
comprising DNA encoding
any of the herein described antibodies. Host cell comprising any such vector
are also provided. By way of
example, the host cells may be CHO cells, E. coli cells, or yeast cells. A
process for producing any of the herein
5


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
described antibodies is further provided and comprises culturing host cells
under conditions suitable for expression
of the desired antibody and recovering the desired antibody from the cell
culture.
In another embodiment, the invention provides oligopeptides ("TAT binding
oligopeptides") which bind,
preferably specifically, to any of the above or below described TAT
polypeptides. Optionally, the TAT binding
oligopeptides of the present invention may be conjugated to a growth
inhibitory agent or cytotoxic agent such as
a toxin, including, for example, a maytansinoid or calicheamicin, an
antibiotic, a radioactive isotope, a nucleolytic
enzyme, or the like. The TAT binding oligopeptides of the present invention
may optionally be produced in CHO
cells or bacterial cells and preferably inhibit the growth or proliferation of
or induce the death of a cell to which
they bind. For diagnostic purposes, the TAT binding oligopeptides of the
present invention may be detectably
labeled, attached to a solid support, or the like.
In other embodiments of the present invention, the invention provides vectors
comprising DNA encoding
any of the herein described TAT binding oligopeptides. Host cell comprising
any such vector are also provided.
By way of example, the host cells may be CHO cells, E. coli cells, or yeast
cells. A process for producing any of
the herein described TAT binding oligopeptides is further provided and
comprises culturing host cells under
conditions suitable for expression of the desired oligopeptide and recovering
the desired oligopeptide from the cell
culture.
In another embodiment, the invention provides small organic molecules ("TAT
binding organic
molecules") which bind, preferably specifically, to any of the above or below
described TAT polypeptides.
Optionally, the TAT binding organic molecules of the present invention may be
conjugated to a growth inhibitory
agent or cytotoxic agent such as a toxin, including, for example, a
maytansinoid or calicheamicin, an antibiotic,
a radioactive isotope, a nucleolytic enzyme, or the like. The TAT binding
organic molecules of the present
invention preferably inhibit the growth or proliferation of or induce the
death of a cell to which they bind. For
diagnostic purposes, the TAT binding organic molecules of the present
invention may be detectably labeled,
attached to a solid support, or the like.
In a still further embodiment, the invention concerns a composition of matter
comprising a TAT
polypeptide as described herein, a chimeric TAT polypeptide as described
herein, an anti-TAT antibody as
described herein, a TAT binding oligopeptide as described herein, or a TAT
binding organic molecule as described
herein, in combination with a carrier. Optionally, the carrier is a
pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
In yet another embodiment, the invention concerns an article of manufacture
comprising a container and
a composition of matter contained within the container, wherein the
composition of matter may comprise a TAT
polypeptide as described herein, a chimeric TAT polypeptide as described
herein, an anti-TAT antibody as
described herein, a TAT binding oligopeptide as described herein, or a TAT
binding organic molecule as described
herein. The article may further optionally comprise a label affixed to the
container, or a package insert included
with the container, that refers to the use of the composition of matter for
the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic
detection of a tumor.
Another embodiment of the present invention is directed to the use of a TAT
polypeptide as described
herein, a chimeric TAT polypeptide as described herein, an anti-TAT
polypeptide antibody as described herein,
a TAT binding oligopeptide as described herein, or a TAT binding organic
molecule as described herein, for the
preparation of a medicament useful in the treatment of a condition which is
responsive to the TAT polypeptide,
6


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
chimeric TAT polypeptide, anti-TAT polypeptide antibody, TAT binding
oligopeptide, or TAT binding organic
molecule.
B. Additional Embodiments
Another embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method for
inhibiting the growth of a cell
that expresses a TAT polypeptide, wherein the method comprises contacting the
cell with an antibody, an
oligopeptide or a small organic molecule that binds to the TAT polypeptide,
and wherein the binding of the
antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule to the TAT polypeptide causes
inhibition of the growth of the cell
expressing the TAT polypeptide. In preferred embodiments, the cell is a cancer
cell and binding of the antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule to the TAT polypeptide causes death of the
cell expressing the TAT polypeptide.
Optionally, the antibody is a monoclonal antibody, antibody fragment, chimeric
antibody, humanized antibody,
or single-chain antibody. Antibodies, TAT binding oligopeptides and TAT
binding organic molecules employed
in the methods of the present invention may optionally be conjugated to a
growth inhibitory agent or cytotoxic
agent such as a toxin, including, for example, a maytansinoid or
calicheamicin, an antibiotic, a radioactive isotope,
a nucleolytic enzyme, or the like. The antibodies and TAT binding
oligopeptides employed in the methods of the
present invention may optionally be produced in CHO cells or bacterial cells.
Yet another embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method of
therapeutically treating a
mammal having a cancerous tumor comprising cells that express a TAT
polypeptide, wherein the method
comprises administering to the mammal a therapeutically effective amount of an
antibody, an oligopeptide or a
small organic molecule that binds to the TAT polypeptide, thereby resulting in
the effective therapeutic treatment
of the tumor. Optionally, the antibody is a monoclonal antibody, antibody
fragment, chimeric antibody, humanized
antibody, or single-chain antibody. Antibodies, TAT binding oligopeptides and
TAT binding organic molecules
employed in the methods of the present invention may optionally be conjugated
to a growth inhibitory agent or
cytotoxic agent such as a toxin, including, for example, a maytansinoid or
calicheaniicin, an antibiotic, a
radioactive isotope, a nucleolytic enzyme, or the like. The antibodies and
oligopeptides employed in the methods
of the present invention may optionally be produced in CHO cells or bacterial
cells.
Yet another embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method of
determining the presence of
a TAT polypeptide in a sample suspected of containing the TAT polypeptide,
wherein the method comprises
exposing the sample to an antibody, oligopeptide or small organic molecule
that binds to the TAT polypeptide and
determining binding of the antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule to the
TAT polypeptide in the sample,
wherein the presence of such binding is indicative of the presence of the TAT
polypeptide in the sample.
Optionally, the sample may contain cells (which may be cancer cells) suspected
of expressing the TAT
polypeptide. The antibody, TAT binding oligopeptide or TAT binding organic
molecule employed in the method
may optionally be detectably labeled, attached to a solid support, or the
like.
A further embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method of
diagnosing the presence of a
tumor in a mammal, wherein the method comprises detecting the level of
expression of a gene encoding a TAT
polypeptide (a) in a test sample of tissue cells obtained from said mammal,
and (b) in a control sample of known
normal non-cancerous cells of the same tissue origin or type, wherein a higher
level of expression of the TAT
polypeptide in the test sample, as compared to the control sample, is
indicative of the presence of tumor in the
mammal from which the test sample was obtained.

7


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Another embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method of
diagnosing the presence of a
tumor in a mammal, wherein the method comprises (a) contacting a test sample
comprising tissue cells obtained
from the mammal with an antibody, oligopeptide or small organic molecule that
binds to a TAT polypeptide and
(b) detecting the formation of a complex between the antibody, oligopeptide or
small organic molecule and the
TAT polypeptide in the test sample, wherein the formation of a complex is
indicative of the presence of a tumor
in the mammal. Optionally, the antibody, TAT binding oligopeptide or TAT
binding organic molecule employed
is detectably labeled, attached to a solid support, or the like, and/or the
test sample of tissue cells is obtained from
an individual suspected of having a cancerous tumor.
Yet another embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method for
treating or preventing a cell
proliferative disorder associated with altered, preferably increased,
expression or activity of a TAT polypeptide,
the method comprising administering to a subject in need of such treatment an
effective amount of an antagonist
of a TAT polypeptide. Preferably, the cell proliferative disorder is cancer
and the antagonist of the TAT
polypeptide is an anti-TAT polypeptide antibody, TAT binding oligopeptide, TAT
binding organic molecule or
antisense oligonucleotide. Effective treatment or prevention of the cell
proliferative disorder may be a result of
direct Icilling or growth inhibition of cells that express a TAT polypeptide
or by antagonizing the cell growth
potentiating activity of a TAT polypeptide.
Yet another embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method of
binding an antibody,
oligopeptide or small organic molecule to a cell that expresses a TAT
polypeptide, wherein the method comprises
contacting a cell that expresses a TAT polypeptide with said antibody,
oligopeptide or small organic molecule
under conditions which are suitable for binding of the antibody, oligopeptide
or small organic molecule to said
TAT polypeptide and allowing binding therebetween. In preferred embodiments,
the antibody is labeled witli a
molecule or compound that is useful for qualitatively and/or quantitatively
determining the location and/or amount
of binding of the antibody, oligopeptide or small organic molecule to the
cell.
Other embodiments of the present invention are directed to the use of (a) a
TAT polypeptide, (b) a nucleic
acid encoding a TAT polypeptide or a vector or host cell comprising that
nucleic acid, (c) an anti-TAT polypeptide
antibody, (d) a TAT-binding oligopeptide, or (e) a TAT-binding small organic
molecule in the preparation of a
medicament useful for (i) the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of
a cancer or tumor, or (ii) the
therapeutic treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
Another embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method for
inhibiting the growth of a cancer
cell, wherein the growth of said cancer cell is at least in part dependent
upon the growth potentiating effect(s) of
a TAT polypeptide (wherein the TAT polypeptide may be expressed either by the
cancer cell itself or a cell that
produces polypeptide(s) that have a growth potentiating effect on cancer
cells), wherein the method comprises
contacting the TAT polypeptide with an antibody, an oligopeptide or a small
organic molecule that binds to the
TAT polypeptide, thereby antagonizing the growth-potentiating activity of the
TAT polypeptide and, in turn,
inhibiting the growth of the cancer cell. Preferably the growth of the cancer
cell is completely inhibited. Even
more preferably, binding of the antibody, oligopeptide or small organic
molecule to the TAT polypeptide induces
the death of the cancer cell. Optionally, the antibody is a monoclonal
antibody, antibody fragment, chimeric
antibody, humanized antibody, or single-chain antibody. Antibodies, TAT
binding oligopeptides and TAT binding
organic molecules employed in the methods of the present invention may
optionally be conjugated to a growth
8


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
inhibitory agent or cytotoxic agent such as a toxin, including, for example, a
maytansinoid or calicheamicin, an
antibiotic, a radioactive isotope, a nucleolytic enzyme, or the like. The
antibodies and TAT binding oligopeptides
employed in the methods of the present invention may optionally be produced in
CHO cells or bacterial cells.
Yet another embodiment of the present invention is directed to a method of
therapeutically treating a
tumor in a mammal, wherein the growth of said tumor is at least in part
dependent upon the growtl- potentiating
effect(s) of a TAT polypeptide, wherein the method comprises administering to
the mammal a ttierapeutically
effective amount of an antibody, an oligopeptide or a small organic molecule
that binds to the TAT polypeptide,
thereby antagonizing the growth potentiating activity of said TAT polypeptide
and resulting in the effective
therapeutic treatment of the tumor. Optionally, the antibody is a monoclonal
antibody, antibody fragment, chimeric
antibody, humanized antibody, or single-chain antibody. Antibodies, TAT
binding oligopeptides and TAT binding
organic molecules employed in the methods of the present invention may
optionally be conjugated to a growth
inhibitory agent or cytotoxic agent such as a toxin, including, for example, a
maytansinoid or calicheamicin, an
antibiotic, a radioactive isotope, a nucleolytic enzyme, or the like. The
antibodies and oligopeptides employed
in the methods of the present invention may optionally be produced in CHO
cells or bacterial cells.

C. Further Additional Embodiments
In yet further embodiments, the invention is directed to the following set of
potential claims for this
application:
1. Isolated nucleic acid having a nucleotide sequence that has at least 80%
nucleic acid sequence
identity to:
(a) a DNA molecule encoding the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) a DNA molecule encoding the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2,
lacking its associated
signal peptide;
(c) a DNA molecule encoding an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide;
(d) a DNA molecule encoding an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2,
lacking its associated signal peptide;
(e) the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1;
(f) the full-length coding sequence of the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1; or
(g) the complement of (a), (b), (c), (d), (e) or (f).
2. Isolated nucleic acid having:
(a) a nucleotide sequence that encodes the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:2;
(b) a nucleotide sequence that encodes the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID
N0:2, lacking its
associated signal peptide;
(c) a nucleotide sequence that encodes an extracellular domain of the
polypeptide shown as SEQ ID
NO:2, with its associated signal peptide;
(d) a nucleotide sequence that encodes an extracellular domain of the
polypeptide shown as SEQ ID
NO:2, lacking its associated signal peptide;
(e) the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:1;
9


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
(f) the full-length coding region of the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1; or
(g) the complement of (a), (b), (c), (d), (e) or (f).
3. Isolated nucleic acid that hybridizes to:
(a) a nucleic acid that encodes the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) a nucleic acid that encodes the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2,
lacking its associated
signal peptide;
(c) a nucleic acid that encodes an extracellular domain of the polypeptide
shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide;
(d) a nucleic acid that encodes an extracellular domain of the polypeptide
shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide;
(e) the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1;
(f) the full-length coding region of the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1; or
(g) the complement of (a), (b), (c), (d), (e) or (f).
4. The nucleic acid of Claim 3, wherein the hybridization occurs under
stringent conditions.
5. The nucleic acid of Claim 3 which is at least about 5 nucleotides in
length.
6. An expression vector comprising the nucleic acid of Claim 1, 2 or 3.
7. The expression vector of Claim 6, wherein said nucleic acid is operably
linked to control
sequences recognized by a host cell transformed with the vector.
8. A host cell comprising the expression vector of Claim 7.
9. The host cell of Claim 8 which is a CHO cell, an E. coli cell or a yeast
cell.
10. A process for producing a polypeptide comprising culturing the host cell
of Claim 8 under
conditions suitable for expression of said polypeptide and recovering said
polypeptide from the cell culture.
11. An isolated polypeptide having at least 80% amino acid sequence identity
to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1.
12. An isolated polypeptide having:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID N0:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1; or


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
13. A chimeric polypeptide comprising the polypeptide of Claim 11 or 12 fused
to a heterologous
polypeptide.
14. The chimeric polypeptide of Claim 13, wherein said heterologous
polypeptide is an epitope tag
sequence or an Fc region of an immunoglobulin.
15. An isolated antibody that binds to a polypeptide having at least 80% amino
acid sequence
identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-lengtli coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1.
16. An isolated antibody that binds to a polypeptide having:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an aniino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide
shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ II) NO:1.
17. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which is a monoclonal antibody.
18. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which is an antibody fragment.
19. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which is a chimeric or a humanized
antibody.
20. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which is conjugated to a growth inhibitory
agent.
21. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which is conjugated to a cytotoxic agent.
22. The antibody of Claim 21, wherein the cytotoxic agent is selected from the
group consisting of
toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic enzymes.
23. The antibody of Claim 21, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
24. The antibody of Claim 23, wherein the toxin is selected from the group
consisting of
maytansinoid and calicheamicin.
25. The antibody of Claim 23, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
26. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which is produced in bacteria.
27. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which is produced in CHO cells.
11


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
28. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which induces death of a cell to which it
binds.
29. The antibody of Claim 15 or 16 which is detectably labeled.
30. An isolated nucleic acid having a nucleotide sequence that encodes the
antibody of Claim 15 or
16.
31. An expression vector comprising the nucleic acid of Claim 30 operably
linked to control
sequences recognized by a host cell transformed with the vector.
32. A host cell comprising the expression vector of Claim 31.
33. The host cell of Claim 32 which is a CHO cell, an E. coli cell or a yeast
cell.
34. A process for producing an antibody comprising culturing the host cell of
Claim 32 under
conditions suitable for expression of said antibody and recovering said
antibody from the cell culture.
35. An isolated oligopeptide that binds to a polypeptide having at least 80%
amino acid sequence
identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1.
36. An isolated oligopeptide that binds to a polypeptide having:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
37. The oligopeptide of Claim 35 or 36 which is conjugated to a growth
inhibitory agent.
38. The oligopeptide of Claim 35 or 36 which is conjugated to a cytotoxic
agent.
39. The oligopeptide of Claim 38, wherein the cytotoxic agent is selected from
the group consisting
of toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic enzymes.
40. The oligopeptide of Claim 38, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
41. The oligopeptide of Claim 40, wherein the toxin is selected from the group
consisting of
maytansinoid and calicheamicin.
42. The oligopeptide of Claim 40, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
43. The oligopeptide of Claim 35 or 36 which induces death of a cell to which
it binds.
12


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
44. The oligopeptide of Claim 35 or 36 which is detectably labeled.
45. A TAT binding organic molecule that binds to a polypeptide having at least
80% amino acid
sequence identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1.
46. The organic molecule of Claim 45 that binds to a polypeptide having:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence=,
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
47. The organic molecule of Claim 45 or 46 which is conjugated to a growth
inhibitory agent.
48. The organic molecule of Claim 45 or 46 which is conjugated to a cytotoxic
agent.
49. The organic molecule of Claim 48, wherein the cytotoxic agent is selected
from the group
consisting of toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic
enzymes.
50. The organic molecule of Claim 48, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
51. The organic molecule of Claim 50, wherein the toxin is selected from the
group consisting of
maytansinoid and calicheamicin.
52. The organic molecule of Claim 50, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
53. The organic molecule of Claim 45 or 46 which induces death of a cell to
which it binds.
54. The organic molecule of Claim 45 or 46 which is detectably labeled.
55. A composition of matter comprising:
(a) the polypeptide of Claim 11;
(b) the polypeptide of Claim 12;
(c) the chimeric polypeptide of Claim 13;
(d) the antibody of Claim 15;
(e) the antibody of Claim 16;
(f) the oligopeptide of Claim 35;
(g) the oligopeptide of Claim 36;

13


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
(h) the TAT binding organic molecule of Claim 45; or
(i) the TAT binding organic molecule of Claim 46; in combination with a
carrier.
56. The composition of matter of Claim 55, wherein said carrier is a
pharmaceutically acceptable
carrier.
57. An article of manufacture comprising:
(a) a container; and
(b) the composition of matter of Claim 55 contained within said container.
58. The article of manufacture of Claim 57 further comprising a label affixed
to said container, or
a package insert included with said container, referring to the use of said
composition of matter for the therapeutic
treatment of or the diagnostic detection of a cancer.
59. A method of inhibiting the growth of a cell that expresses a protein
having at least 80% amino
acid sequence identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1, said method comprising contacting said cell with an antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule that binds
to said protein, the binding of said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule to said protein thereby causing an
inhibition of growth of said cell.
60. The method of Claim 59, wherein said antibody is a monoclonal antibody.
61. The method of Claim 59, wherein said antibody is an antibody fragment.
62. The method of Claim 59, wherein said antibody is a chimeric or a humanized
antibody.
63. The method of Claim 59, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a growth inhibitory agent.
64. The method of Claim59, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a cytotoxic agent.
65. The method of Claim 64, wherein said cytotoxic agent is selected from the
group consisting of
toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic enzymes.
66. The method of Claim 64, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
67. The method of Claim 66, wherein the toxin is selected from the group
consisting of maytansinoid
and calicheamicin.
68. The method of Claim 66, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
69. The method of Claim 59, wherein said antibody is produced in bacteria.
70. The method of Claim 59, wherein said antibody is produced in CHO cells.
71. The method of Claim 59, wherein said cell is a cancer cell.

14


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
72. The method of Claim 71, wherein said cancer cell is further exposed to
radiation treatment or
a chemotherapeutic agent.
73. The method of Claim 71, wherein said cancer cell is selected from the
group consisting of a
breast cancer cell, a colorectal cancer cell, a lung cancer cell, an ovarian
cancer cell, a central nervous system
cancer cell, a liver cancer cell, a bladder cancer cell, a pancreatic cancer
cell, a cervical cancer cell, a melanoma
cell and a leukemia cell.
74. The method of Claim 71, wherein said protein is more abundantly expressed
by said cancer cell
as compared to a normal cell of the same tissue origin.
75. The method of Claim 59 which causes the death of said cell.
76. The method of Claim 59, wherein said protein has:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
77. A method of therapeutically treating a mammal having a cancerous tumor
comprising cells that
express a protein having at least 80% amino acid sequence identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1, said method comprising adnunistering to said mammal a therapeutically
effective amount of an antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule that binds to said protein, thereby
effectively treating said mammal.
78. The method of Claim 77, wherein said antibody is a monoclonal antibody.
79. The method of Claim 77, wherein said antibody is an antibody fragment.
80. The method of Claim 77, wherein said antibody is a chimeric or a humanized
antibody.
81. The method of Claim 77, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a growth inhibitory agent.
82. The method of Claim 77, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a cytotoxic agent.
83. The method of Claim 82, wherein said cytotoxic agent is selected from the
group consisting of
toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic enzymes.



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
84. The method of Claim 82, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
85. The method of Claim 84, wherein the toxin is selected from the group
consisting of maytansinoid
and calicheamicin.
86. The method of Claim 84, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
87. The method of Claim 77, wherein said antibody is produced in bacteria.
88. The method of Claim 77, wherein said antibody is produced in CHO cells.
89. The method of Claim 77, wherein said tumor is further exposed to radiation
treatment or a
chemotherapeutic agent.
90. The method of Claim 77, wherein said tumor is a breast tumor, a colorectal
tumor, a lung tumor,
an ovarian tumor, a central nervous system tumor, a liver tumor, a bladder
tumor, a pancreatic tumor, or a cervical
tumor.
91. The method of Claim 77, wherein said protein is more abundantly expressed
by the cancerous
cells of said tumor as compared to a normal cell of the same tissue origin.
92. The method of Claim 77, wherein said protein has:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:l; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
93. A method of determining the presence of a protein in a sample suspected of
containing said
protein, wherein said protein has at least 80% aniino acid sequence identity
to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1, said method comprising exposing said sample to an antibody, oligopeptide
or organic molecule that binds
to said protein and determining binding of said antibody, oligopeptide or
organic molecule to said protein in said
sample, wherein binding of the antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule to
said protein is indicative of the
presence of said protein in said sample.
94. The method of Claim 93, wherein said sample comprises a cell suspected of
expressing said
protein.
95. The method of Claim 94, wherein said cell is a cancer cell.
16


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
96. The method of Claim 93, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is detectably
labeled.
97. The method of Claim 93, wherein said protein has:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacldng its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
98. A method of diagnosing the presence of a tumor in a mammal, said method
comprising
determining the level of expression of a gene encoding a protein having at
least 80% amino acid sequence identity
to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1, in a test sample of tissue cells obtained from said mammal and in a
control sample of known normal cells
of the same tissue origin, wherein a higher level of expression of said
protein in the test sample, as compared to
the control sample, is indicative of the presence of tumor in the mammal from
which the test sample was obtained.
99. The method of Claim 98, wherein the step of determining the level of
expression of a gene
encoding said protein comprises employing an oligonucleotide in an in situ
hybridization or RT-PCR analysis.
100. The method of Claim 98, wherein the step determining the level of
expression of a gene encoding
said protein comprises employing an antibody in an immunohistochemistry or
Western blot analysis.
101. The method of Claim 98, wherein said protein has:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-lengtli coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.

17


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
102. A method of diagnosing the presence of a tumor in a mammal, said method
comprising
contacting a test sample of tissue cells obtained from said mammal with an
antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule that binds to a protein having at least 80% amino acid sequence
identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1, and detecting the formation of a complex between said antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule and said
protein in the test sample, wherein the formation of a complex is indicative
of the presence of a tumor in said
mammal.
103. The method of Claim 102, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is detectably
labeled.
104. The method of Claim 102, wherein said test sample of tissue cells is
obtained from an individual
suspected of having a cancerous tumor.
105. The method of Claim 102, wherein said protein has:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptioe shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
106. A method for treating or preventing a cell proliferative disorder
associated with increased
expression or activity of a protein having at least 80% amino acid sequence
identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID N0:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1, said method comprising administering to a subject in need of such
treatment an effective amount of an
antagonist of said protein, thereby effectively treating or preventing said
cell proliferative disorder.
107. The method of Claim 106, wherein said cell proliferative disorder is
cancer.
18


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
108. The method of Claim 106, wherein said antagonist is an anti-TAT
polypeptide antibody, TAT
binding oligopeptide, TAT binding organic molecule or antisense
oligonucleotide.
109. A metliod of binding an antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule to a
cell that expresses a
protein having at least 80% amino acid sequence identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1, said method comprising contacting said cell with an antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule that binds
to said protein and allowing the binding of the antibody, oligopeptide or
organic molecule to said protein to occur,
thereby binding said antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule to said cell.
110. The method of Claim 109, wherein said antibody is a monoclonal antibody.
111. The method of Claim 109, wherein said antibody is an antibody fragment.
112. The method of Claim 109, wherein said antibody is a chimeric or a
humanized antibody.
113. The method of Claim 109, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a growth inhibitory agent.
114. The method of Claim 109, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a cytotoxic agent.
115. The method of Claim 114, wherein said cytotoxic agent is selected from
the group consisting
of toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic enzymes.
116. The method of Claim 114, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
117. The method of Claim 116, wherein the toxin is selected from the group
consisting of
maytansinoid and calicheamicin.
118. The method of Claim 116, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
119. The method of Claim 109, wherein said antibody is produced in bacteria.
120. The method of Claim 109, wherein said antibody is produced in CHO cells.
121. The method of Claim 109, wherein said cell is a cancer cell.
122. The method of Claim 121, wherein said cancer cell is further exposed to
radiation treatment or
a chemotherapeutic agent.
123. The method of Claim 121, wherein said cancer cell is selected from the
group consisting of a
breast cancer cell, a colorectal cancer cell, a lung cancer cell, an ovarian
cancer cell, a central nervous system
cancer cell, a liver cancer cell, a bladder cancer cell, a pancreatic cancer
cell, a cervical cancer cell, a melanoma
cell and a leukemia cell.
124. The method of Claim 123, wherein said protein is more abundantly
expressed by said cancer
cell as compared to a normal cell of the same tissue origin.
125. The metliod of Claim 109 which causes the death of said cell.
19


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
126. Use of a nucleic acid as claimed in any of Claims 1 to 5 or 30 in the
preparation of a medicament
for the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a cancer.
127. Use of a nucleic acid as claimed in any of Claims 1 to 5 or 30 in the
preparation of a medicament
for treating a tumor.
128. Use of a nucleic acid as claimed in any of Claims 1 to 5 or 30 in the
preparation of a medicament
for treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
129. Use of an expression vector as claimed in any of Claims 6, 7 or 31 in the
preparation of a
medicament for the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a cancer.
130. Use of an expression vector as claimed in any of Claims 6, 7 or 31 in the
preparation of
medicament for treating a tumor.
131. Use of an expression vector as claimed in any of Claims 6, 7 or 31 in the
preparation of a
medicament for treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
132. Use of a host cell as claimed in any of Claims 8, 9, 32, or 33 in the
preparation of a medicament
for the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a cancer.
133. Use of a host cell as claimed in any of Claims 8, 9, 32 or 33 in the
preparation of a medicament
for treating a tumor.
134. Use of a host cell as claimed in any of Claims 8, 9, 32 or 33 in the
preparation of a medicament
for treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
135. Use of a polypeptide as claimed in any of Claims 11 to 14 in the
preparation of a medicament
for the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a cancer.
136. Use of a polypeptide as claimed in any of Claims 11 to 14 in the
preparation of a medicament
for treating a tumor.
137. Use of a polypeptide as claimed in any of Claims 11 to 14 in the
preparation of a medicament
for treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
138. Use of an antibody as claimed in any of Claims 15 to 29 in the
preparation of a medicament for
the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a cancer.
139. Use of an antibody as claimed in any of Claims 15 to 29 in the
preparation of a medicament for
treating a tumor.
140. Use of an antibody as claimed in any of Claims 15 to 29 in the
preparation of a medicament for
treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
141. Use of an oligopeptide as claimed in any of Claims 35 to 44 in the
preparation of a medicament
for the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a cancer.
142. Use of an oligopeptide as claimed in any of Claims 35 to 44 in the
preparation of a medicament
for treating a tumor.
143. Use of an oligopeptide as claimed in any of Claims 35 to 44 in the
preparation of a medicament
.35 for treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
144. Use of a TAT binding organic molecule as claimed in any of Claims 45 to
54 in the preparation
of a medicament for the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a
cancer.



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
145. Use of a TAT binding organic molecule as claimed in any of Claims 45 to
54 in the preparation
of a medicament for treating a tumor.
146. Use of a TAT binding organic molecule as claimed in any of Claims 45 to
54 in the preparation
of a medicament for treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
147. Use of a composition of matter as claimed in any of Claims 55 or 56 in
the preparation of a
medicament for the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a cancer.
148. Use of a composition of matter as claimed in any of Claims 55 or 56 in
the preparation of a
medicament for treating a tumor.
149. Use of a composition of matter as claimed in any of Claims 55 or 56 in
the preparation of a
medicament for treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
150. Use of an article of manufacture as claimed in any of Claims 57 or 58 in
the preparation of a
medicament for the therapeutic treatment or diagnostic detection of a cancer.
151. Use of an article of manufacture as claimed in any of Claims 57 or 58 in
the preparation of a
medicament for treating a tumor.
152. Use of an article of manufacture as claimed in any of Claims 57 or 58 in
the preparation of a
medicament for treatment or prevention of a cell proliferative disorder.
153. A method for inhibiting the growth of a cell, wherein the growth of said
cell is at least in part
dependent upon a growth potentiating effect of a protein having at least 80%
amino acid sequence identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1, said method comprising contacting said protein with an antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule that
binds to said protein, there by inhibiting the growth of said cell.
154. The method of Claim 153, wherein said cell is a cancer cell.
155. The method of Claim 153, wherein said protein is expressed by said cell.
156. The method of Claim 153, wherein the binding of said antibody,
oligopeptide or organic
molecule to said protein antagonizes a cell growth-potentiating activity of
said protein.
157. The method of Claim 153, wherein the binding of said antibody,
oligopeptide or organic
molecule to said protein induces the death of said cell.
158. The method of Claim 153, wherein said antibody is a monoclonal antibody.
159. The method of Claim 153, wherein said antibody is an antibody fragment.
160. The method of Claim 153, wherein said antibody is a chimeric or a
humanized antibody.
161. The method of Claim 153, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a growth inhibitory agent.

21


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
162. The method of Claim 153, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a cytotoxic agent.
163. The method of Claim 162, wherein said cytotoxic agent is selected from
the group consisting
of toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic enzymes.
164. The method of Claim 162, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
165. The method of Claim 164, wherein the toxin is selected from the group
consisting of
maytansinoid and calicheamicin.
166. The method of Claim 164, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
167. The method of Claim 153, wherein said antibody is produced in bacteria.
168. The method of Claim 153, wherein said antibody is produced in CHO cells.
169. The method of Claim 153, wherein said protein has:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO: 1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
170. A method of therapeutically treating a tumor in a mammal, wherein the
growth of said tumor is
at least in part dependent upon a growth potentiating effect of a protein
having at least 80% amino acid sequence
identity to:
(a) the polypeptide shown in as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated signal
peptide;
(c) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, with its
associated signal peptide;
(d) an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal
peptide;
(e) a polypeptide encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID NO: 1; or
(f) a polypeptide encoded by the full-length coding region of the nucleotide
sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1, said method comprising contacting said protein with an antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule that
binds to said protein, thereby effectively treating said tumor.
171. The method of Claim 170, wherein said protein is expressed by cells of
said tumor.
172. The method of Claim 170, wherein the binding of said antibody,
oligopeptide or organic
molecule to said protein antagonizes a cell growth-potentiating activity of
said protein.
173. The method of Claim 170, wherein said antibody is a monoclonal antibody.
174. The method of Claim 170, wherein said antibody is an antibody fragment.
175. The method of Claim 170, wherein said antibody is a chimeric or a
humanized antibody.
22


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
176. The method of Claim 170, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a growth inhibitory agent.
177. The method of Claim 170, wherein said antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is conjugated
to a cytotoxic agent.
178. The method of Claim 177, wherein said cytotoxic agent is selected from
the group consisting
of toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic enzymes.
179. The method of Claim 177, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
180. The method of Claim 179, wherein the toxin is selected from the group
consisting of
maytansinoid and calicheaniicin.
181. The method of Claim 179, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
182. The method of Claim 170, wherein said antibody is produced in bacteria.
183. The method of Claim 170, wherein said antibody is produced in CHO cells.
184. The method of Claim 170, wherein said protein has:
(a) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2;
(b) the amino acid sequence shown as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking its associated
signal peptide sequence;
(c) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, with
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(d) an amino acid sequence of an extracellular domain of the polypeptide shown
as SEQ ID NO:2, lacking
its associated signal peptide sequence;
(e) an amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence shown as SEQ ID
NO:1; or
(f) an amino acid sequence encoded by the full-length coding region of the
nucleotide sequence shown
as SEQ ID NO:1.
186. An isolated antibody that binds to the epitope bound by an antibody
produced by any of the
hybridoma cell lines shown in Table 7.
187. The antibody of Claim 186 which is a monoclonal antibody.
188. The antibody of Claim 186 which is an antibody fragment.
189. The antibody of Claim 186 which is a chimeric or a humanized antibody.
190. The antibody of Claim 186 which is conjugated to a growth inhibitory
agent.
191. The antibody of Claim 186 which is conjugated to a cytotoxic agent.
192. The antibody of Claim 191, wherein the cytotoxic agent is selected from
the group consisting
of toxins, antibiotics, radioactive isotopes and nucleolytic enzymes.
193. The antibody of Claim 191, wherein the cytotoxic agent is a toxin.
194. The antibody of Claim 193, wherein the toxin is selected from the group
consisting of
maytansinoid and calicheamicin.
195. The antibody of Claim 193, wherein the toxin is a maytansinoid.
196. The antibody of Claim 186 which is produced in bacteria.
197. The antibody of Claim 186 which is produced in CHO cells.
198. The antibody of Claim 186 which induces death of a cell to which it
binds.
199. The antibody of Claim 186 which is detectably labeled.

23


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
200. The antibody of Claim 186 which comprises at least one of the
complementarity determining
regions of any antibody produced by any of the hybridoma cell lines shown in
Table 7.
201. A monoclonal antibody produced by any of the hybridoma cells shown in
Table 7.
202. A hybridoma cell which produces a monoclonal antibody that binds to a
TAT1 13 polypeptide.
203. A method of identifying an antibody that binds to an epitope bound by an
antibody produced
by any of the hybridoma cell lines shown in Table 7, said method comprising
determining the ability of a first
antibody to block binding of a second antibody produced by any of the
hybridoma cell lines shown in Table 7 to
a TAT1 13 polypeptide, wherein the ability of said first antibody to block the
binding of said second antibody to
said TAT 113 polypeptide by at least 40% and at equal antibody concentrations
is indicative of said first antibody
being capable of binding to an epitope bound by said second antibody.
Yet further embodiments of the present invention will be evident to the
skilled artisan upon a reading of
the present specification.

BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
Figure 1 shows a nucleotide sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1) of a TAT1 13 cDNA, wherein
SEQ ID NO:1 is a
clone designated herein as "DNA215609".
Figure 2 shows the amino acid sequence (SEQ ID NO:2) derived from the full-
length coding sequence
of SEQ ID NO:1 shown in Figure 1.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENTS
I. Definitions
Ttie terms "TAT polypeptide" and "TAT" as used herein and wlien immediately
followed by a numerical
designation, refer to various polypeptides, wherein the complete designation
(i.e.,TAT/number) refers to specific
polypeptide sequences as described herein. The terms "TAT/number polypeptide"
and "TAT/number" wherein
the term "number" is provided as an actual numerical designation as used
herein encompass native sequence
polypeptides, polypeptide variants and fragments of native sequence
polypeptides and polypeptide variants (which
are further defined herein). The TAT polypeptides described herein may be
isolated from a variety of sources,
such as from human tissue types or from another source, or prepared by
recombinant or synthetic methods. The
term "TAT polypeptide" refers to each individual TAT/number polypeptide
disclosed herein. All disclosures in
this specification which refer to the "TAT polypeptide" refer to each of the
polypeptides individually as well as
jointly. For example, descriptions of the preparation of, purification of,
derivation of, formation of antibodies to
or against, formation of TAT binding oligopeptides to or against, formation of
TAT binding organic molecules
to or against, administration of, compositions containing, treatment of a
disease with, etc., pertain to each
polypeptide of the invention individually. The term "TAT polypeptide" also
includes variants of the TAT/number
polypeptides disclosed herein.
A "native sequence TAT polypeptide" comprises a polypeptide having the same
amino acid sequence as
the corresponding TAT polypeptide derived from nature. Such native sequence
TAT polypeptides can be isolated
from nature or can be produced by recombinant or synthetic means. The term
"native sequence TAT polypeptide"
specifically encompasses naturally-occurring truncated or secreted forms of
the specific TAT polypeptide (e.g.,
24


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
an extracellular domain sequence), naturally-occurring variant forms (e.g.,
alternatively spliced forms) and
naturally-occurring allelic variants of the polypeptide. In certain
embodiments of the invention, the native
sequence TAT polypeptides disclosed herein are mature or full-length native
sequence polypeptides comprising
the full-length amino acids sequences shown in the accompanying figures. Start
and stop codons (if indicated) are
shown in bold font and underlined in the figures. Nucleic acid residues
indicated as "N" or "X" in the
accompanying figures are any nucleic acid residue. However, while the TAT
polypeptides disclosed in the
accompanying figures are shown to begin with methionine residues designated
herein as amino acid position 1 in
the figures, it is conceivable and possible that other methionine residues
located either upstream or downstream
from the amino acid position 1 in the figures may be employed as the starting
amino acid residue for the TAT
polypeptides.
The TAT polypeptide "extracellular domain" or "ECD" refers to a form of the
TAT polypeptide which
is essentially free of the transmembrane and cytoplasmic domains. Ordinarily,
a TAT polypeptide ECD will have
less than 1% of such transmembrane and/or cytoplasmic domains and preferably,
will have less than 0.5% of such
domains. It will be understood that any transmembrane domains identified for
the TAT polypeptides of the present
invention are identified pursuant to criteria routinely employed in the art
for identifying that type of hydrophobic
domain. The exact boundaries of a transmembrane domain may vary but most
likely by no more than about 5
amino acids at either end of the domain as initially identified herein.
Optionally, therefore, an extracellular domain
of a TAT polypeptide may contain from about 5 or fewer amino acids on either
side of the transmembrane
domain/extracellular domain boundary as identified in the Examples or
specification and such polypeptides, with
or without the associated signal peptide, and nucleic acid encoding them, are
contemplated by the present
invention.
The approximate location of the "signal peptides" of the various TAT
polypeptides disclosed herein may
be shown in the present specification and/or the accompanying figures. It is
noted, however, that the C-terminal
boundary of a signal peptide may vary, but most likely by no more than about 5
amino acids on either side of the
signal peptide C-terminal boundary as initially identified herein, wherein the
C-terminal boundary of the signal
peptide may be identified pursuant to criteria routinely employed in the art
for identifying that type of amino acid
sequence element (e.g., Nielsen et al., Prot. Eng. 10:1-6 (1997) and von
Heinje et al., Nucl. Acids. Res. 14:4683-
4690 (1986)). Moreover, it is also recognized that, in some cases, cleavage of
a signal sequence from a secreted
polypeptide is not entirely uniform, resulting in more than one secreted
species. These mature polypeptides, where
the signal peptide is cleaved within no more than about 5 amino acids on
either side of the C-terminal boundary
of the signal peptide as identified herein, and the polynucleotides encoding
them, are contemplated by the present
invention.
"TAT polypeptide variant" means a TAT polypeptide, preferably an active TAT
polypeptide, as defined
herein having at least about 80% amino acid sequence identity with a full-
length native sequence TAT polypeptide
sequence as disclosed herein, a TAT polypeptide sequence lacking the signal
peptide as disclosed herein, an
extracellular domain of a TAT polypeptide, with or without the signal peptide,
as disclosed herein or any other
fragment of a full-length TAT polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein (such
as those encoded by a nucleic acid
that represents only a portion of the complete coding sequence for a full-
length TAT polypeptide). Such TAT
polypeptide variants include, for instance, TAT polypeptides wherein one or
more amino acid residues are added,


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
or deleted, at the N- or C-terminus of the full-length native amino acid
sequence. Ordinarily, a TAT polypeptide
variant will have at least about 80% amino acid sequence identity,
alternatively at least about 81%, 82%, 83%,
84%, 85%, 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or
99% amino acid
sequence identity, to a full-length native sequence TAT polypeptide sequence
as disclosed herein, a TAT
polypeptide sequence lacking the signal peptide as disclosed herein, an
extracellular domain of a TAT polypeptide,
with or without the signal peptide, as disclosed herein or any other
specifically defined fragment of a full-length
TAT polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein. Ordinarily, TAT variant
polypeptides are at least about 10 amino
acids in length, alternatively at least about 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90,
100, 110, 120, 130, 140, 150, 160, 170,
180, 190, 200, 210, 220, 230, 240, 250, 260, 270, 280, 290, 300, 310, 320,
330, 340, 350, 360, 370, 380, 390,
400, 410, 420, 430, 440, 450, 460, 470, 480, 490, 500, 510, 520, 530, 540,
550, 560, 570, 580, 590, 600 amino
acids in length, or more. Optionally, TAT variant polypeptides will have no
more than one conservative amino
acid substitution as compared to the native TAT polypeptide sequence,
alternatively no more than 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7,
8, 9, or 10 conservative amino acid substitution as compared to the native TAT
polypeptide sequence.
"Percent (%) amino acid sequence identity" with respect to the TAT polypeptide
sequences identified
herein is defined as the percentage of amino acid residues in a candidate
sequence that are identical with the amino
acid residues in the specific TAT polypeptide sequence, after aligning the
sequences and introducing gaps, if
necessary, to achieve the maximum percent sequence identity, and not
considering any conservative substitutions
as part of the sequence identity. Alignment for purposes of determining
percent amino acid sequence identity can
be achieved in various ways that are within the skill in the art, for
instance, using publicly available computer
software such as BLAST, BLAST-2, ALIGN or Megalign (DNASTAR) software. Those
skilled in the art can
determine appropriate parameters for measuring alignment, including any
algorithms needed to achieve maximal
alignment over the full length of the sequences being compared. For purposes
herein, however, % amino acid
sequence identity values are generated using the sequence comparison computer
program ALIGN-2, wherein the
complete source code for the ALIGN-2 program is provided in Table 1 below. The
ALIGN-2 sequence
comparison computer program was authored by Genentech, Inc. and the source
code shown in Table 1 below has
been filed with user documentation in the U.S. Copyright Office, Washington
D.C., 20559, where it is registered
under U.S. Copyright Registration No. TXU510087. The ALIGN-2 program is
publicly available through
Genentech, Inc., South San Francisco, California or may be compiled from the
source code provided in Table 1
below. The ALIGN-2 program should be compiled for use on a UNIX operating
system, preferably digital UNIX
V4.0D. All sequence comparison parameters are set by the ALIGN-2 program and
do not vary.
In situations where ALIGN-2 is employed for amino acid sequence comparisons,
the % amino acid
sequence identity of a given amino acid sequence A to, with, or against a
given amino acid sequence B (which can
alternatively be phrased as a given amino acid sequence A that has or
comprises a certain % amino acid sequence
identity to, with, or against a given amino acid sequence B) is calculated as
follows:

100 times the fraction X/Y

where X is the number of amino acid residues scored as identical matches by
the sequence alignment program
ALIGN-2 in that program's alignment of A and B, and where Y is the total
number of amino acid residues in B.
26


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
It will be appreciated that where the length of arnino acid sequence A is not
equal to the length of amino acid
sequence B, the % amino acid sequence identity of A to B will not equal the %
amino acid sequence identity of
B to A. As examples of % amino acid sequence identity calculations using this
method, Tables 2 and 3
demonstrate how to calculate the % amino acid sequence identity of the amino
acid sequence designated
"Comparison Protein" to the amino acid sequence designated "TAT", wherein
"TAT" represents the amino acid
sequence of a hypothetical TAT polypeptide of interest, "Comparison Protein"
represents the amino acid sequence
of a polypeptide against which the "TAT" polypeptide of interest is being
compared, and "X, "Y" and "Z" each
represent different hypothetical amino acid residues. Unless specifically
stated otherwise, all % amino acid
sequence identity values used herein are obtained as described in the
immediately preceding paragraph using the
ALIGN-2 computer program.
"TAT variant polynucleotide" or "TAT variant nucleic acid sequence" means a
nucleic acid molecule
which encodes a TAT polypeptide, preferably an active TAT polypeptide, as
defined herein and which has at least
about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity with a nucleotide acid sequence
encoding a full-length native sequence
TAT polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein, a full-length native sequence
TAT polypeptide sequence lacldng
the signal peptide as disclosed lierein, an extracellular domain of a TAT
polypeptide, with or without the signal
peptide, as disclosed herein or any other fraginent of a full-length TAT
polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein
(such as those encoded by a nucleic acid that represents only a portion of the
complete coding sequence for a full-
length TAT polypeptide). Ordinarily, a TAT variant polynucleotide will have at
least about 80% nucleic acid
sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81%, 82%, 83%, 84%, 85%, 86%,
87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%,
93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or 99% nucleic acid sequence identity with a
nucleic acid sequence encoding
a full-length native sequence TAT polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein, a
full-length native sequence TAT
polypeptide sequence lacking the signal peptide as disclosed herein, an
extracellular domain of a TAT polypeptide,
with or without the signal sequence, as disclosed herein or any other fragment
of a full-length TAT polypeptide
sequence as disclosed herein. Variants do not encompass the native nucleotide
sequence.
Ordinarily, TAT variant polynucleotides are at least about 5 nucleotides in
length, alternatively at least
about 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24,
25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55,
60, 65, 70, 75, 80, 85, 90, 95,100,105, 110, 115, 120, 125, 130, 135, 140,
145, 150, 155, 160, 165,170,175,180,
185, 190, 195, 200, 210, 220, 230, 240, 250, 260, 270, 280, 290, 300, 310,
320, 330, 340, 350, 360, 370, 380, 390,
400, 410, 420, 430, 440, 450, 460, 470, 480, 490, 500, 510, 520, 530, 540,
550, 560, 570, 580, 590, 600, 610, 620,
630, 640, 650, 660, 670, 680, 690, 700, 710, 720, 730, 740, 750, 760, 770,
780, 790, 800, 810, 820, 830, 840, 850,
860, 870, 880, 890, 900, 910, 920, 930, 940, 950, 960, 970, 980, 990, or 1000
nucleotides in length, wherein in
this context the term "about" means the referenced nucleotide sequence length
plus or minus 10% of that
referenced length.
"Percent (%) nucleic acid sequence identity" with respect to TAT-encoding
nucleic acid sequences
identified herein is defined as the percentage of nucleotides in a candidate
sequence that are identical with the
nucleotides in the TAT nucleic acid sequence of interest, after aligning the
sequences and introducing gaps, if
necessary, to achieve the maximum percent sequence identity. Alignment for
purposes of determining percent
nucleic acid sequence identity can be achieved in various ways that are within
the skill in the art, for instance, using
publicly available computer software such as BLAST, BLAST-2, ALIGN or Megalign
(DNASTAR) software.
27


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
For purposes herein, however, % nucleic acid sequence identity values are
generated using the sequence
comparison computer programALIGN-2, wherein the complete source code for the
ALIGN-2 program is provided
in Table 1 below. The ALIGN-2 sequence comparison computer program was
authored by Genentech, Inc. and
the source code shown in Table 1 below has been filed with user documentation
in the U.S. Copyright Office,
Washington D.C., 20559, where it is registered under U.S. Copyright
Registration No. TXU510087. The ALIGN-
2 program is publicly available through Genentech, Inc., South San Francisco,
California or may be compiled from
the source code provided in Table i below. The ALIGN-2 program should be
compiled for use on a UNIX
operating system, preferably digital UNIX V4.0D. All sequence comparison
parameters are set by the ALIGN-2
program and do not vary.
In situations where ALIGN-2 is employed for nucleic acid sequence comparisons,
the % nucleic acid
sequence identity of a given nucleic acid sequence C to, with, or against a
given nucleic acid sequence D (which
can alternatively be phrased as a given nucleic acid sequence C that has or
comprises a certain % nucleic acid
sequence identity to, with, or against a given nucleic acid sequence D) is
calculated as follows:

100 times the fraction W/Z
where W is the number of nucleotides scored as identical matches by the
sequence alignment program ALIGN-2
in that program's alignment of C and D, and where Z is the total number of
nucleotides in D. It will be appreciated
that where the length of nucleic acid sequence C is not equal to the length of
nucleic acid sequence D, the %
nucleic acid sequence identity of C to D will not equal the % nucleic acid
sequence identity of D to C. As
examples of % nucleic acid sequence identity calculations, Tables 4 and 5,
demonstrate how to calculate the %
nucleic acid sequence identity of the nucleic acid sequence designated
"Comparison DNA" to the nucleic acid
sequence designated "TAT-DNA", wherein "TAT-DNA" represents a hypothetical TAT-
encoding nucleic acid
sequence of interest, "Comparison DNA" represents the nucleotide sequence of a
nucleic acid molecule against
which the "TAT-DNA" nucleic acid molecule of interest is being compared, and
"N", "L" and "V" each represent
different hypothetical nucleotides. Unless specifically stated otherwise, all
% nucleic acid sequence identity values
used herein are obtained as described in the immediately preceding paragraph
using the ALIGN-2 computer
program.
In other embodiments, TAT variant polynucleotides are nucleic acid molecules
that encode a TAT
polypeptide and which are capable of hybridizing, preferably under stringent
hybridization and wash conditions,
to nucleotide sequences encoding a full-length TAT polypeptide as disclosed
herein. TAT variant polypeptides
may be those that are encoded by a TAT variant polynucleotide.
The term "full-length coding region" when used in reference to a nucleic acid
encoding a TAT
polypeptide refers to the sequence of nucleotides which encode the full-length
TAT polypeptide of the invention
(which is often shown between start and stop codons, inclusive thereof, in the
accompanying figures). The term
"full-length coding region" when used in reference to an ATCC deposited
nucleic acid refers to the TAT
polypeptide-encoding portion of the cDNA that is inserted into the vector
deposited with the ATCC (which is often
shown between start and stop codons, inclusive thereof, in the accompanying
figures).

28


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
"Isolated," when used to describe the various TAT polypeptides disclosed
herein, means polypeptide that
has been identified and separated and/or recovered from a component of its
natural environment. Contaminant
components of its natural environment are materials that would typically
interfere with diagnostic or therapeutic
uses for the polypeptide, and may include enzymes, hormones, and other
proteinaceous or non-proteinaceous
solutes. In preferred embodiments, the polypeptide will be purified (1) to a
degree sufficient to obtain at least 15
residues of N-terminal or internal amino acid sequence by use of a spinning
cup sequenator, or (2) to homogeneity
by SDS-PAGE under non-reducing or reducing conditions using Coomassie blue or,
preferably, silver stain.
Isolated polypeptide includes polypeptide in situ within recombinant cells,
since at least one component of the
TAT polypeptide natural environment will not be present. Ordinarily, however,
isolated polypeptide will be
prepared by at least one purification step.
An "isolated" TAT polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid or other polypeptide-
encoding nucleic acid is a
nucleic acid molecule that is identified and separated from at least one
contaminant nucleic acid molecule with
which it is ordinarily associated in the natural source of the polypeptide-
encoding nucleic acid. An isolated
polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid molecule is other than in the form or
setting in which it is found in nature.
Isolated polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid molecules therefore are
distinguished from the specific polypeptide-
encoding nucleic acid molecule as it exists in natural cells. However, an
isolated polypeptide-encoding nucleic
acid molecule includes polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid molecules contained
in cells that ordinarily express the
polypeptide where, for example, the nucleic acid molecule is in a chromosomal
location different from that of
natural cells.
The term "control sequences" refers to DNA sequences necessary for the
expression of an operably linked
coding sequence in a particular host organism. The control sequences that are
suitable for prokaryotes, for
example, include a promoter, optionally an operator sequence, and a ribosome
binding site. Eukaryotic cells are
known to utilize promoters, polyadenylation signals, and enhancers.
Nucleic acid is "operably linked" when it is placed into a functional
relationship with another nucleic acid
sequence. For example, DNA for a presequence or secretory leader is operably
linked to DNA for a polypeptide
if it is expressed as a preprotein that participates in the secretion of the
polypeptide; a promoter or enhancer is
operably linked to a coding sequence if it affects the transcription of the
sequence; or a ribosome binding site is
operably linked to a coding sequence if it is positioned so as to facilitate
translation. Generally, "operably linked"
means that the DNA sequences being linked are contiguous, and, in the case of
a secretory leader, contiguous and
in reading phase. However, enhancers do not have to be contiguous. Linking is
accomplished by ligation at
convenient restriction sites. If such sites do not exist, the synthetic
oligonucleotide adaptors or linkers are used
in accordance with conventional practice.
"Stringency" of hybridization reactions is readily determinable by one of
ordinary skill in the art, and
generally is an empirical calculation dependent upon probe length, washing
temperature, and salt concentration.
In general, longer probes require higher temperatures for proper annealing,
while shorter probes need lower
temperatures. Hybridization generally depends on the ability of denatured DNA
to reanneal when complementary
strands are present in an environment below their melting temperature. The
higher the degree of desired homology
between the probe and hybridizable sequence, the higher the relative
temperature which can be used. As a result,
it follows that higher relative temperatures would tend to make the reaction
conditions more stringent, while lower
29


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
temperatures less so. For additional details and explanation of stringency of
hybridization reactions, see Ausubel
et al., Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, Wiley Interscience Publishers,
(1995).
"Stringent conditions" or "high stringency conditions", as defined herein, may
be identified by those that:
(1) employ low ionic strength and high temperature for washing, for example
0.015 M sodium chloride/0.0015 M
sodium citrate/0.1% sodium dodecyl sulfate at 50 C; (2) employ during
hybridization a denaturing agent, such as
formamide, for example, 50% (v/v) formamide with 0.1% bovine serum albun--
in/0.1% Ficoll/0.1%
polyvinylpyrrolidone/50mM sodium phosphate buffer at pH 6.5 with 750 mM sodium
chloride, 75 mM sodium
citrate at 42 C; or (3) overnight hybridization in a solution that employs 50%
formamide, 5 x SSC (0.75 M NaC1,
0.075 M sodium citrate), 50 mM sodium phosphate (pH 6.8), 0.1% sodium
pyrophosphate, 5 x Denhardt's
solution, sonicated salmon sperm DNA (50 g/ml), 0.1% SDS, and 10% dextran
sulfate at 42 C, with a 10 minute
wash at 42 C in 0.2 x SSC (sodium chloride/sodium citrate) followed by a 10
minute high-stringency wash
consisting of 0.1 x SSC containing EDTA at 55 C.
"Moderately stringent conditions" may be identified as described by Sambrook
et al., Molecular Cloning:
A Laboratory Manual, New York: Cold Spring Harbor Press, 1989, and include the
use of washing solution and
hybridization conditions (e.g., temperature, ionic strength and %SDS) less
stringent that those described above.
An example of moderately stringent conditions is overnight incubation at 37 C
in a solution comprising: 20%
formamide, 5 x SSC (150 mM NaC1,15 mM trisodium citrate), 50 mM sodium
phosphate (pH 7.6), 5 x Denhardt's
solution, 10% dextran sulfate, and 20 mg/ml denatured sheared salmon sperm
DNA, followed by washing the
filters in 1 x SSC at about 37-50 C. The skilled artisan will recognize how to
adjust the temperature, ionic
strength, etc. as necessary to accommodate factors such as probe length and
the like.
The term "epitope tagged" when used herein refers to a chimeric polypeptide
comprising a TAT
polypeptide or anti-TAT antibody fused to a "tag polypeptide". The tag
polypeptide has enough residues to
provide an epitope against which an antibody can be made, yet is short enough
such that it does not interfere with
activity of the polypeptide to which it is fused. The tag polypeptide
preferably also is fairly unique so that the
antibody does not substantially cross-react with other epitopes. Suitable tag
polypeptides generally have at least
six amino acid residues and usually between about 8 and 50 amino acid residues
(preferably, between about 10
and 20 amino acid residues).
"Active" or "activity" for the purposes herein refers to form(s) of a TAT
polypeptide which retain a
biological and/or an immunological activity of native or naturally-occurring
TAT, wherein "biological" activity
refers to abiological function (either inhibitory or stimulatory) caused by a
native or naturally-occurring TAT other
than the ability to induce the production of an antibody against an antigenic
epitope possessed by a native or
naturally-occurring TAT and an "immunological" activity refers to the ability
to induce the production of an
antibody against an antigenic epitope possessed by a native or naturally-
occurring TAT.
The term "antagonist" is used in the broadest sense, and includes any molecule
that partially or fully
blocks, inhibits, or neutralizes a biological activity of a native TAT
polypeptide disclosed herein. In a similar
manner, the term "agonist" is used in the broadest sense and includes any
molecule that mimics a biological activity
of a native TAT polypeptide disclosed herein. Suitable agonist or antagonist
molecules specifically include agonist
or antagonist antibodies or antibody fragments, fragments or amino acid
sequence variants of native TAT
polypeptides, peptides, antisense oligonucleotides, small organic molecules,
etc. Methods for identifying agonists


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
or antagonists of a TAT polypeptide may comprise contacting a TAT polypeptide
with a candidate agonist or
antagonist molecule and measuring a detectable change in one or more
biological activities normally associated
with the TAT polypeptide.
"Treating" or "treatment" or "alleviation" refers to both therapeutic
treatment and prophylactic or
preventative measures, wherein the object is to prevent or slow down (lessen)
the targeted pathologic condition
or disorder. Those in need of treatment include those already with the
disorder as well as those prone to have the
disorder or those in whom the disorder is to be prevented. A subject or mammal
is successfully "treated" for a
TAT polypeptide-expressing cancer if, after receiving a therapeutic amount of
an anti-TAT antibody, TAT binding
oligopeptide or TAT binding organic molecule according to the methods of the
present invention, the patient shows
observable and/or measurable reduction in or absence of one or more of the
following: reduction in the number
of cancer cells or absence of the cancer cells; reduction in the tumor size;
inhibition (i.e., slow to some extent and
preferably stop) of cancer cell infiltration into peripheral organs including
the spread of cancer into soft tissue and
bone; inhibition (i.e., slow to some extent and preferably stop) of tumor
metastasis; inhibition, to some extent, of
tumor growth; and/or relief to some extent, one or more of the symptoms
associated with the specific cancer;
reduced morbidity and mortality, and improvement in quality of life issues. To
the extent the anti-TAT antibody
or TAT binding oligopeptide may prevent growth and/or kill existing cancer
cells, it may be cytostatic and/or
cytotoxic. Reduction of these signs or symptoms may also be felt by the
patient.
The above parameters for assessing successful treatment and improvement in the
disease are readily
measurable by routine procedures familiar to a physician. For cancer therapy,
efficacy can be measured, for
example, by assessing the time to disease progression (TTP) and/or determining
the response rate (RR). Metastasis
can be determined by staging tests and by bone scan and tests for calcium
level and other enzymes to determine
spread to the bone. CT scans can also be done to look for spread to the pelvis
and lymph nodes in the area. Chest
X-rays and measurement of liver enzyme levels by known methods are used to
look for metastasis to the lungs and
liver, respectively. Other routine methods for monitoring the disease include
transrectal ultrasonography (TRUS)
and transrectal needle biopsy (TRNB).
For bladder cancer, which is a more localized cancer, methods to determine
progress of disease include
urinary cytologic evaluation by cystoscopy, monitoring for presence of blood
in the urine, visualization of the
urothelial tract by sonography or an intravenous pyelogram, computed
tomography (CT) and magnetic resonance
imaging (MRI). The presence of distant metastases can be assessed by CT of the
abdomen, chest x-rays, or
radionuclide imaging of the skeleton.
"Chronic" administration refers to administration of the agent(s) in a
continuous mode as opposed to an
acute mode, so as to maintain the initial therapeutic effect (activity) for an
extended period of time. "Intermittent"
administration is treatment that is not consecutively done without
interruption, but rather is cyclic in nature.
"Mammal" for purposes of the treatment of, alleviating the symptoms of or
diagnosis of a cancer refers
to any animal classified as a mammal, including humans, domestic and farm
animals, and zoo, sports, or pet
animals, such as dogs, cats, cattle, horses, sheep, pigs, goats, rabbits, etc.
Preferably, the mammal is human.
Administration "in combination with" one or more further therapeutic agents
includes simultaneous
(concurrent) and consecutive administration in any order.

31


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
"Carriers" as used herein include pharmaceutically acceptable carriers,
excipients, or stabilizers which
are nontoxic to the cell or mammal being exposed thereto at the dosages and
concentrations employed. Often the
physiologically acceptable carrier is an aqueous pH buffered solution.
Examples of physiologically acceptable
carriers include buffers such as phosphate, citrate, and other organic acids;
antioxidants including ascorbic acid;
low molecular weight (less than about 10 residues) polypeptide; proteins, such
as serum albunun, gelatin, or
immunoglobulins; hydrophilic polymers such as polyvinylpyrrolidone; amino
acids such as glycine, glutan-dne,
asparagine, arginine or lysine; monosaccharides, disaccharides, and other
carbohydrates including glucose,
mannose, or dextrins; chelating agents such as EDTA; sugar alcohols such as
mannitol or sorbitol; salt-forming
counterions such as sodium; and/or nonionic surfactants such as TWEENO,
polyethylene glycol (PEG), and
PLURONICS .
By "solid phase" or "solid support" is meant a non-aqueous matrix to which an
antibody, TAT binding
oligopeptide or TAT binding organic molecule of the present invention can
adhere or attach. Examples of solid
phases encompassed herein include those formed partially or entirely of glass
(e.g., controlled pore glass),
polysaccharides (e.g., agarose), polyacrylamides, polystyrene, polyvinyl
alcohol and silicones. In certain
embodiments, depending on the context, the solid phase can comprise the well
of an assay plate; in others it is a
purification column (e.g., an affinity chromatograpliy column). This term also
includes a discontinuous solid phase
of discrete particles, such as those described in U.S. Patent No. 4,275,149.
A"liposome" is a small vesicle composed of various types of lipids,
phospholipids and/or surfactant
which is useful for delivery of a drug (such as a TAT polypeptide, an antibody
tliereto or a TAT binding
oligopeptide) to a mammal. The components of the liposome are commonly
arranged in a bilayer formation,
similar to the lipid arrangement of biological membranes.
A "small" molecule or "small" organic molecule is defined herein to have
amolecular weight below about
500 Daltons.
An "effective amount" of a polypeptide, antibody, TAT binding oligopeptide,
TAT binding organic
molecule or an agonist or antagonist thereof as disclosed herein is an amount
sufficient to carry out a specifically
stated purpose. An "effective amount" may be determined empirically and in a
routine manner, in relation to the
stated purpose.
The term "therapeutically effective amount" refers to an amount of an
antibody, polypeptide, TAT binding
oligopeptide, TAT binding organic molecule or other drug effective to "treat"
a disease or disorder in a subject
or mammal. In the case of cancer, the therapeutically effective amount of the
drug may reduce the number of
cancer cells; reduce the tumor size; inhibit (i.e., slow to some extent and
preferably stop) cancer cell infiltration
into peripheral organs; inhibit (i.e., slow to some extent and preferably
stop) tumor metastasis; inhibit, to some
extent, tumor growth; and/or relieve to some extent one or more of the
symptoms associated with the cancer. See
the definition herein of "treating". To the extent the drug may prevent growth
and/or kill existing cancer cells, it
may be cytostatic and/or cytotoxic.
A "growth inhibitory amount" of an anti-TAT antibody, TAT polypeptide, TAT
binding oligopeptide or
TAT binding organic molecule is an amount capable of inhibiting the growth of
a cell, especially tumor, e.g.,
cancer cell, either in vitro or in vivo. A "growth inhibitory amount" of an
anti-TAT antibody, TAT polypeptide,
TAT binding oligopeptide or TAT binding organic molecule for purposes of
inhibiting neoplastic cell growth may
32


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
be determined empirically and in a routine manner.
A"cytotoxic amount" of an anti-TAT antibody, TAT polypeptide, TAT binding
oligopeptide or TAT
binding organic molecule is an amount capable of causing the destruction of a
cell, especially tumor, e.g., cancer
cell, either in vitro or ira vivo. A "cytotoxic amount" of an anti-TAT
antibody, TAT polypeptide, TAT binding
oligopeptide or TAT binding organic molecule for purposes of inhibiting
neoplastic cell growth may be determined
empirically and in a routine manner.
The term "antibody" is used in the broadest sense and specifically covers, for
example, single anti-TAT
monoclonal antibodies (including agonist, antagonist, and neutralizing
antibodies), anti-TAT antibody
compositions with polyepitopic specificity, polyclonal antibodies, single
chain anti-TAT antibodies, and fragments
of anti-TAT antibodies (see below) as long as they exhibit the desired
biological or immunological activity. The
term "immunoglobulin" (Ig) is used interchangeable with antibody herein.
An "isolated antibody" is one which has been identified and separated and/or
recovered from a component
of its natural environment. Contaminant components of its natural environment
are materials which would interfere
with diagnostic or therapeutic uses for the antibody, and may include enzymes,
hormones, and other proteinaceous
or nonproteinaceous solutes. In preferred embodiments, the antibody will be
purified (1) to greater than 95% by
weight of antibody as determined by the Lowry method, and most preferably more
than 99% by weight, (2) to a
degree sufficient to obtain at least 15 residues of N-terminal or internal
anuno acid sequence by use of a spinning
cup sequenator, or (3) to homogeneity by SDS-PAGE under reducing or
nonreducing conditions using Coomassie
blue or, preferably, silver stain. Isolated antibody includes the antibody in
situ within recombinant cells since at
least one component of the antibody's natural environment will not be present.
Ordinarily, however, isolated
antibody will be prepared by at least one purification step.
The basic 4-chain antibody unit is a heterotetrameric glycoprotein composed of
two identical light (L)
chains and two identical heavy (H) chains (an IgM antibody consists of 5 of
the basic heterotetramer unit along
with an additional polypeptide called J chain, and therefore contain 10
antigen binding sites, while secreted IgA
antibodies can polymerize to form polyvalent assemblages comprising 2-5 of the
basic 4-chain units along with
J chain). In the case of IgGs, the 4-chain unit is generally about 150,000
daltons. Each L chain is linked to a H
chain by one covalent disulfide bond, while the two H chains are linked to
each other by one or more disulfide
bonds depending on the H chain isotype. Each H and L chain also has regularly
spaced intrachain disulfide
bridges. Each H chain has at the N-terminus, a variable domain (VH) followed
by three constant domains (CH) for
each of the a and y chains and four CH domains for and e isotypes. Each L
chain has at the N-terniinus, a
variable domain (Vi,) followed by a constant domain (C,) at its other end. The
VL is aligned with the VH and the
CL is aligned with the first constant domain of the heavy chain (CHl).
Particular amino acid residues are believed
to form an interface between the light chain and heavy chain variable domains.
The pairing of a VH and VL
together forms a single antigen-binding site. For the structure and properties
of the different classes of antibodies,
see, e.g., Basic and Clinical Immunology, 8th edition, Daniel P. Stites, Abba
I. Terr and Tristram G. Parslow
(eds.), Appleton & Lange, Norwalk, CT, 1994, page 71 and Chapter 6.
The L chain from any vertebrate species can be assigned to one of two clearly
distinct types, called kappa
and lambda, based on the amino acid sequences of their constant domains.
Depending on the amino acid sequence
of the constant domain of their heavy chains (CH), immunoglobulins can be
assigned to different classes or
33


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
isotypes. There are five classes of immunoglobulins: IgA, IgD, IgE, IgG, and
IgM, having heavy chains designated
a, S, e, y, and , respectively. The y and a classes are further divided into
subclasses on the basis of relatively
minor differences in CH sequence and function, e.g., humans express the
following subclasses: IgGl, IgG2, IgG3,
IgG4, IgAl, and IgA2.
The term "variable" refers to the fact that certain segments of the variable
domains differ extensively in
sequence among antibodies. The V domain mediates antigen binding and define
specificity of a particular antibody
for its particular antigen. However, the variability is not evenly distributed
across the 110-amino acid span of the
variable domains. Instead, the V regions consist of relatively invariant
stretches called framework regions (FRs)
of 15-30 amino acids separated by shorter regions of extreme variability
called "hypervariable regions" that are
each 9-12 amino acids long. The variable domains of native heavy and light
chains each comprise four FRs,
largely adopting aP-sheet configuration, connected by three hypervariable
regions, which form loops connecting,
and in some cases forming part of, the (3-sheet structure. The hypervariable
regions in each chain are held together
in close proximity by the FRs and, with the hypervariable regions from the
other chain, contribute to the formation
of the antigen-binding site of antibodies (see Kabat et al., Seguences of
Proteins of Immunolo~ydcal Interest, 5th
Ed. Public Health Service, National Institutes of Health, Bethesda, MD.
(1991)). The constant domains are not
involved directly in binding an antibody to an antigen, but exhibit various
effector functions, such as participation
of the antibody in antibody dependent cellular cytotoxicity (ADCC).
The term "hypervariable region" when used herein refers to the amino acid
residues of an antibody which
are responsible for antigen-binding. The hypervariable region generally
comprises amino acid residues from a
"complementarity determining region" or "CDR" (e.g. around about residues 24-
34 (Ll), 50-56 (L2) and 89-97
(L3) in the VL, and around about 1-35 (Hl), 50-65 (H2) and 95-102 (H3) in the
VH; Kabat et al., Sequences of
Proteins of Immunological Interest, 5th Ed. Public Health Service, National
Institutes of Health, Bethesda, MD.
(1991)) and/or those residues from a "hypervariable loop" (e.g. residues 26-32
(Ll), 50-52 (L2) and 91-96 (L3)
in the VL, and 26-32 (H1), 53-55 (H2) and 96-101 (H3) in the VH; Chothia and
Lesk J. Mol. Biol. 196:901-917
(1987)).
The term "monoclonal antibody" as used herein refers to an antibody obtained
from a population of
substantially homogeneous antibodies, i.e., the individual antibodies
comprising the population are identical except
forpossible naturally occurring mutations that may be present in minor
amounts. Monoclonal antibodies are highly
specific, being directed against a single antigenic site. Furthermore, in
contrast to polyclonal antibody preparations
which include different antibodies directed against different determinants
(epitopes), each monoclonal antibody
is directed against a single determinant on the antigen. In addition to their
specificity, the monoclonal antibodies
are advantageous in that they may be synthesized uncontaminated by other
antibodies. The modifier "monoclonal"
is not to be construed as requiring production of the antibody by any
particular method. For example, the
monoclonal antibodies useful in the present invention may be prepared by the
hybridoma methodology first
described by Kohler et al., Nature, 256:495 (1975), or may be made using
recombinant DNA methods in bacterial,
eukaryotic animal or plant cells (see, e.g., U.S. Patent No. 4,816,567). The
"monoclonal antibodies" may also be
isolated from phage antibody libraries using the techniques described in
Clackson et al., Nature, 352:624-628
(1991) and Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol., 222:581-597 (1991), for example.

34


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
The monoclonal antibodies herein include "chimeric" antibodies in which a
portion of the heavy and/or
light chain is identical with or homologous to corresponding sequences in
antibodies derived from a particular
species or belonging to a particular antibody class or subclass, while the
remainder of the chain(s) is identical with
or homologous to corresponding sequences in antibodies derived from another
species or belonging to another
antibody class or subclass, as well as fragments of such antibodies, so long
as they exhibit the desired biological
activity (see U.S. Patent No. 4,816,567; and Morrison et al., Proc. Natl.
Acad. Sci. USA, 81:6851-6855 (1984)).
Chimeric antibodies of interestherein include "primatized" antibodies
comprising variable domain antigen-binding
sequences derived from a non-human primate (e.g. Old World Monkey, Ape etc),
and human constant region
sequences.
An "intact" antibody is one which comprises an antigen-binding site as well as
a C, and at least heavy
chain constant domains, CH1, CH2 and CH3. The constant domains may be native
sequence constant domains (e. g.
human native sequence constant domains) or amino acid sequence variant
thereof. Preferably, the intact antibody
has one or more effector functions.
"Antibody fragments" comprise a portion of an intact antibody, preferably the
antigen binding or variable
region of the intact antibody. Examples of antibody fragments include Fab,
Fab', F(ab')z, and Fv fragments;
diabodies; linear antibodies (see U.S. Patent No. 5,641,870, Example 2; Zapata
et al., Protein Eng. 8(10):
1057-1062 [1995]); single-chain antibody molecules; and multispecific
antibodies formed from antibody
fragments.
Papain digestion of antibodies produces two identical antigen-binding
fragments, called "Fab" fragments,
and a residual "Fe" fragment, a designation reflecting the ability to
crystallize readily. The Fab fragment consists
of an entire L chain along with the variable region domain of the H chain
(VH), and the first constant domain of
one heavy chain (CH1). Each Fab fragment is monovalent with respect to antigen
binding, i.e., it has a single
antigen-binding site. Pepsin treatment of an antibody yields a single large
F(ab')2 fragment wliich roughly
corresponds to two disulfide linked Fab fragments having divalent antigen-
binding activity and is still capable of
cross-linking antigen. Fab' fragments differ from Fab fragments by having
additional few residues at the carboxy
terminus of the CHl domain including one or more cysteines from the antibody
hinge region. Fab'-SH is the
designation herein for Fab' in which the cysteine residue(s) of the constant
domains bear a free thiol group. F(ab')z
antibody fragments originally were produced as pairs of Fab' fragments which
have hinge cysteines between them.
Other chemical couplings of antibody fragments are also known.
The Fe fragment comprises the carboxy-terminal portions of both H chains held
together by disulfides.
The effector functions of antibodies are determined by sequences in the Fc
region, which region is also the part
recognized by Fe receptors (FcR) found on certain types of cells.
"Fv" is the minimum antibody fragment which contains a complete antigen-
recognition and -binding site.
This fragment consists of a dimer of one heavy- and one liglit-chain variable
region domain in tight, non-covalent
association. From the folding of these two domains emanate six hypervariable
loops (3loops each from the H and
L chain) that contribute the amino acid residues for antigen binding and
confer antigen binding specificity to the
antibody. However, even a single variable domain (or half of an Fv comprising
only three CDRs specific for an
antigen) has the ability to recognize and bind antigen, although at a lower
affinity than the entire binding site.



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
"Single-chain Fv" also abbreviated as "sFv" or "scFv" are antibody fragments
that comprise the VH and
V, antibody domains connected into a single polypeptide chain. Preferably, the
sFv polypeptide further comprises
a polypeptide linker between the VH and Vi, domains which enables the sFv to
form the desired structure for
antigen binding. For a review of sFv, see Pluckthun in The Pharmacology of
Monoclonal Antibodies, vol. 113,
Rosenburg and Moore eds., Springer-Verlag, New York, pp. 269-315 (1994);
Borrebaeck 1995, infra.
The term "diabodies" refers to small antibody fragments prepared by
constructing sFv fragments (see
preceding paragraph) with short linkers (about 5-10 residues) between the VH
and V, domains such that inter-chain
but not intra-chain pairing of the V domains is achieved, resulting in a
bivalent fragment, i.e., fragment having two
antigen-binding sites. Bispecific diabodies are heterodimers of two
"crossover" sFv fragments in which the VH
and V, domains of the two antibodies are present on different polypeptide
chains. Diabodies are described more
fully in, for example, EP 404,097; WO 93/11161; and Hollinger et al., Proc.
Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 90:6444-6448
(1993).
"Humanized" forms of non-human (e.g., rodent) antibodies are chimeric
antibodies that contain minimal
sequence derived from the non-human antibody. For the most part, humanized
antibodies are human
immunoglobulins (recipient antibody) in which residues from a hypervariable
region of the recipient are replaced
by residues from a hypervariable region of a non-human species (donor
antibody) such as mouse, rat, rabbit or non-
human primate having the desired antibody specificity, affinity, and
capability. In some instances, framework
region (FR) residues of the human immunoglobulin are replaced by corresponding
non-human residues.
Furthermore, humanized antibodies may comprise residues that are not found in
the recipient antibody or in the
donor antibody. These modifications are made to further refine antibody
performance. In general, the humanized
antibody will comprise substantially all of at least one, and typically two,
variable domains, in which all or
substantially all of the hypervariable loops correspond to those of a non-
human inununoglobulin and all or
substantially all of the FRs are those of a human immunoglobulin sequence. The
humanized antibody optionally
also will comprise at least a portion of an immunoglobulin constant region
(Fc), typically that of a human
immunoglobulin. For further details, see Jones et al., Nature 321:522-525
(1986); Riechmann et al., Nature
332:323-329 (1988); and Presta, Curr. Op. Struct. Biol. 2:593-596 (1992).
A "species-dependent antibody," e.g., a mammalian anti-human IgE antibody, is
an antibody which has
a stronger binding affinity for an antigen from a first mammalian species than
it has for a homologue of that antigen
from a second mammalian species. Normally, the species-dependent antibody
"bind specifically" to a human
antigen (i.e., has a binding affinity (Kd) value of no more than about 1 x 10'
M, preferably no more than about
1 x 10-$ and most preferably no more than about 1 x 10-9 M) but has a binding
affinity for a homologue of the
antigen from a second non-human mammalian species which is at least about 50
fold, or at least about 500 fold,
or at least about 1000 fold, weaker than its binding affinity for the human
antigen. The species-dependent antibody
can be of any of the various types of antibodies as defined above, but
preferably is a humanized or human antibody.
A "TAT binding oligopeptide" is an oligopeptide that binds, preferably
specifically, to a TAT polypeptide
as described herein. TAT binding oligopeptides may be chemically synthesized
using known oligopeptide
synthesis methodology or may be prepared and purified using recombinant
technology. TAT binding oligopeptides
are usually at least about 5 amino acids in length, alternatively at least
about 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16,
17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35,
36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46,
36


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
47, 48, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65,
66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76,
77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 84, 85, 86, 87, 88, 89, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95,
96, 97, 98, 99, or 100 amino acids in
length or more, wherein such oligopeptides that are capable of binding,
preferably specifically, to a TAT
'polypeptide as described herein. TAT binding oligopeptides may be identified
without undue experimentation
using well known techniques. In this regard, it is noted that techniques for
screening oligopeptide libraries for
oligopeptides that are capable of specifically binding to a polypeptide target
are well known in the art (see, e.g.,
U.S. Patent Nos. 5,556,762, 5,750,373, 4,708,871, 4,833,092, 5,223,409,
5,403,484, 5,571,689, 5,663,143; PCT
Publication Nos. WO 84/03506 and W084/03564; Geysen et al., Proc. Natl. Acad.
Sci. U.S.A., 81:3998-4002
(1984); Geysen et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A., 82:178-182 (1985);
Geysen et al., in Synthetic Peptides as
Antigens, 130-149 (1986); Geysen et al., J. Immunol. Meth., 102:259-274
(1987); Schoofs et al., J. Inununol.,
140:611-616 (1988), Cwirla, S. E. et al. (1990) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA,
87:6378; Lowman, H.B. et al. (1991)
Biochemistry, 30:10832; Clackson, T. et al. (1991) Nature, 352: 624; Marks, J.
D. et al. (1991), J. Mol. Biol.,
222:581; Kang, A.S. et al. (1991) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 88:8363, and
Sniitli, G. P. (1991) Current Opin.
Biotechnol., 2:668).
A "TAT binding organic molecule" is an organic molecule other than an
oligopeptide or antibody as
defined herein that binds, preferably specifically, to a TAT polypeptide as
described herein. TAT binding organic
molecules may be identified and cliemically synthesized using known
methodology (see, e.g., PCT Publication
Nos. W000/00823 and W000/39585). TAT binding organic molecules are usually
less than about 2000 daltons
in size, alternatively less than about 1500, 750, 500, 250 or 200 daltons in
size, wherein such organic molecules
that are capable of binding, preferably specifically, to a TAT polypeptide as
described herein may be identified
without undue experimentation using well known techniques. In this regard, it
is noted that techniques for
screening organic molecule libraries for molecules that are capable of binding
to a polypeptide target are well
known in the art (see, e.g., PCT Publication Nos. W000/00823 and W000/39585).
An antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule "which binds" an antigen
of interest, e.g. a tumor-
associated polypeptide antigen target, is one that binds the antigen with
sufficient affinity such that the antibody,
oligopeptide or other organic molecule is useful as a diagnostic and/or
therapeutic agent in targeting a cell or tissue
expressing the antigen, and does not significantly cross-react with other
proteins. In such embodiments, the extent
of binding of the antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule to a "non-
target" protein will be less than about
10% of the binding of the antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule to
its particular target protein as
determined by fluorescence activated cell sorting (FACS) analysis or
radioimmunoprecipitation (RIA). With
regard to the binding of an antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule
to a target molecule, the term "specific
binding" or "specifically binds to" or is "specific for" a particular
polypeptide or an epitope on a particular
polypeptide target means binding that is measurably different from a non-
specific interaction. Specific binding
can be measured, for example, by determining binding of a molecule compared to
binding of a control molecule,
which generally is a molecule of similar structure that does not have binding
activity. For example, specific
binding can be determined by competition with a control molecule that is
similar to the target, for example, an
excess of non-labeled target. In this case, specific binding is indicated if
the binding of the labeled target to a
probe is competitively inhibited by excess unlabeled target. The term
"specific binding" or "specifically binds to"
or is "specific for" a particular polypeptide or an epitope on a particular
polypeptide target as used herein can be
37


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
exhibited, for example, by a molecule having a Kd for the target of at least
about 10-'M, alternatively at least about
10'S M, alternatively at least about 10-6 M, alternatively at least about 10-'
M, alternatively at least about 10"$ M,
alternatively at least about 10-9 M, alternatively at least about 10-10 M,
alternatively at least about 10-" M,
alternatively at least about 10-12 M, or greater. In one embodiment, the term
"specific binding" refers to binding
where a molecule binds to a particular polypeptide or epitope on a particular
polypeptide without substantially
binding to any other polypeptide or polypeptide epitope.
An antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule that "inhibits the growth
of tumor cells expressing
a TAT polypeptide" or a"growth inhibitory" antibody, oligopeptide or other
organic molecule is one which results
in measurable growth inhibition of cancer cells expressing or overexpressing
the appropriate TAT polypeptide.
The TAT polypeptide may be a transmembrane polypeptide expressed on the
surface of a cancer cell or may be
a polypeptide that is produced and secreted by a cancer cell. Preferred growth
inhibitory anti-TAT antibodies,
oligopeptides or organic molecules inhibit growth of TAT-expressing tumor
cells by greater than 20%, preferably
from about 20% to about 50%, and even more preferably, by greater than 50%
(e.g., from about 50% to about
100%) as compared to the appropriate control, the control typically being
tumor cells not treated with the antibody,
oligopeptide or other organic molecule being tested. In one embodiment, growth
inhibition can be measured at
an antibody concentration of about 0.1 to 30 g/ml or about 0.5 nM to 200 nM
in cell culture, where the growth
inhibition is determined 1-10 days after exposure of the tumor cells to the
antibody. Growth inhibition of tumor
cells in vivo can be deterniined in various ways such as is described in the
Experimental Examples section below.
The antibody is growth inhibitory in vivo if administration of the anti-TAT
antibody at about 1 g/kg to about 100
mg/kg body weight results in reduction in tumor size or tumor cell
proliferation within about 5 days to 3 months
from the first administration of the antibody, preferably within about 5 to 30
days.
An antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule which "induces apoptosis"
is one which induces
programmed cell death as determined by binding of annexin V, fragmentation of
DNA, cell shrinkage, dilation of
endoplasmic reticulum, cell fragmentation, and/or formation of membrane
vesicles (called apoptotic bodies). The
cell is usually one which overexpresses a TAT polypeptide. Preferably the cell
is a tumor cell, e.g., a prostate,
breast, ovarian, stomach, endometrial, lung, lddney, colon, bladder cell.
Various methods are available for
evaluating the cellular events associated with apoptosis. For example,
phosphatidyl serine (PS) translocation can
be measured by annexin binding; DNA fiagmentation can be evaluated through.
DNA laddering; and
nuclear/chromatin condensation along with DNA fragmentation can be evaluated
by any increase in hypodiploid
cells. Preferably, the antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule which
induces apoptosis is one which
results in about 2 to 50 fold, preferably about 5 to 50 fold, and most
preferably about 10 to 50 fold, induction of
annexin binding relative to untreated cell in an annexin binding assay.
Antibody "effector functions" refer to those biological activities
attributable to the Fc region (a native
sequence Fc region or amino acid sequence variant Fc region) of an antibody,
and vary with the antibody isotype.
Examples of antibody effector functions include: C l q binding and complement
dependent cytotoxicity; Fc receptor
binding; antibody-dependent cell-mediated cytotoxicity (ADCC); phagocytosis;
down regulation of cell surface
receptors (e.g., B cell receptor); and B cell activation.
"Antibody-dependent cell-mediated cytotoxicity" or "ADCC" refers to a form of
cytotoxicity in which
secreted Ig bound onto Fc receptors (FcRs) present on certain cytotoxic cells
(e.g., Natural Killer (NK) cells,
38


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
neutrophils, and macrophages) enable these cytotoxic effector cells to bind
specifically to an antigen-bearing target
cell and subsequently kill the target cell with cytotoxins. The antibodies
"arm" the cytotoxic cells and are
absolutely required for such killing. The primary cells for mediating ADCC, NK
cells, express FcyRIII only,
whereas monocytes express FcyRI, FcyRII and FcyRIII. FcR expression on
hematopoietic cells is summarized
in Table 3 on page 464 of Ravetch and Kinet, Annu. Rev. Immunol. 9:457-92
(1991). To assess ADCC activity
of a molecule of interest, an in vitro ADCC assay, such as that described in
US Patent No. 5,500,362 or 5,821,337
may be performed. Useful effector cells for such assays include peripheral
blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) and
Natural Killer (NK) cells. Alternatively, or additionally, ADCC activity of
the molecule of interest may be
assessed in vivo, e.g., in a animal model such as that disclosed in Clynes et
al. (USA) 95:652-656 (1998).
"Fc receptor" or "FcR" describes a receptor that binds to the Fc region of an
antibody. The preferred FcR
is a native sequence human FcR. Moreover, a preferred FcR is one which binds
an IgG antibody (a gamma
receptor) and includes receptors of the FcyRI, Fc-yRII and FcyRIIl subclasses,
including allelic variants and
alternatively spliced forms of these receptors. FcyRII receptors include
FcyRIIA (an "activating receptor") and
FcyRIIB (an "inhibiting receptor"), which have similar amino acid sequences
that differ primarily in the
cytoplasmic domains thereof. Activating receptor FcyRIIA contains an
immunoreceptor tyrosine-based activation
motif (ITAM) in its cytoplasmic domain. Inhibiting receptor FcyRIIB contains
an immunoreceptor tyrosine-based
inhibition motif (ITIM) in its cytoplasmic domain. (see review M. in Daeron,
Annu. Rev. Immunol. 15:203-234
(1997)). FcRs are reviewed in Ravetch and Kinet, Annu. Rev. Immunol. 9:457-492
(1991); Capel et al.,
Immunomethods 4:25-34 (1994); and de Haas et al., J. Lab. Clin. Med. 126:330-
41 (1995). Other FcRs, including
those to be identified in the future, are encompassed by the term "FcR"
herein. The term also includes the neonatal
receptor, FcRn, which is responsible for the transfer of maternal IgGs to the
fetus (Guyer et al., J. Immunol.
117:587 (1976) and Kim et al., J. Immunol. 24:249 (1994)).
"Human effector cells" are leukocytes which express one or more FcRs and
perform effector functions.
Preferably, the cells express at least FcyRIII and perform ADCC effector
function. Examples of human leukocytes
which mediate ADCC include peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC), natural
killer (NK) cells, monocytes,
cytotoxic T cells and neutrophils; with PBMCs and NK cells being preferred.
The effector cells may be isolated
from a native source, e.g., from blood.
"Complement dependent cytotoxicity" or "CDC" refers to the lysis of a target
cell in the presence of
complement. Activation of the classical complement patliway is initiated by
the binding of the first component
of the complement system (Clq) to antibodies (of the appropriate subclass)
which are bound to their cognate
antigen. To assess complement activation, a CDC assay, e.g., as described in
Gazzano-Santoro et al., J. Immunol.
Methods 202:163 (1996), may be performed.
The terms "cancer" and "cancerous" refer to or describe the physiological
condition in mammals that is
typically characterized by unregulated cell growth. Examples of cancer
include, but are not limited to, carcinoma,
lymphoma, blastoma, sarcoma, and leukemia or lymphoid malignancies. More
particular examples of such cancers
include squamous cell cancer (e.g., epithelial squamous cell cancer), lung
cancer including small-cell lung cancer,
non-small cell lung cancer, adenocarcinoma of the lung and squamous carcinoma
of the lung, cancer of the
peritoneum, hepatocellular cancer, gastric or stomach cancer including
gastrointestinal cancer, pancreatic cancer,
glioblastoma, cervical cancer, ovarian cancer, liver cancer, bladder cancer,
cancer of the urinary tract, hepatoma,
39


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
breast cancer, colon cancer, rectal cancer, colorectal cancer, endometrial or
uterine carcinoma, salivary gland
carcinoma, kidney or renal cancer, prostate cancer, vulval cancer, thyroid
cancer, hepatic carcinoma, anal
carcinoma, penile carcinoma, melanoma, multiple myeloma and B-cell lymphoma,
brain, as well as head and neck
cancer, and associated metastases.
The terms "cell proliferative disorder" and "proliferative disorder" refer to
disorders that are associated
with some degree of abnormal cell proliferation. In one embodiment, the cell
proliferative disorder is cancer.
"Tumor", as used herein, refers to all neoplastic cell growth and
proliferation, whether malignant or
benign, and all pre-cancerous and cancerous cells and tissues.
An antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule which "induces cell death"
is one which causes a
viable cell to become nonviable. The cell is one which expresses a TAT
polypeptide, preferably a cell that
overexpresses a TAT polypeptide as compared to a normal cell of the same
tissue type. The TAT polypeptide may
be a transmembrane polypeptide=expressed on the surface of a cancer cell or
may be a polypeptide that is produced
and secreted by a cancer cell. Preferably, the cell is a cancer cell, e.g., a
breast, ovarian, stomach, endometrial,
salivary gland, lung, kidney, colon, thyroid, pancreatic or bladder cell. Cell
death in vitro may be determined in
the absence of complement and immune effector cells to distinguish cell death
induced by antibody-dependent cell-
mediated cytotoxicity (ADCC) or complement dependent cytotoxicity (CDC). Thus,
the assay for cell death may
be performed using heat inactivated serum (i.e., in the absence of complement)
and in the absence of immune
effector cells. To determine whether the antibody, oligopeptide or other
organic molecule is able to induce cell
death, loss of membrane integrity as evaluated by uptake of propidium iodide
(PI), trypan blue (see Moore et al.
Cytotechnology 17:1-11(1995)) or7AAD canbe assessed relative to untreated
cells. Preferred cell death-inducing
antibodies, oligopeptides or other organic molecules are those which induce PI
uptake in the PI uptake assay in
BT474 cells.
A "TAT-expressing cell" is a cell which expresses an endogenous or transfected
TAT polypeptide either
on the cell surface or in a secreted form. A "TAT-expressing cancer" is a
cancer comprising cells that have a TAT
polypeptide present on the cell surface or that produce and secrete a TAT
polypeptide. A "TAT-expressing
cancer" optionally produces sufficient levels of TAT polypeptide on the
surface of cells thereof, such that an anti-
TAT antibody, aligopeptide ot otlier organic molecule can bind thereto and
have a therapeutic effect with respect
to the cancer. In another embodiment, a "TAT-expressing cancer" optionally
produces and secretes sufficient
levels of TAT polypeptide, such that an anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide ot
other organic molecule antagonist can
bind thereto and have a therapeutic effect with respect to the cancer. With
regard to the latter, the antagonist may
be an antisense oligonucleotide which reduces, inhibits or prevents production
and secretion of the secreted TAT
polypeptide by tumor cells. A cancer which "overexpresses" a TAT polypeptide
is one which has significantly
higher levels of TAT polypeptide at the cell surface thereof, or produces and
secretes, compared to a noncancerous
cell of the same tissue type. Such overexpression may be caused by gene
amplification or by increased
transcription or translation. TAT polypeptide overexpression may be
deterniined in a diagnostic or prognostic
assay by evaluating increased levels of the TAT protein present on the surface
of a cell, or secreted by the cell
(e.g., via an immunohistochemistry assay using anti-TAT antibodies prepared
against an isolated TAT polypeptide
which may be prepared using recombinant DNA technology from an isolated
nucleic acid encoding the TAT
polypeptide; FACS analysis, etc.). Alternatively, or additionally, one may
measure levels of TAT polypeptide-


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
encoding nucleic acid or mRNA in the cell, e.g., via fluorescent in situ
hybridization using a nucleic acid based
probe corresponding to a TAT-encoding nucleic acid or the complement thereof;
(FISH; see W098/45479
published October, 1998), Southern blotting, Northern blotting, or polymerase
chain reaction (PCR) techniques,
such as real time quantitative PCR (RT-PCR). One may also study TAT
polypeptide overexpression by measuring
shed antigen in a biological fluid such as serum, e.g, using antibody-based
assays (see also, e.g., U.S. Patent No.
4,933,294 issued June 12,1990; W091/05264 published April 18, 1991; U.S.
Patent 5,401,638 issued March 28,
1995; and Sias et al., J. Immunol. Methods 132:73-80 (1990)). Aside fromthe
above assays, various in vivo assays
are available to the skilled practitioner. For example, one may expose cells
witliin the body of the patient to an
antibody which is optionally labeled with a detectable label, e.g., a
radioactive isotope, and binding of the antibody
to cells in the patient can be evaluated, e.g., by external scanning for
radioactivity or by analyzing a biopsy taken
from a patient previously exposed to the antibody.
As used herein, the term"immunoadhesin" designates antibody-like molecules
which combine the binding
specificity of a heterologous protein (an "adhesin") with the effector
functions of immunoglobulin constant
domains. Structurally, the immunoadhesins comprise a fusion of an amino acid
sequence with the desired binding
specificity which is other than the antigen recognition and binding site of an
antibody (i.e., is "heterologous"), and
an immunoglobulin constant domain sequence. The adhesin part of an
inununoadhesin molecule typically is a
contiguous amino acid sequence comprising at least the binding site of a
receptor or a ligand. The immunoglobulin
constant domain sequence in the immunoadhesin may be obtained from any
immunoglobulin, such as IgG- 1, IgG-
2, IgG-3, or IgG-4 subtypes, IgA (including IgA-1 and IgA-2), IgE, IgD or IgM.
The word "label" when used herein refers to a detectable compound or
composition which is conjugated
directly or indirectly to the antibody, oligopeptide or other organic molecule
so as to generate a "labeled" antibody,
oligopeptide or other organic molecule. The label may be detectable by itself
(e.g. radioisotope labels or
fluorescent labels) or, in the case of an enzymatic label, may catalyze
chemical alteration of a substrate compound
or composition which is detectable.
The term "cytotoxic agent" as used herein refers to a substance that inhibits
or prevents the function of
211 131 125
cells and/or causes destruction of cells. The term is intended to include
radioactive isotopes (e.g., At , I , I
Y90, Re186, Rel$$, Sm153, Bi212 P32 and radioactive isotopes of Lu),
chemotherapeutic agents, enzymes and
fragments thereof such as nucleolytic enzymes, antibiotics, and toxins such as
small molecule toxins or
enzymatically active toxins of bacterial, fungal, plant or animal origin,
including fragments and/or variants thereof,
and the various antitumor or anticancer agents disclosed below. Other
cytotoxic agents are described below. A
tumoricidal agent causes destruction of tumor cells.
A "chemotherapeutic agent" is a cheniical compound useful in the treatment of
cancer. Examples of
chemotherapeutic agents include alkylating agents such as thiotepa and CYTOXAN
cyclosphosphamide; alkyl
sulfonates such as busulfan, improsulfan and piposulfan; aziridines such as
benzodopa, carboquone, meturedopa,
and uredopa; ethylenimines and methylamelamines including altretamine,
triethylenemelamine,
trietylenephosphoramide, triethiylenethiophosphoramide and
trimethylolomelamine; acetogenins (especially
bullatacin and bullatacinone); delta-9-tetrahydrocannabinol
(dronabinol,lVIARINOL ); beta-lapachone; lapachol;
colchicines; betulinic acid; a camptothecin (including the synthetic analogue
topotecan (HYCAMTIN ), CPT-11
(irinotecan, CAMPTOSAR ), acetylcamptothecin, scopolectin, and 9-
aminocamptothecin); bryostatin; callystatin;
41


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
CC-1065 (including its adozelesin, carzelesin and bizelesin synthetic
analogues); podophyllotoxin; podophyllinic
acid; teniposide; cryptophycins (particularly cryptophycin 1 and cryptophycin
8); dolastatin; duocarmycin
(including the synthetic analogues, KW-2189 and CB1-TM1); eleutherobin;
pancratistatin; a sarcodictyin;
spongistatin; nitrogen mustards such as chlorambucil, chlornaphazine,
cholophosphamide, estramustine,
ifosfamide, mechlorethamine, mechlorethamine oxide hydrochloride, melphalan,
novembichin, phenesterine,
prednimustine, trofosfamide, uracil mustard; nitrosureas such as carmustine,
chlorozotocin, fotemustine, lomustine,
nimustine, and ranimnustine; antibiotics such as the enediyne antibiotics (e.
g., calicheamicin, especially
calicheamicin gammalI and calicheamicin omegaIl (see, e.g., Agnew, Chem Intl.
Ed. Engl., 33:183-186 (1994));
dynemicin, including dynemicin A; an esperamicin; as well as neocarzinostatin
chromophore and related
chromoprotein enediyne antiobiotic chromophores), aclacinomysins, actinomycin,
authramycin, azaserine,
bleomycins, cactinomycin, carabicin, carminomycin, carzinophilin,
chromomycinis, dactinomycin, daunorubicin,
detorubicin, 6-diazo-5-oxo-L-norleucine, ADRIAMYCINO doxorubicin (including
morpholino-doxorubicin,
cyanomorpholino-doxorubicin, 2-pyrrolino-doxorubicin and deoxydoxorubicin),
epirubicin, esorubicin, idarubicin,
marcellomycin, mitomycins such as mitomycin C, mycophenolic acid, nogalamycin,
olivomycins, peplomycin,
potfiromycin, puromycin, quelamycin, rodorubicin, streptonigrin, streptozocin,
tubercidin, ubenimex, zinostatin,
zorubicin; anti-metabolites such as methotrexate and 5-fluorouracil (5-FU);
folic acid analogues such as
denopterin, methotrexate, pteropterin, trimetrexate; purine analogs such as
fludarabine, 6-mercaptopurine,
thiamiprine, thioguanine; pyrimidine analogs such as ancitabine, azacitidine,
6-azauridine, carmofur, cytarabine,
dideoxyuridine, doxifluridine, enocitabine, floxuridine; androgens such as
calusterone, dromostanolone propionate,
epitiostanol, mepitiostane, testolactone; anti- adrenals such as
aminoglutethimide, mitotane, trilostane; folic acid
replenisher such as frolinic acid; aceglatone; aldophosphamide glycoside;
aminolevulinic acid; eniluracil;
amsacrine; bestrabucil; bisantrene; edatraxate; defofamine; demecolcine;
diaziquone; elfornithine; elliptinium
acetate; an epothilone; etoglucid; gallium nitrate; hydroxyurea; lentinan;
lonidainine; maytansinoids such as
maytansine and ansamitocins; mitoguazone; mitoxantrone; mopidanmol;
nitraerine; pentostatin; phenamet;
pirarubicin; losoxantrone; 2-ethylhydrazide; procarbazine; PSKO polysaccharide
complex (JHS Natural Products,
Eugene, OR); razoxane; rhizoxin; sizofiran; spirogermanium; tenuazonic acid;
triaziquone;
2,2',2"-trichlorotriethylamine; trichothecenes (especially T-2 toxin,
verracurin A, roridin A and anguidine);
urethan; vindesine (ELDISINEO, FILDESINO); dacarbazine; mannomustine;
mitobronitol; mitolactol;
pipobroman; gacytosine; arabinoside ("Ara-C"); thiotepa; taxoids, e.g., TAXOLO
paclitaxel (Bristol-Myers Squibb
Oncology, Princeton, N.J.), ABRAXANETM Cremophor-free, albumin-engineered
nanoparticle formulation of
paclitaxel (American Pharmaceutical Partners, Schaumberg, Illinois), and
TAXOTEREO doxetaxel
(Rh6ne-Poulenc Rorer, Antony, France); chloranbucil; gemcitabine (GEMZARO); 6-
thioguanine; mercaptopurine;
methotrexate; platinum analogs such as cisplatin and carboplatin; vinblastine
(VELBANO); platinum; etoposide
(VP-16); ifosfamide; mitoxantrone; vincristine (ONCOVINO); oxaliplatin;
leucovovin; vinorelbine
(NAVELBINEO); novantrone; edatrexate; daunomycin; aminopterin; ibandronate;
topoisomerase inhibitor RFS
2000; difluorometlhylornithine (DMFO); retinoids such as retinoic acid;
capecitabine (XELODAO);
pharmaceutically acceptable salts, acids or derivatives of any of the above;
as well as combinations of two or more
of the above such as CHOP, an abbreviation for a combined therapy of
cyclophosphamide, doxorubicin,
vincristine, and prednisolone, and FOLFOX, an abbreviation for a treatment
regimen with oxaliplatin
42


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
(ELOXATINTM) combined with 5-FU and leucovovin.
Also included in this definition are anti-hormonal agents that act to
regulate, reduce, block, or inhibit the
effects of hormones that can promote the growth of cancer, and are often in
the form of systemic, or whole-body
treatment. They may be hormones themselves. Examples include anti-estrogens
and selective estrogen receptor
modulators (SERMs), including, for example, tamoxifen (including NOLVADEXO
tamoxifen), EVISTAO
raloxifene, droloxifene, 4-hydroxytamoxifen, trioxifene, keoxifene, LY117018,
onapristone, and FARESTONO
toremifene; anti-progesterones; estrogen receptor down-regulators (ERDs);
agents that function to suppress or shut
down the ovaries, for example, leutinizing hormone-releasing hormone (LHRH)
agonists such as LUPRONO and
ELIGARDO leuprolide acetate, goserelin acetate, buserelin acetate and
tripterelin; other anti-androgens such as
flutamide, nilutamide and bicalutamide; and aromatase inhibitors that inhibit
the enzyme aromatase, which
regulates estrogen production in the adrenal glands, such as, for example,
4(5)-imidazoles, aminoglutethimide,
MEGASEO megestrol acetate, AROMASINO exemestane, formestanie, fadrozole,
RIVISORO vorozole,
FEMARAO letrozole, and ARIMIDEXO anastrozole. In addition, such definition of
chemotherapeutic agents
includes bisphosphonates such as clodronate (for example, BONEFOSO or OSTACO),
DIDROCALO etidronate,
NE-58095, ZOMETAO zoledronic acid/zoledronate, FOSAMAXO alendronate, AREDIAO
pamidronate,
SKELIDO tiludronate, or ACTONELO risedronate; as well as troxacitabine (a 1,3-
dioxolane nucleoside cytosine
analog); antisense oligonucleotides, particularly those that inhibit
expression of genes in signaling pathways
implicated in abherant cell proliferation, such as, for example, PKC-alpha,
Raf, H-Ras, and epidermal growth
factor receptor (EGF-R); vaccines such as THERATOPEO vaccine and gene therapy
vaccines, for example,
ALLOVECTINO vaccine, LEUVECTINO vaccine, and VAXIDO vaccine; LURTOTECANO
topoisomerase 1
inhibitor; ABARELIXO rmRH; lapatinib ditosylate (an ErbB-2 and EGFR dual
tyrosine kinase small-molecule
inhibitor also known as GW572016); and pharmaceutically acceptable salts,
acids or derivatives of any of the
above.
A "growth inhibitory agent" when used herein refers to a compound or
composition which inhibits growth
of a cell, especially a TAT-expressing cancer cell, either in vitro or in
vivo. Thus, the growth inhibitory agent may
be one which significantly reduces the percentage of TAT-expressing cells in S
phase. Examples of growth
inhibitory agents include agents that block cell cycle progression (at a place
other than S phase), such as agents
that induce G1 arrest and M-phase arrest. Classical M-phase blockers include
the vincas (vincristine and
vinblastine), taxanes, and topoisomerase II inhibitors such as doxorubicin,
epirubicin, daunorubicin, etoposide,
and bleomycin. Those agents that arrest Gl also spill over into S-phase
arrest, for example, DNA alkylating agents
such as tamoxifen, prednisone, dacarbazine, mechlorethamine, cisplatin,
methotrexate, 5-fluorouracil, and ara-C.
Further information can be found in The Molecular Basis of Cancer, Mendelsohn
and Israel, eds., Chapter 1,
entitled "Cell cycle regulation, oncogenes, and antineoplastic drugs" by
Murakami et al. (WB Saunders:
Philadelphia, 1995), especially p. 13. The taxanes (paclitaxel and docetaxel)
are anticancer drugs both derived
from the yew tree. Docetaxel (TAXOTEREO, Rhone-Poulenc Rorer), derived from
the European yew, is a
semisynthetic analogue of paclitaxel (TAXOLO, Bristol-Myers Squibb).
Paclitaxel and docetaxel promote the
assembly of niicrotubules from tubulin dimers and stabilize microtubules by
preventing depolymerization, which
results in the inhibition of mitosis in cells.

43


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
"Doxorubicin" is an anthracycline antibiotic. The full chemical name of
doxorubicin is (8S-cis)-10-[(3-
amino-2,3,6-trideoxy-a-L-lyxo-hexapyranosyl)oxy]-7,8,9,10-tetrahydro-6,8,11-
trihydroxy-8-(hydroxyacetyl)-1-
methoxy-5,12-naphthacenedione.
The term "cytokine" is a generic term for proteins released by one cell
population which act on another
cell as intercellular mediators. Examples of such cytokines are lymphokines,
monokines, and traditional
polypeptide hormones. Included among the cytokines are growth hormone such as
human growth hormone, N-
methionyl human growth hormone, and bovine growth hormone; parathyroid
hormone; thyroxine; insulin;
proinsulin; relaxin; prorelaxin; glycoprotein hormones such as follicle
stimulating hormone (FSH), thyroid
stimulating hormone (TSH), and luteinizing hormone (LH); hepatic growth
factor; fibroblast growth factor;
prolactin; placental lactogen; tumor necrosis factor-ca and -(3; mullerian-
inhibiting substance; mouse gonadotropin-
associated peptide; inhibin; activin; vascular endothelial growth factor;
integrin; thrombopoietin (TPO); nerve
growth factors such as NGF-(3; platelet-growth factor; transforming growth
factors (TGFs) such as TGF-a and
TGF-(3; insulin-like growth factor-I and -II; erythropoietin (EPO);
osteoinductive factors; interferons such as
interferon -ca, -(3, and -y; colony stimulating factors (CSFs) such as
macrophage-CSF (M-CSF); granulocyte-
macrophage-CSF (GM-CSF); and granulocyte-CSF (G-CSF); interleukins (ILs) such
as 1L-1, IL- la, IL-2, IL-3,
IL-4, IL-5, IL-6, IL-7, IL-8, IL-9, IL-11, IL-12; a tumor necrosis factor such
as TNF-a or TNF-6; and other
polypeptide factors including LIF and kit ligand (KL). As used herein, the
term cytokine includes proteins from
natural sources or from recombinant cell culture and biologically active
equivalents of the native sequence
cytokines.
The term "package insert" is used to refer to instructions customarily
included in commercial packages
of therapeutic products, that contain information about the indications,
usage, dosage, administration,
contraindications and/or warnings concerning the use of such therapeutic
products.

44


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1

*
* C-C increased from 12 to 15
* Z is average of EQ
* B is average of ND
* match with stop is _M; stop-stop = 0; J(joker) match = 0
#define _M -8 /* value of a match with a stop *!
int _day[26][26] = {
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV WXYZ*/
!* A*/ { 2, 0,-2, 0, 0,-4, 1,-1,-1, 0,-1,-2,-1, 0,_M, 1, 0,-2, 1, 1, 0, 0,-6,
0,-3, 0},
/* B*/ { 0, 3,-4, 3, 2,-5, 0, 1,-2, 0, 0,-3,-2, 2,_M,-1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0; 2; 5,
0,-3, 1},
/* C*/ {-2,-4,15,-5; 5,-4; 3,-3,-2, 0,-5,-6; 5,-4,_M,-3; 5,-4, 0,-2, 0,-2,-8,
0, 0; 5},
1* D{ 0, 3,-5, 4, 3,-6, 1, 1,-2, 0, 0,-4,-3, 2,_M; 1, 2,-i, 0, 0, 0,-2,-7, 0;
4, 2},
/* E{ 0, 2,-5, 3, 4, 5, 0, 1,-2, 0, 0,-3; 2, 1,_M,-1, 2,-1, 0, 0, 0,-2, 7, 0,-
4, 3},
/* F*/ {-4,-5; 4,-6,-5, 9,-5,-2, 1, 0; 5, 2, 0,-4,_M; 5; 5,-4,-3, 3, 0,-1, 0,
0, 7; 5},
/* G*/ 11, 0,-3, 1, 0,-5, 5, 2; 3, 0,-2,-4,-3, 0,_M,-1,-1, 3, 1, 0, 0,-1, 7,
0,-5, 01,
/* H*/ 1-1, 1,-3, 1, 1,-2,-2, 6,-2, 0, 0,-2,-2, 2,_M, 0, 3, 2,-1,-i, 0,-2,-3,
0, 0, 2},
/* I*/ {-1,-2,-2,-2,-2, 1,-3,-2, 5, 0,-2, 2, 2,-2,_M,-2,-2,-2; 1, 0, 0, 4,-5,
0,-1,-2},
/*J*1 {0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,_M,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0},
/* K*/ {-1, 0,-5, 0, 0,-5,-2, 0; 2, 0, 5,-3, 0, 1,_M,-1, 1, 3, 0, 0, 0> 2,-3,
0, 4, 01,
/* L*/ {-2,-3,-6,-4; 3, 2,-4; 2, 2, 0,-3, 6, 4,-3,_M; 3; 2, 3; 3,-1, 0, 2,-2,
0; 1; 2},
/* M{-1,-2,-5,-3,-2, 0,-3; 2, 2, 0, 0, 4, 6,-2,_M,-2,-1, 0; 2; 1, 0, 2,-4, 0,-
2; 1},
/* N*/ { 0, 2,-4, 2, 1, 4, 0, 2,-2, 0, 1,-3,2, 2,_M,-1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0,-2, 4,
0, 2, 11,
/* O
/* P*/ 6, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0,-1,-6, 0; 5, 0},
/* Q*/ { 0, 1,-5, 2, 2,-5,-1, 3,-2, 0, 1,-2,-1, 1,_M, 0, 4, 1,-1,-1, 0, 2,-5,
0,-4, 3},
/* R {-2, 0,-4,-1,-1,-4; 3, 2,-2, 0, 3,-3, 0, 0,_M, 0, 1, 6, 0,-i, 0,-2, 2, 0,
4, 0},
/* S*/ { 1, 0, 0, 0, 0,-3, 1; 1,-1, 0, 0,-3, 2, 1,_M, 1,-1, 0, 2, 1, 0,-1, 2,
0; 3, 0},
/* T*/ { 1, 0,-2, 0, 0,-3, 0,-1, 0, 0, 0; 1; 1, 0,_M, 0,-1,-1, 1, 3, 0, 0; 5,
0,-3, 0},
/*U*/ {0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,_M,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0},
/* V{ 0,-2,-2, 2,-2,-1,-1,-2, 4, 0,-2, 2, 2,-2,_M,-1,-2,-2,-1, 0, 0, 4,-6, 0,-
2,-2},
/* W{-6; 5,-8,-7,-7, 0; 7; 3; 5, 0; 3,-2; 4, 4,_M,-6; 5, 2,-2,-5, 0,-6,17, 0,
0; 6},
/* x*/ { o, o, a, o, o, o, o, o, o, o, o, o, o, o,_M, o, o, o, o, o, o, o, o,
o, o, o},
/* Y*/ 1-3,-3, 0,-4,-4, 7,-5, 0,-1, 0,-4,-1,-2; 2,_M,-5,-4,-4,-3,-3, 0,-2, 0,
0,10,-4},
/* Z*! { 0, 1,-5, 2, 3,-5, 0, 2,-2, 0, 0, 2,-1, 1,_M, 0, 3, 0, 0, 0, 0; 2; 6,
0; 4, 4}
};

50


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1 (cont')
1*
#include <stdio.h>
#include <ctype.h>
#define MAXJMP 16 /* max jumps in a diag
#define MAXGAP 24 /* don't continue to penalize gaps larger than this */
#define JMPS 1024 /* max jmps in an path */
#define MX 4 /* save if there's at least MX-1 bases since last jmp
#define DMAT 3 /* value of matching bases
#define DMIS 0 /* penalty for mismatched bases */
#define DINSO 8 /* penalty for a gap
#define DINS 1 1 /* penalty per base
#define PINSO 8 /* penalty for a gap *1
#define PINS 1 4 /* penalty per residue */
structjmp {
short n[MAXJMP]; /* size ofjmp (neg for dely) *1
unsigned short x[MAXJMP]; /* base no. ofjmp in seq x
}; /* limits seq to 2"16 -1 *1
struct diag {
int score; /* score at last jmp
long offset; /* offset of prev block */
short ijmp; /* current jmp index *1
structjmp jp; /* list of jmps *1
1;
struct path {
int spc=, /* number of leading spaces
short n[JMPS];/* size of jmp (gap) */
int x[JMPS];/* loc of jmp (last elem before gap) */
};
char *ofile; /* output file name */
char *namex[2]; /* seq names: getseqsQ
char *prog; /* prog name for err msgs
char *seqx[2]; /* seqs: getseqs()
int dmax; /* best diag: nw()
int dmaxO; /* final diag */
int dna; /* set if dna: main()
int endgaps; /* set if penalizing end gaps
int gapx, gapy; /* total gaps in seqs
int len0, lenl; /* seq lens */
int ngapx, ngapy; /* total size of gaps
int smax; /* max score: nw()
int *xbm; /* bitmap for matching *1
long offset; /* current offset in jmp file */
struct diag *dx; /* holds diagonals */
struct path pp[2]; /* holds path for seqs
char *callocQ, *malloc(), *indexQ, *strcpyQ;
char *getseq(), *g_callocQ;

46


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1(cont')
/* Needleman-Wunsch alignment program
*
* usage: progs filel file2
* where filel and file2 are two dna or two protein sequences.
* The sequences can be in upper- or lower-case an may contain ambiguity
* Any lines beginning with ';', '>' or '<' are ignored
* Max file length is 65535 (limited by unsigned short x in the jmp struct)
* A sequence with 1/3 or more of its elements ACGTU is assumed to be DNA
* Output is in the file "align.out"
*
* The program may create a tmp file in /tmp to hold info about traceback.
* Original version developed under BSD 4.3 on a vax 8650
*1
#include "nw.h"
#include "day.h"

static _dbval[26]
1,14,2,13,0,0,4,11,0,0,12,0,3,15,0,0,0,5,6,8,8,7,9,0,10,0
static _pbval[26]
1, 21(1 ('D'-'A'))1(1 ('N'-'A')), 4, 8, 16, 32, 64,
128, 256, OxFFFFFFF, 1<<10, 1 i1, 1 12, 1<<13, 1<<14,
1<<15, 1<<16, 1<<17, 1<<18, 1<<19, 1<<20, 1<<21, 1<<22,
1 25K1 ('E'-'A'))~(1 ('Q'-'A'))
1<<23, 1<<24,
};
main(ac, av) main
int ac;
char xav[];
{
prog = av[0];
if (ac!= 3) {
fprintf(stderr,"usage: %s filel file2\n", prog);
fprintf(stderr,"where filel and file2 are two dna or two protein
sequences.\n");
fprintf(stderr,"The sequences can be in upper- or lower-case\n");
fprintf(stderr,"Any llnes beginning with';' or'<' are ignored\n");
fprintf(stderr,"Output is in the file \"align.out\"\n");
exit(l);
1
namex[0] = av[1];
namex[l] = av[2];
seqx[0] = getseq(namex[0], &len0);
seqx[1] = getseq(namex[l], &lenl);
xbm = (dna)? dbval : _pbval;

endgaps = 0; /* 1 to penalize endgaps
ofile = "align.out"; /* output file */

nwQ; /* fill in the matrix, get the possible jmps *!
readjmps(); /* get the actual jmps */
printQ; /* print stats, alignment */
cleanup(0); /* unlink any tmp files */}

47


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1(cont')

/* do the alignment, return best score: main()
* dna: values in Fitch and Smith, PNAS, 80, 1382-1386, 1983
* pro: PAM 250 values
* When scores are equal, we prefer mismatches to any gap, prefer
* a new gap to extending an ongoing gap, and prefer a gap in seqx
* to a gap in seq y.

nw() nw
{
char *px, *py; /* seqs and ptrs
int *ndely, *dely; /* keep track of dely
int ndelx, delx; /* keep track of delx
int *tmp; /* for swapping rowO, rowl
int niis; /* score for each type
int insO, insl; /* insertion penalties *1
register id; /* diagonal index
register ij; /* jmp index */
register *co10, *coll; /* score for curr, last row
register xx, yy; /* index into seqs
dx = (struct diag *)g_calloc("to get diags", len0+len1+1, sizeof(struct
diag));
ndely =(int *)g_calloc("to get ndely", len1+1, sizeof(int));
dely =(int *)g_calloc("to get dely", lenl+l, sizeof(int));
colO =(int *)g_calloc("to get co10", lenl+l, sizeof(int));
coll =(int *)g_calloc("to get coll", len1+1, sizeof(int));
insO = (dna)? DINSO : PINSO;
insl = (dna)? DINS1 : PINS1;
smax = -10000;
if (endgaps) {
for (co10[0] = dely[0] =-ins0, yy = 1; yy <=1en1; yy++) {
colO[yy] = dely[yyl = co10[yy-1]-insl;
ndely[yy] = yy;
}
co10[0] = 0; /* Waterman Bull Math Bio184 *!
}
else
for (yy = 1; yy <=1en1; yy++)
dely[yy] = -insO;
/* fill in match matrix
*/
for (px = seqx[0], xx = 1; xx <= lenO; px++, xx++) {
/* initialize first entry in col

if (endgaps) {
if (xx == 1)
coll[0] = delx = -(ins0+ins1);
else
coll[0] = delx = co10[0] - insl;
ndelx = xx;
}
else t
coll[0] = 0;
delx = -ins0;
ndelx = 0;
}

48


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1(cont')
...nw
for (py = seqx[1], yy = 1; yy r- lenl; py++, yy++) {
mis = co10[yy-1];
if (dna)
mis += (xbm[*px-'A']&xbm[*py-'A'])? DMAT : DMIS;
else
mis +_ _day[*px-'A'][*py-'A'];
/* update penalty for del in x seq;
* favor new del over ongong del
* ignore MAXGAP if weighting endgaps
*f
if (endgaps 11 ndely[yy] < MAXGAP) {
if (colO[yy] - insO >= dely[yy]) {
dely[yy] = colO[yy] - (ins0+ins1);
ndely[yy] = 1;
} else {
dely[yy] -= insl;
ndely[yy]++;
}
} else {
if (co10[yy] - (ins0+ins1) >= dely[yy]) {
dely[yy] = co10[yy] - (ins0+ins1);
ndely[yy] = 1;
} else
ndely[yy]++;
}

/* update penalty for del in y seq;
* favor new del over ongong del
if (endgaps 11 ndelx < MAXGAP) {
if (coll [yy-1] - insO >= delx) {
delx = coll [yy-1] - (ins0+ins1);
ndelx = 1;
I else {
delx -= insl;
ndelx++;
}
} else {
if (coll[yy-1] - (ins0+ins1) >= delx) {
delx =co11[yy-1] - (ins0+ins1);
ndelx = 1;
I else
ndelx++;
}
1* pick the maximum score; we're favoring
* mis over any del and delx over dely
*/

...nw
id=xx-yy+lenl-1;
if (mis >= delx && mis >= dely[yy])
coll[yy] = mis;

49


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1 (cont')
else if (delx >= dely[yy]) {
coll[yy] = delx;
ij = dx[id].ijmp;
if (dx[id].jp.n[0] && (!dna 11 (ndelx >= MAXJMP
&& xx > dx[id].jp.x[ij]+MX) 11 niis > dx[id].score+DINSO)) {
dx[id].ijmp++;
if (++ij >= MAXJMP) {
writejmps(id);
ii = dx[id].ijmp = 0;
dx[id].offset = offset;
offset += sizeof(structjmp) + sizeof(offset);
}
}
dx[id].jp.n[ij] = ndelx;
dx[id].jp.x[ij] = xx;
dx[id].score = delx;
}
else {
coll[yy] = dely[yy];
ii = dx[id].ijmp;
if (dx[id].jp.n[0] && (!dna (ndely[yy] >= MAXJMP
&& xx> dx[id].jp.x[ij]+MX) mis > dx[id].score+DINSO)) {
dx[id].ijmp++;
if (++ij >= MAXJMP) {
writejmps(id);
ij = dx[id].ijmp = 0;
dx[id].offset = offset;
offset += sizeof(struct jmp) + sizeof(offset);
}
1
dx[id].jp.n[ij] = -ndely[yy];
dx[id]=jp=x[ij] = xx;
dx[id].score = dely[yy];
}
if(xx-len0&&yy<Ienl){
/* last col
*1
if (endgaps)
coll[yy] -= ins0+ins1*(lenl-yy);
if (coll[yy] > smax) {
smax = coll[yy];
dmax = id;
}
}
}
if (endgaps && xx < lenO)
coll[yy-1]-= ins0+ins1*(len0-xx);
if (coll[yy-1] > smax) {
smax = coll[yy-1];
dmax = id;
}
tmp = co10; co10 = coll; coll = tmp; }
(void) free((char *)ndely);
(void) free((char *)dely);
(void) free((char *)colO);
(void) free((char *)coll); }



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1 (cont')
*
* print() -- only routine visible outside this module
*
* static:
* getmat() -- trace back best path, count matches: print()
* pr_alignO -- print alignment of described in array p[]: printO
* dumpblock() -- dump a block of lines with numbers, stars: pr_alignQ
* nums() -- put out a number line: dumpblock()
* putline() -- put out a line (name, [num], seq, [num]): dumpblock()
* stars() - -put a line of stars: dumpblock()
* stripname() -- strip any path and prefix from a seqname
#include "nw.h"

#define SPC 3
#define P LINE 256 /* maximum output line */
#define P_SPC 3 /* space between name or num and seq
extern _day[26][26];
int olen; /* set output line length
FILE *fx; /* output file *1

print() print
{
int lx, ly, firstgap, lastgap; /* overlap */
if ((fx = fopen(ofile, "w")) == 0) {
fprintf(stderr,"%s: can't write %s\n", prog, ofile);
cleanup(l);
}
fprintf(fx, "<first sequence: %s (length = %ad)\n", namex[0], lenO);
fprintf(fx, "<second sequence: %s (length = %d)Vi", namex[1], lenl);
olen = 60;
lx =1en0;
ly = lenl;
firstgap = lastgap = 0;
if (dmax < lenl - 1) { /* leading gap in x
pp[0].spc = firstgap =1enl - dmax - 1;
ly -= pp[0].spc;
}
else if (dmax > lenl - 1) { /* leading gap in y
pp[1].spc = firstgap = dmax - (lenl - 1);
lx -= pp[l].spc;
}
if (dmax0 < lenO - 1) { /* trailing gap in x
lastgap =1en0 - dmax0 -1;
lx -=lastgap;
}
else if (dmax0 > lenO - 1) {/* trailing gap in y
lastgap = dmax0 - (lenO - 1);
ly -=lastgap;
}
getmat(lx, ly, firstgap, lastgap);
pr_align(); }

51


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1 (cont')

* trace back the best path, count matches
static
getmat(lx, ly, firstgap, lastgap) getmat
int lx, ly; /* "core" (nunus endgaps)
int firstgap, lastgap; /* leading trailing overlap *1
{
int nm, iO, ii, sizO, sizl;
char outx[32];
double pet;
register nO, nl;
register char *p0, *pl;
/* get total matches, score
i0 = il = sizo = sizl = 0;
p0 = seqx[0] + pp[1].spc;
p1 = seqx[1] +pp[0].spc;
n0=pp[l].spc+ 1;
nl = pp[0].spc + 1;
nm = 0;
while ( *pO && *pl ) {
if (siz0) {
pl++;
nl++;
siz0--;
}
else if (sizl) {
p0++;
n0++;
sizl--;
}
else {
if (xbm[*p0-'A']&xbm[*pl-'A'])
nm++;
if (nO++ = pp[0].x[i0])
sizO = pp[0].n[i0++];
if (nl++ == pp[l].x[il])
sizl = pp[1].n[il++];
po++;
pl++;
}
}
/* pct homology:
* if penalizing endgaps, base is the shorter seq
* else, knock off overhangs and take shorter core
if (endgaps)
lx =(len0 < lenl)? IenO : lenl;
else
lx = (lx < ly)? lx : ly;
pct = 100. *(double)nm/(double)lx;
fprintf(fx, "An");
fprintf(fx, "<%d match%s in an overlap of %d: %.2f percent similarity\n",
nm, (nm = 1)? "es", lx, pet);

52


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
~,.
Table 1(cont')
fprintf(fx, "<gaps in first sequence: %d", gapx); ...getmat
if (gapx) {
(void) sprintf(outx, " (%d %s%s)",
ngapx, (dna)? "base":"residue", (ngapx 1)? :"s");
fprintf(fx,"%s", outx);
fprintf(fx, ", gaps in second sequence: %d", gapy);
if (gapy) {
(void) sprintf(outx, " (%d %as%as)",
ngapy, (dna)? "base":"residue", (ngapy = 1)? "s");
fprintf(fx,"%s", outx);
}
if (dna)
fprintf(fx,
"\n<score: %d (match = %d, mismatch = %d, gap penalty = %d + %d per base)\n",
smax, DMAT, DMIS, DINSO, DINS1);
else
fprintf(fx,
"Vi<score: %d (Dayhoff PAM 250 matrix, gap penalty = %d +%od per residue)\n",
smax, PINSO, PINS1);
if (endgaps)
fprintf(fx,
"<endgaps penalized. left endgap: %d %s%s, right endgap: %d %s%s\n",
firstgap, (dna)? "base" : "residue", (firstgap = 1)? "s",
lastgap, (dna)? "base" : "residue", (lastgap == 1)? "" : "s
else
fprintf(fx, "<endgaps not penalized\n");
}
static nm; /* matches in core -- for checking *1
static Imax; /* lengths of stripped file names */
static ij[2]; /* jmp index for a path *1
static nc[2]; /* number at start of current line
static ni[2]; /* current elem number -- for gapping
static siz[2];
static char *ps[2]; /* ptr to current element *1
static char *po[21; /* ptr to next output char slot
static char out[2][P_LINE]; /* output line */
static char star[P_LINE]; /* set by stars0 */
* print alignment of described in struct path pp[]
static
pr_align0 pr_align
{
int nn; /* char count *1
int more;
register i;

for (i = 0,1max = 0; i< 2; i++) {
nn = stripname(namex[i]);
if (nn > lmax)
lmax = nn;
nc[i] =1;
ni[i] = 1;
siz[i] = ij [i] = 0;
ps[i] = seqx[i];
po[i] = out[i]; }

53


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1 (cont')

for (nn = nm = 0, more = 1; more; ) { ...pr_align
for (i = more = 0; i < 2; i++) {

* do we have more of this sequence?
if (!*ps[i])
continue;
more++;
if (pp[i].spc) { /* leading space *1
*po[i]++ = ";
pp[il=spc--;
}
else if (siz[i]) { /* in a gap
*po[i]++
siz[i]--;
}
else { /* we're putting a seq element
*/
*po[i] = *ps[i];
if (islower(*ps[i]))
*ps[i] = toupper(*ps(ij);
po[il++;
ps[i]++;
* are we at next gap for this seq?
if (ni[i] = pp[i].x[ij[i]]) {

* we need to merge all gaps
* at this location

siz[i] = pp[i].n[ij [i]++];
while (ni[il == pp[il.x[ij[ill)
siz[i] += pp[i].n[ij[il++];
}
}
}
if (++nn = olen !more && nn) {
dumpblockQ;
for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
po[i] = out[i];
nn = 0;
}
}
}

* dump a block of lines, including numbers, stars: pr align()
static
dumpblock() dumpblock
{
register i;
for (i = 0; i< 2; i++)
*po[i]-- = A0';

54


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1 (cont')
...dumpblock
(void) putc('\n', fx);
for(i=0;i<2;i++){
if (*out[i] && (*out[i] *(po[i]) !_ ")) {
if (i = 0)
nums(i);
if (i = 0 && *out[1])
starsQ;
putline(i);
if (i = 0 && *out[1])
fprintf(fx, star);
if(i==1)
nums(i);
}
}
}
/*
* put out a number line: dumpblock()
*1
static
nums(ix) nums
int ix; /* index in out[] holding seq line
{
char nline[P_LINE];
register i, j;
register char *pn, *px, *py;
for (pn = nline, i 0; i < 1max+P_SPC; i++, pn++)
*pn=I
for (i = nc[ix], py = out[ix]; *py; py++, pn++) {
if (*Py " II *Py =' ')
*pn
else {
if(i%10==011 (i== 1 &&nc[ix] 1)){
j = (i < 0)? -i: i;
for (px = pn; j; j/= 10, px--)
*px =j%10 +'0';
if (i < 0)
*px
}
else
*pn
i++;
}
}
*pn='\0;
nc[ix] = i;
for (pn = nline; *pn; pn++)
(void) putc(*pn, fx);
(void) putc('\n', fx);
}

* put out a line (name, [num], seq, [num]): dumpblock()
static
putline(ix) putline
int ix; {



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1 (cont')

...putline
int i;
register char *px;
for (px = namex[ix], i = 0; *px && *px px++, i++)
(void) putc(*px, fx);
for (; i < 1max+P_SPC; i++)
(void) putc(' ', fx);
/* these count from 1:
* ni[] is current element (from 1)
* nc[] is number at start of current line
for (px = out[ix]; *px; px++)
(void) putc(*px&Ox7F, fx);
(void) putc(W, fx);
}

* put a line of stars (seqs always in out[0], out[1]): dumpblock()
static
stars() stars
{
int i;
register char *p0, *pl, cx, *px;

if (!*out[0] (*out[0] && *(po[0]) =
!*out[1] (*out[1] && *(po[1]) = "))
return;
px = star;
for (i = lmax+P_SPC; i; i--)
*px++ =";

for (p0 = out[0], pl = out[1]; *pO && *pl; p0++, pl+F) {
if (isalpha(*pO) && isalpha(*pl)) {

if (xbm[*p0-'A']&xbm[*pl-'A']) {
cx ='*';
nm++;
}
else if (!dna && _day[*p0-'A'][*pl-'A'] > 0)
cx -'
else
cx= ,
}
else
cx
*px++ = cx;
}
*px++W;
*Px = V>
1

56


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1(cont')

* strip path or prefix from pn, return len: pr_align()
static
stripname(pn) stripname
char *pn; /* file name (may be path) */
{
register char *px, *py;
py=0;
for (px = pn; *px; px++)
if (*px
py=px+1;
if (py)
(void) strcpy(pn, py);
return(strlen(pn));
}


57


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1(cont')

* cleanup() -- cleanup any tmp file
* getseqQ -- read in seq, set dna, len, maxlen
* g_callocQ -- callocO with error checkin
* readjmps0 -- get the good jmps, from tmp file if necessary
* writejmpsO -- write a filled array of imps to a tmp file: nw0
#include "nw.h"
#include <sys/file.h>
char *jname ="/tmp/homgXXXXXX"; /* tmp file for jmps
FILE *fj;
int cleanupQ; I* cleanup tmp file *I
long lseek0;
* remove any tmp file if we blow

cleanup(i) cleanup
int i;
{
if (fj)
(void) unlink(jname);
exit(i);
}
* read, return ptr to seq, set dna, len, maxlen
* skip lines starting with ';', '<', or '>'
* seq in upper or lower case
*1
char *
getseq(file, len) getseq
char *file; /* file name */
int *len; /* seq len */
{
char line[1024], *pseq;
register char *px, *py;
int natgc, tlen;
FILE *fp;
if ((fp = fopen(file,"r")) == 0) {
fprintf(stderr,"%s: can't read %s\n", prog, file);
exit(1);
}
tlen = natgc = 0;
while (fgets(line, 1024, fp)) {
if (*line == ';' 11 *line *line = '>')
continue;
for (px =1ine=, *px != W; px++)
if (isupper(*px) 11 islower(*px))
tlen++;
}
if ((pseq = malloc((unsigned)(tlen+6))) = 0) {
fprintf(stderr,"%s: mallocO failed to get %d bytes for %s\n", prog, tlen+6,
file);
exit(1);
}
pseq[0] = pseq[1] = pseq[2] = pseq[3] ='\0

58


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1(cont')
...getseq
py = pseq + 4;
*len = tlen;
rewind(fp);
while (fgets(line, 1024, fp)) {
if (*line ==';' 11 *line ='<' Jj *line ='>')
continue;
for (px =1ine; *px !='\n'; px++) {
if (isupper(*px))
*py++= *px;
else if (islower(*px))
*py++ = toupper(*px);
if (index("ATGCU",*(py-1)))
natgc++;
}
}
*py++
*py = \0 ;
(void) fclose(fp);
dna = natgc > (tlen/3);
return(pseq+4);
}
char *
g_calloc(msg, nx, sz) g_calloc
char *msg; /* program, calling routine
int nx, sz; /* number and size of elements
{
char *px,*callocQ;
if ((px = calloc((unsigned)nx, (unsigned)sz)) == 0) {
if (*msg) {
fprintf(stderr, "%s: g_calloc() failed %s (n=%d, sz=%d)\n", prog, msg, nx,
sz);
exit(1);
}
}
return(px);
}

* get final jmps from dx[] or tmp file, set pp[], reset dmax: main()
readjmps
readjmps0
{
int fd = -1;
int siz,i0,i1;
register i, j, xx;
if (fj) {
(void) fclose(fj);
if ((fd = open(jname, O_RDONLY, 0)) < 0) {
fprintf(stderr, "%s: can't openO %s\n", prog, jname);
cleanup(1);
}
}
for (i = iO = i l= 0, dmaxO = dmax, xx =1en0; ; i++) {
while (1) {
for (j = dx[dmax].ijmp; j >= 0 && dx[dmax].jp.x[j] >= xx; j--)

59


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1(cont')
...readjmps
if (j < 0 && dx[dmax].offset && fj) {
(void) lseek(fd, dx[dmaxl.offset, 0);
(void) read(fd, (char *)&dx[dmax].jp, sizeof(struct jmp));
(void) read(fd, (char *)&dx[dmax].offset, sizeof(dx[dmax].offset));
dx[dmaxl.ijmp = MAXJMP-1; }
else
break; }
if (i >= JMPS) {
fprintf(stderr, "%s: too many gaps in alignmenAn", prog);
cleanup(1);
}
if(j>=0){
siz = dx[dmax].jp.n[j];
xx= dx[dmax]=jP=xGl;
dmax += siz;
if (siz < 0) { /* gap in second seq
pp[1].n[il] = -siz;
xx += siz;
/* id = xx - yy + lenl - 1
pp[1].x[il] = xx - dmax + lenl - 1;
gapy++;
ngapy -= siz;
/* ignore MAXGAP when doing endgaps */
siz = (-siz < MAXGAP 11 endgaps)? -siz : MAXGAP;
il++;
}
else if (siz > 0) { /* gap in first seq
pp[0].n[i0] = siz;
pp[0].x[i0] = xx;
gapx++;
ngapx += siz;
/* ignore MAXGAP when doing endgaps */
siz =(siz < MAXGAP endgaps)? siz : MAXGAP;
io++;
}
}
else
break;
}
/* reverse the order of jmps
for (j = 0, i0--; j < i0; j++, iO--) {
i= pp[0].n[j]; pp[0].n[j] = pp[0].n[i0]; pp[ol.n[io] =
i = pp[0].x[j]; pp[0].x[j] = pp[0].x[i0]; pp[Oj.x[i0] =
1
for (j = 0, i1--; j< il; j++, il--) {
i= PP[ll=nU]; PP[1]=nCl] = pp[1].n[ill; PP[1].n[il] =i;
i= PP[1]=xfJl; PP[l]=xCl] = PP[1].x[il7; PP[1].x[il] =
}
if (fd >= 0)
(void) close(fd);
if (fj) {
(void) unlink(jname);
fj = 0;
offset = 0;
} }



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 1 (cont')

* write a filled jmp struct offset of the prev one (if any): nwQ

writejmps(ix) writejmps
int ix;
{
char *mktempQ;
if (!fj) {
if (mktemp(jname) < 0) {
fprintf(stderr, "%s: can't mktemp() %s\n", prog, jname);
cleanup(1);
}
if ((fi = fopen(jname, "w")) = 0) {
fprintf(stderr, "%s: can't write %s\n", prog, jname);
exit(1);
}
}
(void) fwrite((char *)&dx[ix].jp, sizeof(structjmp), 1, fj);
(void) fwrite((char *)&dx[ix].offset, sizeof(dx[ix].offset), 1, fj);
}

61


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 2

TAT XXXXXxxXXXXXXXX (Length = 15 amino acids)
Comparison Protein XXXXXYYYYYYY (Length = 12 amino acids)
% amino acid sequence identity =

(the number of identically matching amino acid residues between the two
polypeptide sequences as determined
by ALIGN-2) divided by (the total number of amino acid residues of the TAT
polypeptide) _

5 divided by 15 = 33.3%

Table 3

TAT XXXXXXXXXX (Length = 10 amino acids)
Comparison Protein XXXXXYYYyYYZZYZ (Length = 15 amino acids)
% amino acid sequence identity =

(the number of identically matching an-dno acid residues between the two
polypeptide sequences as determined
by ALIGN-2) divided by (the total number of amino acid residues of the TAT
polypeptide) _

5 divided by 10 = 50%

Table 4
TAT-DNA NNNNNNNNNNNNNN (Length = 14 nucleotides)
Comparison DNA NNNNNNLLLLLLLLLL (Length = 16 nucleotides)
% nucleic acid sequence identity =
(the number of identically matching nucleotides between the two nucleic acid
sequences as determined by ALIGN-
2) divided by (the total number of nucleotides of the TAT-DNA nucleic acid
sequence) _

6 divided by 14 = 42.9%

62


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Table 5

TAT-DNA NNNNNNNNNNNN (Length = 12 nucleotides)
Comparison DNA NNNNLLLVV (Length = 9 nucleotides)
% nucleic acid sequence identity =

(the number of identically matching nucleotides between the two nucleic acid
sequences as determined by ALIGN-
2) divided by (the total number of nucleotides of the TAT-DNA nucleic acid
sequence) _

4 divided by 12 = 33.3%

II. Compositions and Methods of the Invention
A. Anti-TAT Antibodies
In one embodiment, the present invention provides anti-TAT antibodies which
may find use herein as
therapeutic and/or diagnostic agents. Exemplary antibodies include polyclonal,
monoclonal, humanized, bispecific,
and heteroconjugate antibodies.
1. Polyclonal Antibodies
Polyclonal antibodies are preferably raised in animals by multiple
subcutaneous (sc) or intraperitoneal
(ip) injections of the relevant antigen and an adjuvant. It may be useful to
conjugate the relevant antigen
(especially when synthetic peptides are used) to a protein that is immunogenic
in the species to be immunized.
For example, the antigen can be conjugated to keyhole limpet hemocyanin (KLH),
serum albumin, bovine
thyroglobulin, or soybean trypsin inhibitor, using a bifunctional or
derivatizing agent, e.g., maleimidobenzoyl
sulfosuccinimide ester (conjugation through cysteine residues), N-
hydroxysuccinimide (through lysine residues),
glutaraldeliyde, succinic anhydride, SOC12, or R1N=C=NR, where R and Rl are
different alkyl groups.
Animals are immunized against the antigen, immunogenic conjugates, or
derivatives by combining, e.g.,
100 g or 5 g of the protein or conjugate (for rabbits or mice, respectively)
with 3 volumes of Freund's complete
adjuvant and injecting the solution intradermally at multiple sites. One month
later, the animals are boosted with
1/5 to 1/10 the original amount of peptide or conjugate in Freund's complete
adjuvant by subcutaneous injection
at multiple sites. Seven to 14 days later, the animals are bled and the serum
is assayed for antibody titer. Animals
are boosted until the titer plateaus. Conjugates also can be made in
recombinant cell culture as protein fusions.
Also, aggregating agents such as alum are suitably used to enhance the immune
response.
2. Monoclonal Antibodies
Monoclonal antibodies may be made using the hybridoma method first described
by Kohier et al., Nature,
256:495 (1975), or may be made by recombinant DNA methods (U.S. Patent No.
4,816,567).
In the hybridoma method, a mouse or other appropriate host animal, such as a
hamster, is immunized as
described above to elicit lymphocytes that produce or are capable of producing
antibodies that will specifically
bind to the protein used for immunization. Alternatively, lymphocytes may be
immunized in vitro. After
immunization, lymphocytes are isolated and then fused with a myeloma cell line
using a suitable fusing agent, such
63


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
as polyethylene glycol, to form a hybridoma cell (Goding, Monoclonal
Antibodies: Principles and Practice, pp.59-
103 (Academic Press, 1986)).
The hybridoma cells thus prepared are seeded and grown in a suitable culture
medium which medium
preferably contains one or more substances that inhibit the growth or survival
of the unfused, parental myeloma
cells (also referred to as fusion partner). For example, if the parental
myeloma cells lack the enzyme hypoxantliine
guanine phosphoribosyl transferase (HGPRT or HPRT), the selective culture
medium for the hybridomas typically
will include hypoxanthine, aminopterin, and thymidine (HAT medium), which
substances prevent the growth of
HGPRT-deficient cells.
Preferred fusion partner myeloma cells are those that fuse efficiently,
support stable high-level production
of antibody by the selected antibody-producing cells, and are sensitive to a
selective medium that selects against
the unfused parental cells. Preferred myeloma cell lines are murine myeloma
lines, such as those derived from
MOPC-21 and MPC-11 mouse tumors available from the Salk Institute Cell
Distribution Center, San Diego,
California USA, and SP-2 and derivatives e.g., X63-Ag8-653 cells available
from the American Type Culture
Collection, Manassas, Virginia, USA. Human myeloma and mouse-human
heteromyeloma cell lines also have
been described for the production of human monoclonal antibodies (Kozbor, J.
Immunol., 133:3001 (1984); and
Brodeur et al., Monoclonal Antibody Production Techniques and Applications,
pp. 51-63 (Marcel Dekker, Inc.,
New York, 1987)).
Culture mediumin which hybridomacells are growing is assayed for production of
monoclonal antibodies
directed against the antigen. Preferably, the binding specificity of
monoclonal antibodies produced by hybridoma
cells is determined by immunoprecipitation or by an in vitro binding assay,
such as radioimmunoassay (RIA) or
enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay (ELISA).
The binding affinity of the monoclonal antibody can, for example, be
determined by the Scatchard
analysis described in Munson et al., Anal. Biochem., 107:220 (1980).
Once hybridoma cells that produce antibodies of the desired specificity,
affinity, and/or activity are
identified, the clones may be subcloned by limiting dilution procedures and
grown by standard methods (Goding,
Monoclonal Antibodies: Principles and Practice, pp.59-103 (Academic Press,
1986)). Suitable culture media for
this purpose include, for example, D-MEM or RPMI-1640 medium. In addition, the
hybridoma cells may be
grown in vivo as ascites tumors in an animal e.g,, by i.p. injection of the
cells into mice.
The monoclonal antibodies secreted by the subclones are suitably separated
from the culture medium,
ascites fluid, or serum by conventional antibody purification procedures such
as, for example, affinity
chromatography (e.g., using protein A or protein G-Sepharose) or ion-exchange
chromatography, hydroxylapatite
chromatography, gel electrophoresis, dialysis, etc.
DNA encoding the monoclonal antibodies is readily isolated and sequenced using
conventional
procedures (e.g., by using oligonucleotide probes that are capable of binding
specifically to genes encoding the
heavy and light chains of murine antibodies). The hybridoma cells serve as a
preferred source of such DNA. Once
isolated, the DNA may be placed into expression vectors, which are then
transfected into host cells such as E. coli
cells, siniian COS cells, Chinese Hamster Ovary (CHO) cells, or myeloma cells
that do not otherwise produce
antibody protein, to obtain the synthesis of monoclonal antibodies in the
recombinant host cells. Review articles
on recombinant expression in bacteria of DNA encoding the antibody include
Skerra et al., Curr. Opinion in
64


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Immunol., 5:256-262 (1993) and Plnckthun, Immunol. Revs. 130:151-188 (1992).
In a further embodiment, monoclonal antibodies or antibody fragments can be
isolated from antibody
phage libraries generated using the techniques described in McCafferty et al.,
Nature, 348:552-554 (1990).
Clackson et al., Nature, 352:624-628 (1991) and Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol.,
222:581-597 (1991) describe the
isolation of murine and human antibodies, respectively, using phage libraries.
Subsequent publications describe
the production of high affinity (nM range) human antibodies by chain shuffling
(Marks et al., Bio/Technology,
10:779-783 (1992)), as well as combinatorial infection and in vivo
recombination as a strategy for constructing
very large phage libraries (Waterhouse et al., Nuc. Acids. Res. 21:2265-2266
(1993)). Thus, these techniques are
viable alternatives to traditional monoclonal antibody hybridoma techniques
for isolation of monoclonal antibodies.
The DNA that encodes the antibody may be modified to produce chimeric or
fusion antibody
polypeptides, for example, by substituting human heavy chain and light chain
constant domain (CH and CL)
sequences for the homologous murine sequences (U.S. Patent No. 4,816,567; and
Morrison, et aL, Proc. Natl Acad.
Sci. USA, 81:6851 (1984)), or by fusing the immunoglobulin coding sequence
with all or part of the coding
sequence for a non-immunoglobulin polypeptide (heterologous polypeptide). The
non-immunoglobulin
polypeptide sequences can substitute for the constant domains of an antibody,
or they are substituted for the
variable domains of one antigen-combining site of an antibody to create a
chimeric bivalent antibody comprising
one antigen-combining site having specificity for an antigen and another
antigen-combining site having specificity
for a different antigen.
3. Human and Humanized Antibodies
The anti-TAT antibodies of the invention may further comprise humanized
antibodies or human
antibodies. Humanized forms of non-human (e.g., murine) antibodies are
chimeric immunoglobulins,
immunoglobulin chains or fragments thereof (such as Fv, Fab, Fab', F(ab')z or
other antigen-binding subsequences
of antibodies) which contain minimal sequence derived from non-human
immunoglobulin. Humanized antibodies
include human imrnunoglobulins (recipient antibody) in which residues from a
complementary determining region
(CDR) of the recipient are replaced by residues from a CDR of a non-human
species (donor antibody) such as
mouse, rat or rabbit having the desired specificity, affinity and capacity. In
some instances, Fv framework residues
of the human inununoglobulin are replaced by corresponding non-human residues.
Humanized antibodies may
also comprise residues which are found neither in the recipient antibody nor
in the imported CDR or framework
sequences. In general, the humanized antibody will comprise substantially all
of at least one, and typically two,
variable domains, in which all or substantially all of the CDR regions
correspond to those of a non-human
immunoglobulin and all or substantially all of the FR regions are those of a
human immunoglobulin consensus
sequence. The humanized antibody optimally also will comprise at least a
portion of an immunoglobulin constant
region (Fc), typically that of a human immunoglobulin [Jones et al., Nature,
321:522-525 (1986); Riechmann et
al., Nature, 332:323-329 (1988); and Presta, Curr. Op. Struct. Biol., 2:593-
596 (1992)].
Methods for humanizing non-human antibodies are well known in the art.
Generally, a humanized
antibody has one or more amino acid residues introduced into it from a source
which is non-human. These non-
human amino acid residues are often referred to as "import" residues, which
are typically taken from an "import"
variable domain. Humanization can be essentially performed following the
method of Winter and co-workers
[Jones et al., Nature, 321:522-525 (1986); Riechmann et al., Nature, 332:323-
327 (1988); Verhoeyen et al.,


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Science, 239:1534-1536 (1988)], by substituting rodent CDRs or CDR sequences
for the corresponding sequences
of a human antibody. Accordingly, such "humanized" antibodies are chimeric
antibodies (U.S. Patent No.
4,816,567), wherein substantially less than an intact human variable domain
has been substituted by the
corresponding sequence from a non-human species. In practice, humanized
antibodies are typically human
antibodies in which some CDR residues and possibly some FR residues are
substituted by residues from analogous
sites in rodent antibodies.
The choice of human variable domains, both light and heavy, to be used in
making the humanized
antibodies is very important to reduce antigenicity and HAMA response (human
anti-mouse antibody) when the
antibody is intended for human therapeutic use. According to the so-called
"best-fit" method, the sequence of the
variable domain of a rodent antibody is screened against the entire library of
known human variable domain
sequences. The human V domain sequence which is closest to that of the rodent
is identified and the human
framework region (FR) within it accepted for the humanized antibody (Sims et
al., J. Immunol. 151:2296 (1993);
Chothia et al., J. Mol. Biol., 196:901 (1987)). Another method uses a
particular framework region derived from
the consensus sequence of all human antibodies of a particular subgroup of
light or heavy chains. The same
framework may be used for several different humanized antibodies (Carter et
al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA,
89:4285 (1992); Presta et al., J. Immunol. 151:2623 (1993)).
It is further important that antibodies be humanized with retention of high
binding affinity for the antigen
and other favorable biological properties. To achieve this goal, according to
a preferred method, humanized
antibodies are prepared by a process of analysis of the parental sequences and
various conceptual humanized
products using three-diinensional models of the parental and humanized
sequences. Three-dimensional
immunoglobulin models are commonly available and are familiar to those skilled
in the art. Computer programs
are available which illustrate and display probable three-dimensional
conformational structures of selected
candidate immunoglobulin sequences. Inspection of these displays permits
analysis of the likely role of the
residues in the functioning of the candidate immunoglobulin sequence, i.e.,
the analysis of residues that influence
the ability of the candidate immunoglobulin to bind its antigen. In this way,
FR residues can be selected and
combined from the recipient and import sequences so that the desired antibody
characteristic, such as increased
affinity for the target antigen(s), is achieved. In general, the hypervariable
region residues are directly and most
substantially involved in influencing antigen binding.
Various forms of a humanized anti-TAT antibody are contemplated. For example,
the humanized
antibody may be an antibody fragment, such as a Fab, which is optionally
conjugated with one or more cytotoxic
agent(s) in order to generate an immunoconjugate. Alternatively, the humanized
antibody may be an intact
antibody, such as an intact IgGl antibody.
As an alternative to humanization, human antibodies can be generated. For
example, it is now possible
to produce transgenic animals (e.g., mice) that are capable, upon
immunization, of producing a full repertoire of
human antibodies in the absence of endogenous immunoglobulin production. For
example, it has been described
that the homozygous deletion of the antibody heavy-chain joining region (JH)
gene in chimeric and germ-line
mutant mice results in complete inhibition of endogenous antibody production.
Transfer of the human germ-line
immunoglobulin gene array into such germ-line mutant mice will result in the
production of human antibodies upon
antigen challenge. See, e.g., Jakobovits et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA,
90:2551 (1993); Jakobovits et al.,
66


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Nature, 362:255-258 (1993); Bruggemann et al., Year in Immuno. 7:33 (1993);
U.S. Patent Nos. 5,545,806,
5,569,825, 5,591,669 (all of GenPharm); 5,545,807; and WO 97/17852.
Alternatively, phage display technology (McCafferty et al., Nature 348:552-553
[1990]) can be used to
produce human antibodies and antibody fragments in vitro, from immunoglobulin
variable (V) domain gene
repertoires from unimmunized donors. According to this technique, antibody V
domain genes are cloned in-frame
into either a major or minor coat protein gene of a filamentous bacteriophage,
such as M13 or fd, and displayed
as functional antibody fragments on the surface of the phage particle. Because
the filamentous particle contains
a single-stranded DNA copy of the phage genome, selections based on the
functional properties of the antibody
also result in selection of the gene encoding the antibody exhibiting those
properties. Thus, the phage miniics some
of the properties of the B-cell. Phage display can be performed in a variety
of formats, reviewed in, e.g., Johnson,
Kevin S. and Chiswell, David J., Current Opinion in Structural Biology 3:564-
571(1993). Several sources of V-
gene segments can be used for phage display. Clackson et al., Nature, 352:624-
628 (1991) isolated a diverse array
of anti-oxazolone antibodies from a small random combinatorial library of V
genes derived from the spleens of
immunized mice. A repertoire of V genes from unimmunized human donors can be
constructed and antibodies
to a diverse array of antigens (including self-antigens) can be isolated
essentially following the techniques
described by Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol. 222:581-597 (1991), or Griffith et
al., EMBO J.12:725-734 (1993). See,
also, U.S. Patent Nos. 5,565,332 and 5,573,905.
As discussed above, human antibodies may also be generated by in vitro
activated B cells (see U.S.
Patents 5,567,610 and 5,229,275).
4. Antibodv fragments
In certain circumstances there are advantages of using antibody fragments,
rather than whole antibodies.
The smaller size of the fragments allows for rapid clearance, and may lead to
improved access to solid tumors.
Various techniques have been developed for the production of antibody
fragments. Traditionally, these
fragments were derived via proteolytic digestion of intact antibodies (see,
e.g., Morimoto et al., Journal of
Biochemical and Biophysical Methods 24:107-117 (1992); and Brennan et al.,
Science, 229:81(1985)). However,
these fragments can now be produced directly by recombinant host cells. Fab,
Fv and ScFv antibody fragments
can all be expressed in and secreted from E. coli, thus allowing the facile
production of large amounts of these
fragments. Antibody fragments can be isolated from the antibody phage
libraries discussed above. Alternatively,
Fab'-SH fragments can be directly recovered from E. coli and chemically
coupled to formF(ab')2 fragments (Carter
et al., Bio/Technology 10:163-167 (1992)). According to another approach,
F(ab')2 fragments can be isolated
directly from recombinant host cell culture. Fab and F(ab')2 fragment with
increased in vivo half-life comprising
a salvage receptor binding epitope residues are described in U.S. Patent No.
5,869,046. Other techniques for the
production of antibody fragments will be apparent to the skilled practitioner.
In other embodiments, the antibody
of choice is a single chain Fv fragment (scFv). See WO 93/16185; U.S. Patent
No. 5,571,894; and U.S. Patent
No. 5,587,458. Fv and sFv are the only species with intact combining sites
that are devoid of constant regions;
thus, they are suitable for reduced nonspecific binding during in vivo use,
sFv fusion proteins may be constructed
to yield fusion of an effector protein at either the amino or the carboxy
terminus of an sFv. See Antibodv
Engineering, ed. Borrebaeck, supra. The antibody fragment may also be a
"linear antibody", e.g., as described in
U.S. Patent 5,641,870 for example. Such linear antibody fragments may be
monospecific or bispecific.

67


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
5. Bispecific Antibodies
Bispecific antibodies are antibodies that have binding specificities for at
least two different epitopes.
Exemplary bispecific antibodies may bind to two different epitopes of a TAT
protein as described herein. Other
such antibodies may combine a TAT binding site with a binding site for another
protein. Alternatively, an anti-
TAT arm may be combined with an arm which binds to a triggering molecule on a
leukocyte such as a T-cell
receptor molecule (e.g. CD3), or Fc receptors for IgG (FcyR), such as FcyRI
(CD64), FcyRII (CD32) and FcyRIII
(CD 16), so as to focus and localize cellular defense mechanisms to the TAT-
expressing cell. Bispecific antibodies
may also be used to localize cytotoxic agents to cells which express TAT.
These antibodies possess a TAT-
binding arm and an arm which binds the cytotoxic agent (e.g., saporin, anti-
interferon-a, vinca alkaloid, ricin A
chain, methotrexate or radioactive isotope hapten). Bispecific antibodies can
be prepared as full length antibodies
or antibody fragments (e.g., F(ab')2 bispecific antibodies).
WO 96/16673 describes a bispecific anti-ErbB2/anti-FcyRIII antibody and U.S.
Patent No. 5,837,234
discloses a bispecific anti-ErbB2/anti-Fc-yRI antibody. A bispecific anti-
ErbB2/Fca antibody is shown in
W098/02463. U.S. Patent No. 5,821,337 teaches a bispecific anti-ErbB2/anti-CD3
antibody.
Methods for making bispecific antibodies are known in the art. Traditional
production of full length
bispecific antibodies is based on the co-expression of two immunoglobulin
heavy chain-light chain pairs, where
the two chains have different specificities (Millstein et al., Nature 305:537-
539 (1983)). Because of the random
assortment of immunoglobulin heavy and light chains, these hybridomas
(quadromas) produce a potential mixture
of 10 different antibody molecules, of which only one has the correct
bispecific structure. Purification of the
correct molecule, which is usually done by affinity chromatography steps, is
rather cumbersome, and the product
yields are low. Similar procedures are disclosed in WO 93/08829, and in
Traunecker et al., EMBO J. 10:3655-
3659 (1991).
According to a different approach, antibody variable domains with the desired
binding specificities
(antibody-antigen combining sites) are fused to immunoglobulin constant domain
sequences. Preferably, the fusion
is with an Ig heavy chain constant domain, comprising at least part of the
hinge, CH2, and CH3 regions. It is
preferred to have the first heavy-chain constant region (CHl ) containing the
site necessary for light chain bonding,
present in at least one of the fusions. DNAs encoding the immunoglobulin heavy
chain fusions and, if desired, the
immunoglobulin light chain, are inserted into separate expression vectors, and
are co-transfected into a suitable
host cell. This provides for greater flexibility in adjusting the mutual
proportions of the three polypeptide
fragments in embodiments when unequal ratios of the three polypeptide chains
used in the construction provide
the optimum yield of the desired bispecific antibody. It is, however, possible
to insert the coding sequences for
two or all three polypeptide chains into a single expression vector when the
expression of at least two polypeptide
chains in equal ratios results in high yields or when the ratios have no
significant affect on the yield of the desired
chain combination.
In a preferred embodiment of this approach, the bispecific antibodies are
composed of a hybrid
inununoglobulin heavy chain with afirst binding specificity in one arm, and a
hybrid immunoglobulin heavy chain-
light chain pair (providing a second binding specificity) in the other arm. It
was found that this asymmetric
structure facilitates the separation of the desired bispecific compound from
unwanted immunoglobulin chain
combinations, as the presence of an immunoglobulin light chain in only one
half of the bispecific molecule
68


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
provides for a facile way of separation. This approach is disclosed in WO
94/04690. For further details of
generating bispecific antibodies see, for example, Suresh et al., Methods in
Enzymology 121:210 (1986).
According to another approach described in U.S. Patent No. 5,731,168, the
interface between a pair of
antibody molecules can be engineered to maximize the percentage of
heterodimers which are recovered from
recombinant cell culture. The preferred interface comprises at least a part of
the CH3 domain. In this method, one
or more small amino acid side chains from the interface of the first antibody
molecule are replaced with larger side
chains (e.g., tyrosine or tryptophan). Compensatory "cavities" of identical or
similar size to the large side chain(s)
are created on the interface of the second antibody molecule by replacing
large amino acid side chains with smaller
ones (e.g., alanine or threonine). This provides a mechanism for increasing
the yield of the heterodimer over other
unwanted end-products such as homodimers.
Bispecific antibodies include cross-linked or "heteroconjugate" antibodies.
For example, one of the
antibodies in the heteroconjugate can be coupled to avidin, the other to
biotin. Such antibodies have, for example,
been proposed to target immune system cells to unwanted cells (U.S. Patent No.
4,676,980), and for treatment of
HIV infection (WO 91/00360, WO 92/200373, and EP 03089). Heteroconjugate
antibodies may be made using
any convenient cross-linking methods. Suitable cross-linking agents are well
known in the art, and are disclosed
in U.S. Patent No. 4,676,980, along with a number of cross-linking techniques.
Techniques for generating bispecific antibodies from antibody fragments have
also been described in the
literature. For example, bispecific antibodies can be prepared using chemical
linkage. Brennan et al., Science
229:81 (1985) describe a procedure wherein intact antibodies are
proteolytically cleaved to generate F(ab')2
fragments. These fragments are reduced in the presence of the dithiol
complexing agent, sodium arsenite, to
stabilize vicinal dithiols and prevent intermolecular disulfide formation. The
Fab' fragments generated are then
converted to thionitrobenzoate (TNB) derivatives. One of the Fab'-TNB
derivatives is then reconverted to the
Fab'-thiol by reduction with mercaptoethylamine and is mixed with an equimolar
amount of the other Fab'-TNB
derivative to form the bispecific antibody. The bispecific antibodies produced
can be used as agents for the
selective inunobilization of enzymes.
Recent progress has facilitated the direct recovery of Fab'-SH fragments from
E. coli, which can be
chemically coupled to form bispecific antibodies. Shalaby et al., J. Exp. Med.
175: 217-225 (1992) describe the
production of a fully humanized bispecific antibody F(ab')2 molecule. Each
Fab' fragment was separately secreted
from E. coli and subjected to directed chemical coupling in vitro to form the
bispecific antibody. The bispecific
antibody thus formed was able to bind to cells overexpressing the ErbB2
receptor and normal human T cells, as
well as trigger the lytic activity of human cytotoxic lymphocytes against
human breast tumor targets.
Various techniques for making and isolating bispecific antibody fragments
directly from recombinant cell culture
have also been described. For example, bispecific antibodies have been
produced using leucine zippers. Kostelny
et al., J. Immunol. 148(5):1547-1553 (1992). The leucine zipper peptides from
the Fos and Jun proteins were
linked to the Fab' portions of two different antibodies by gene fusion. The
antibody homodimers were reduced
at the hinge region to form monomers and then re-oxidized to form the antibody
heterodimers. This method can
also be utilized for the production of antibody homodimers. The "diabody"
technology described by Hollinger
et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 90:6444-6448 (1993) has provided an
alternative mechanism for making
bispecific antibody fragments. The fragments comprise a VH connected to a VL
by a linker which is too short to
69


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
allow pairing between the two domains on the same chain. Accordingly, the VH
and VL domains of one fragment
are forced to pair with the complementary VL and VH domains of another
fragment, thereby forming two antigen-
binding sites. Another strategy for making bispecific antibody fragments by
the use of single-chain Fv (sFv)
dimers has also been reported. See Gruber et al., J. Immunol., 152:5368
(1994).
Antibodies with more than two valencies are contemplated. For example,
trispecific antibodies can be
prepared. Tutt et al., J. Immunol. 147:60 (1991).
6. Heteroconiugate Antibodies
Heteroconjugateantibodiesarealsowithinthescopeofthepresentinvention.
Heteroconjugateantibodies
are composed of two covalently joined antibodies. Such antibodies have, for
example, been proposed to target
immune system cells to unwanted cells [U.S. Patent No. 4,676,980], and for
treatment of HIV infection [WO
91/00360; WO 92/200373; EP 03089]. It is contemplated that the antibodies may
be prepared in vitro using
known methods in synthetic protein cheniistry, including those involving
crosslinking agents. For example,
immunotoxins may be constructed using a disulfide exchange reaction or by forn-
ung a thioether bond. Examples
of suitable reagents for this purpose include iniinothiolate and methyl-4-
mercaptobutyrimidate and those disclosed,
for example, in U.S. Patent No. 4,676,980.
7. Multivalent Antibodies
A multivalent antibody may be internalized (and/or catabolized) faster than a
bivalent antibody by a cell
expressing an antigen to which the antibodies bind. The antibodies of the
present invention can be multivalent
antibodies (which are other than of the IgM class) with three or more antigen
binding sites (e.g. tetravalent
antibodies), which can be readily produced by recombinant expression of
nucleic acid encoding the polypeptide
chains of the antibody. The multivalent antibody can comprise a dimerization
domain and three or more antigen
binding sites. The preferred dimerization domain comprises (or consists of) an
Fc region or a hinge region. In this
scenario, the antibody will comprise an Fc region and three or more antigen
binding sites amino-terminal to the
Fc region. The preferred multivalent antibody herein comprises (or consists
of) three to about eight, but preferably
four, antigen binding sites. The multivalent antibody comprises at least one
polypeptide chain (and preferably two
polypeptide chains), wherein the polypeptide chain(s) comprise two or more
variable domains. For instance, the
polypeptide chain(s) may comprise VDI-(XI)õVD2-(X2)n Fc, wherein VD1 is a
first variable domain, VD2 is
a second variable domain, Fc is one polypeptide chain of an Fc region, Xl and
X2 represent an amino acid or
polypeptide, and n is 0 or 1. For instance, the polypeptide chain(s) may
comprise: VH-CH1-flexible linker-VH-
CH1-Fc region chain; or VH-CHI-VH-CHI-Fc region chain. The multivalent
antibody herein preferably further
comprises at least two (and preferably four) light chain variable domain
polypeptides. The multivalent antibody
herein may, for instance, comprise from about two to about eight light chain
variable domain polypeptides. The
light chain variable domain polypeptides contemplated here comprise a light
chain variable domain and, optionally,
further comprise a CL domain.
8. Effector Function Engineering
It may be desirable to modify the antibody of the invention with respect to
effector function, e.g., so as
to enhance antigen-dependent cell-mediated cyotoxicity (ADCC) and/or
complement dependent cytotoxicity
(CDC) of the antibody. This may be achieved by introducing one or more amino
acid substitutions in an Fc region
of the antibody. Alternatively or additionally, cysteine residue(s) may be
introduced in the Fc region, thereby


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
allowing interchain disulfide bond formation in this region. The homodimeric
antibody thus generated may have
improved internalization capability and/or increased complement-mediated cell
killing and antibody-dependent
cellular cytotoxicity (ADCC). See Caron et al., J. Exp Med. 176:1191-1195
(1992) and Shopes, B. J. Immunol.
148:2918-2922 (1992). Homodimeric antibodies with enhanced anti-tumor activity
may also be prepared using
heterobifunctional cross-linkers as described in Wolff et al., CancerResearch
53:2560-2565 (1993). Alternatively,
an antibody can be engineered which has dual Fc regions and may thereby have
enhanced complement lysis and
ADCCcapabilities. See Stevenson et al., Anti-Cancer Drug Desitrn 3:219-230
(1989). To increase the serum
half life of the antibody, one may incorporate a salvage receptor binding
epitope into the antibody (especially an
antibody fragment) as described in U.S. Patent 5,739,277, for example. As used
herein, the term "salvage receptor
binding epitope" refers to an epitope of the Fc region of an IgG molecule
(e.g., IgG1, IgG2, IgG3, or IgG4) that is
responsible for increasing the in vivo serum half-life of the IgG molecule.
9. Immunoconiuj4ates
The invention also pertains to immunoconjugates comprising an antibody
conjugated to acytotoxic agent
such as a chemotherapeutic agent, a growth inhibitory agent, a toxin (e.g., an
enzymatically active toxin of
bacterial, fungal, plant, or animal origin, or fragments thereof), or a
radioactive isotope (i.e., a radioconjugate).
Chemotherapeutic agents useful in the generation of such immunoconjugates have
been described above.
Enzymatically active toxins and fragments thereof that can be used include
diphtheria A chain, nonbinding active
fragments of diphtheria toxin, exotoxin A chain (from Pseudomonas aeruginosa),
ricin A chain, abrin A chain,
modeccin A chain, alpha-sarcin, Aleuritesfordii proteins, dianthin proteins,
Pliytolaca a tiericalza proteins (PAPI,
PAPII, and PAP-S), momordica charantia inhibitor, curcin, crotin, sapaonaria
officinalis inhibitor, gelonin,
mitogellin, restrictocin, phenomycin, enomycin, and the tricothecenes. A
variety of radionuclides are available
for the production of radioconjugated antibodies. Examples include 212Bi,
1311, 13'In, 90Y, and'86Re. Conjugates
of the antibody and cytotoxic agent are made using a variety of bifunctional
protein-coupling agents such as N-
succinimidyl-3-(2-pyridyldithiol) propionate (SPDP), iminotliiolane (IT),
bifunctional derivatives of imidoesters
(such as dimethyl adipimidate HCL), active esters (such as disuccinimidyl
suberate), aldehydes (such as
glutareldehyde), bis-azido compounds (such as bis (p-azidobenzoyl)
hexanediamine), bis-diazonium derivatives
(such as bis-(p-diazoniumbenzoyl)-ethylenediamine), diisocyanates (such as
tolyene 2,6-diisocyanate), and bis-
active fluorine compounds (such as 1,5-difluoro-2,4-dinitrobenzene). For
example, a ricin immunotoxin can be
prepared as described in Vitetta et al., Science, 238: 1098 (1987). Carbon-14-
labeled 1-isothiocyanatobenzyl-3-
methyldiethylene triaminepentaacetic acid (MX-DTPA) is an exemplary chelating
agent for conjugation of
radionucleotide to the antibody. See W094/11026.
Conjugates of an antibody and one or more small molecule toxins, such as a
calicheaniicin, maytansinoids,
a trichothene, and CC1065, and the derivatives of these toxins that have toxin
activity, are also contemplated
herein.
Maytansine and maytansinoids
In one preferred embodiment, an anti-TAT antibody (full length or fragments)
of the invention is
conjugated to one or more maytansinoid molecules.
Maytansinoids are mitototic inhibitors which act by inhibiting tubulin
polymerization. Maytansine was
first isolated from the east African shrub Mayterzus serrata (U.S. Patent No.
3,896,111). Subsequently, it was
71


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
discovered that certain microbes also produce maytansinoids, such as
maytansinol and C-3 maytansinol esters (U.S.
Patent No. 4,151,042). Synthetic maytansinol and derivatives and analogues
thereof are disclosed, for example,
in U.S. Patent Nos. 4,137,230; 4,248,870; 4,256,746; 4,260,608; 4,265,814;
4,294,757; 4,307,016; 4,308,268;
4,308,269; 4,309,428; 4,313,946; 4,315,929; 4,317,821; 4,322,348; 4,331,598;
4,361,650; 4,364,866; 4,424,219;
4,450,254; 4,362,663; and 4,371,533, the disclosures of which are hereby
expressly incorporated by reference.
Maytansinoid-antibody conjugates
In an attempt to improve their therapeutic index, maytansine and maytansinoids
have been conjugated
to antibodies specifically binding to tumor cell antigens. Immunoconjugates
containing maytansinoids and their
therapeutic use are disclosed, for example, in U.S. Patent Nos. 5,208,020,
5,416,064 and European Patent EP 0
425 235 B 1, the disclosures of which are hereby expressly incorporated
byreference. Liu et al., Proc. Natl. Acad.
Sci. USA 93:8618-8623 (1996) described immunoconjugates comprising a
maytansinoid designated DM1 linked
to the monoclonal antibody C242 directed against human colorectal cancer. The
conjugate was found to be highly
cytotoxic towards cultured colon cancer cells, and showed antitumor activity
in an in vivo tumor growth assay.
Chari et al., Cancer Research 52:127-131 (1992) describe immunoconjugates in
which a maytansinoid was
conjugated via a disulfide linker to the murine antibody A7 binding to an
antigen on human colon cancer cell lines,
or to another murine monoclonal antibody TA.1 that binds the HER-2/neu
oncogene. The cytotoxicity of the
TA.1-maytansonoid conjugate was tested in vitro on the human breast cancer
cell line SK-BR-3, which expresses
3 x 105 HER-2 surface antigens per cell. The drug conjugate achieved a degree
of cytotoxicity similar to the free
maytansonid drug, which could be increased by increasing the number of
maytansinoid molecules per antibody
molecule. The A7-maytansinoid conjugate showed low systemic cytotoxicity in
mice.
Anti-TAT polypeptide antibody-maytansinoid conjugates (immunoconjugates)
Anti-TAT antibody-maytansinoid conjugates are prepared by chemically linking
an anti-TAT antibody
to a maytansinoid molecule without significantly dinunishing the biological
activity of either the antibody or the
maytansinoid molecule. An average of 3-4 maytansinoid molecules conjugated per
antibody molecule has shown
efficacy in enhancing cytotoxicity of target cells without negatively
affecting the function or solubility of the
antibody, although even one molecule of toxin/antibody would be expected to
enhance cytotoxicity over the use
of naked antibody. Maytansinoids are well known in the art and can be
synthesized by known techniques or
isolated from natural sources. Suitable maytansinoids are disclosed, for
example, in U.S. Patent No. 5,208,020
and in the other patents and nonpatent publications referred to hereinabove.
Preferred maytansinoids are
maytansinol and maytansinol analogues modified in the aromatic ring or at
other positions of the maytansinol
molecule, sucti as various maytansinol esters.
There are many linking groups known in the art for making antibody-
maytansinoid conjugates, including,
for example, those disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 5,208,020 or EP Patent 0 425
235 B 1, and Chari et al., Cancer
Research 52:127-131 (1992). The linking groups include disufide groups,
thioether groups, acid labile groups,
photolabile groups, peptidase labile groups, or esterase labile groups, as
disclosed in the above-identified patents,
disulfide and thioether groups being preferred.
Conjugates of the antibody and maytansinoid may be made using a variety of
bifunctional protein
coupling agents such as N-succinimidyl-3-(2-pyridyldithio) propionate (SPDP),
succinimidyl-4-(N-
maleimidomethyl) cyclohexane-l-carboxylate, iminothiolane (IT), bifunctional
derivatives of imidoesters (such
72


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
as dimethyl adipimidate HCL), active esters (such as disuccinimidyl suberate),
aldehydes (such as glutareldehyde),
bis-azido compounds (such as bis (p-azidobenzoyl) hexanediamine), bis-
diazonium derivatives (such as bis-(p-
diazoniumbenzoyl)-ethylenediamine), diisocyanates (such as toluene 2,6-
diisocyanate), and bis-active fluorine
compounds (such as 1,5-difluoro-2,4-dinitrobenzene). Particularly preferred
coupling agents include N-
succinimidyl-3-(2-pyridyldithio) propionate (SPDP) (Carlsson et al., Biochem.
J. 173:723-737 [1978]) and N-
succinimidyl-4-(2-pyridylthio)pentanoate (SPP) to provide for a disulfide
linkage.
The linker may be attached to the maytansinoid molecule at various positions,
depending on the type of
the link. For example, an ester linkage may be formed by reaction with a
hydroxyl group using conventional
coupling techniques. The reaction may occur at the C-3 position having a
hydroxyl group, the C-14 position
modified with hyrdoxymethyl, the C-15 position modified with a hydroxyl group,
and the C-20 position having
a hydroxyl group. In a preferred embodiment, the linkage is formed at the C-3
position of maytansinol or a
maytansinol analogue.
Calicheamicin
Another immunoconjugate of interest comprises an anti-TAT antibody conjugated
to one or more
calicheamicin molecules. The calicheamicin family of antibiotics are capable
of producing double-stranded DNA
breaks at sub-picomolar concentrations. For the preparation of conjugates of
the calicheamicin family, see U.S.
patents 5,712,374, 5,714,586, 5,739,116, 5,767,285, 5,770,701, 5,770,710,
5,773,001, 5,877,296 (all to American
Cyanamid Company). Structural analogues of calicheamicin which may be used
include, but are not limited to,
yij, azi, a3i, N-acetyl-'yli, PSAG and 611 (Hinman et al., Cancer Research
53:3336-3342 (1993), Lode et al.,
Cancer Research 58:2925-2928 (1998) and the aforementioned U.S. patents to
American Cyanamid). Another
anti-tumor drug that the antibody can be conjugated is QFA which is an
antifolate. Both calicheamicin and QFA
have intracellular sites of action and do not readily cross the plasma
membrane. Therefore, cellular uptake of these
agents through antibody mediated internalization greatly enhances their
cytotoxic effects.
Other cytotoxic agents
Other antitumor agents that can be conjugated to the anti-TAT antibodies of
the invention include BCNU,
streptozoicin,, vincristine and 5-fluorouracil, the family of agents known
collectively LL-E33288 complex
described in U.S. patents 5,053,394, 5,770,710, as well as esperamicins (U.S.
patent 5,877,296).
Enzymatically active toxins and fragments thereof which can be used include
diphtheria A chain,
nonbinding active fragments of diphtheria toxin, exotoxin A chain (from
Pseudoniafaas aeruginosa), ricin A chain,
abrin A chain, modeccin A chain, alpha-sarcin, Aleuritesfordii proteins,
dianthin proteins, Plzytolaca arnericaua
proteins (PAPI, PAPII, and PAP-S), momordicacharantiainhibitor, curcin,
crotin, sapaonaria officinalis inhibitor,
gelonin, mitogellin, restrictocin, phenomycin, enomycin and the tricothecenes.
See, for example, WO 93/21232
published October 28, 1993.
The present invention further contemplates an immunoconjugate formed between
an antibody and a
compound with nucleolytic activity (e.g., a ribonuclease or a DNA endonuclease
such as a deoxyribonuclease;
DNase).
For selective destruction of the tumor, the antibody may comprise a highly
radioactive atom. A variety
of radioactive isotopes are available for the production of radioconjugated
anti-TAT antibodies. Examples include
At211, 1 131, 1 125, Y9o, Rel96, Re188, Smt53 Bi212, P32, Pb212 and
radioactive isotopes of Lu. When the conjugate is
73


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
used for diagnosis, it may comprise a radioactive atom for scintigraphic
studies, for example tc99 ' or I123, or a spin
label for nuclear magnetic resonance (NMR) imaging (also known as magnetic
resonance imaging, mri), such as
iodine-123 again, iodine-131, indium-111, fluorine-19, carbon- 13, nitrogen-
15, oxygen-17, gadolinium, manganese
or iron.
The radio- or other labels may be incorporated in the conjugate in known ways.
For example, the peptide
may be biosynthesized or may be synthesized by chemical amino acid synthesis
using suitable amino acid
precursors involving, for example, fluorine-19 in place of hydrogen. Labels
such as tc99ni or I123, .Rel86, Rel$$
and Inltl can be attached via a cysteine residue in the peptide. Yttrium-90
can be attached via a lysine residue.
The IODOGEN method (Fraker et al (1978) Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 80: 49-
57 can be used to
incorporate iodine-123. "Monoclonal Antibodies in Immunoscintigraphy"
(Chatal,CRC Press 1989) describes
other methods in detail.
Conjugates of the antibody and cytotoxic agent may be made using a variety of
bifunctional protein
coupling agents such as N-succinimidyl-3-(2-pyridyldithio) propionate (SPDP),
succinimidyl-4-(N-
maleimidomethyl) cyclohexane-l-carboxylate, iminothiolane (IT), bifunctional
derivatives of imidoesters (such
as dimethyl adipimidate HCL), active esters (such as disuccinimidyl suberate),
aldehydes (such as glutareldehyde),
bis-azido compounds (such as bis (p-azidobenzoyl) hexanediamine), bis-
diazonium derivatives (such as bis-(p-
diazoniumbenzoyl)-ethylenediamine), diisocyanates (such as tolyene 2,6-
diisocyanate), and bis-active fluorine
compounds (such as 1,5-difluoro-2,4-dinitrobenzene). For example, a ricin
immunotoxin can be prepared as
described in Vitetta et al., Science 238:1098 (1987). Carbon-14-labeled 1-
isotliiocyanatobenzyl-3-
methyldiethylene triaminepentaacetic acid (MX-DTPA) is an exemplary chelating
agent for conjugation of
radionucleotide to the antibody. See W094/11026. The linker may be a
"cleavable linker" facilitating release of
the cytotoxic drug in the cell. For example, an acid-labile linker, peptidase-
sensitive linker, photolabile linker,
dimethyl linker or disulfide-containing linker (Chari et al., Cancer Research
52:127-131 (1992); U.S. Patent No.
5,208,020) may be used.
Alternatively, a fusion protein comprising the anti-TAT antibody and cytotoxic
agent may be made, e.g.,
by recombinant techniques or peptide synthesis. The length of DNA may comprise
respective regions encoding
the two portions of the conjugate either adjacent one another or separated by
a region encoding a linker peptide
which does not destroy the desired properties of the conjugate.
In yet another embodiment, the antibody may be conjugated to a "receptor"
(such streptavidin) for
utilization in tumor pre-targeting wherein the antibody-receptor conjugate is
administered to the patient, followed
by removal of unbound conjugate from the circulation using a clearing agent
and then administration of a"ligand"
(e.g., avidin) which is conjugated to a cytotoxic agent (e.g., a
radionucleotide).
10. Immunolinosomes
The anti-TAT antibodies disclosed herein may also be formulated as
immunoliposomes. A "liposome"
is a small vesicle composed of various types of lipids, phospholipids and/or
surfactant which is useful for delivery
of a drug to a mammal. The components of the liposome are commonly arranged in
a bilayer formation, similar
to the lipid arrangement of biological membranes. Liposomes containing the
antibody are prepared by methods
known in the art, such as described in Epstein et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci.
USA 82:3688 (1985); Hwang et al.,
Proc. Natl Acad. Sci. USA 77:4030 (1980); U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,485,045 and
4,544,545; and W097/38731 published
74


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
October 23, 1997. Liposomes with enhanced circulation time are disclosed in
U.S. Patent No. 5,013,556.
Particularly useful liposomes can be generated by the reverse phase
evaporation method with a lipid
composition comprising phosphatidylcholine, cholesterol and PEG-derivatized
phosphatidylethanolamine (PEG-
PE). Liposomes are extruded through filters of defined pore size to yield
liposomes with the desired diameter.
Fab' fragments of the antibody of the present invention can be conjugated to
the liposomes as described in Martin
et al., J. Biol. Chem. 257:286-288 (1982) via a disulfide interchange
reaction. A chemotherapeutic agent is
optionally contained within the liposome. See Gabizon et al., J. National
Cancer Inst. 81(19):1484 (1989).
B. TAT Binding Oligopeptides
TAT binding oligopeptides of the present invention are oligopeptides that
bind, preferably specifically,
to a TAT polypeptide as described herein. TAT binding oligopeptides may be
chemically synthesized using known
oligopeptide synthesis methodology or may be prepared and purified using
recombinant technology. TAT binding
oligopeptides are usually at least about 5 amino acids in length,
alternatively at least about 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12,
13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31,
32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42,
43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 61,
62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72,
73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 84, 85, 86, 87, 88, 89, 90, 91,
92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99, or 100
amino acids in length or more, wherein such oligopeptides that are capable of
binding, preferably specifically, to
a TAT polypeptide as described herein. TAT binding oligopeptides may be
identified without undue
experimentation using well known techniques. In this regard, it is noted that
techniques for screening oligopeptide
libraries for oligopeptides that are capable of specifically binding to a
polypeptide target are well known in the art
(see, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 5,556,762, 5,750,373, 4,708,871, 4,833,092,
5,223,409, 5,403,484, 5,571,689,
5,663,143; PCT Publication Nos. WO 84/03506 and W084/03564; Geysen et al.,
Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A.,
81:3998-4002 (1984); Geysen et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A., 82:178-182
(1985); Geysen et al., in Synthetic
Peptides as Antigens, 130-149 (1986); Geysen et al., J. Immunol. Meth.,
102:259-274 (1987); Schoofs et al., J.
Immunol., 140:611-616 (1988), Cwirla, S. E. et al. (1990) Proc. Natl. Acad.
Sci. USA, 87:6378; Lowman, H.B.
et al. (1991) Biochemistry, 30:10832; Clackson, T. et al. (1991) Nature, 352:
624; Marks, J. D. et al. (1991), J.
Mol. Biol., 222:581; Kang, A.S. et al. (1991) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA,
88:8363, and Smith, G. P. (1991)
Current Opin. Biotechnol., 2:668).
In this regard, bacteriophage (phage) display is one well known technique
which allows one to screen
large oligopeptide libraries to identify member(s) of those libraries which
are capable of specifically binding to
a polypeptide target. Phage display is a technique by which variant
polypeptides are displayed as fusion proteins
to the coatprotein on the surface of bacteriophage particles (Scott, J.K. and
Smith, G. P. (1990) Science 249: 386).
The utility of phage display lies in the fact that large libraries of
selectively randomized protein variants (or
randomly cloned cDNAs) can be rapidly and efficiently sorted for those
sequences that bind to a target molecule
with high affinity. Display of peptide (Cwirla, S. E. et al. (1990) Proc.
Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 87:6378) or protein
(Lowman, H.B. et al. (1991) Biocheniistry, 30:10832; Clackson, T. et al.
(1991) Nature, 352: 624; Marks, J. D.
et al. (1991), J. Mol. Biol., 222:581; Kang, A.S. et al. (1991) Proc. Natl.
Acad. Sci. USA, 88:8363) libraries on
phage have been used for screening millions of polypeptides or oligopeptides
for ones with specific binding
properties (Smith, G. P. (1991) Current Opin. Biotechnol., 2:668). Sorting
phage libraries of random mutants
requires a strategy for constructing and propagating a large number of
variants, a procedure for affinity purification


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
using the target receptor, and a means of evaluating the results of binding
enrichments. U.S. Patent Nos.
5,223,409, 5,403,484, 5,571,689, and 5,663,143.
Although most phage display methods have used filamentous phage, lambdoid
phage display systems
(WO 95/34683; U.S. 5,627,024), T4 phage display systems (Ren et al., Gene,
215: 439 (1998); Zhu et al., Cancer
Research, 58(15): 3209-3214 (1998); Jiang et al., Infection & Immunity,
65(11): 4770-4777 (1997); Ren et al.,
Gene, 195(2):303-311 (1997); Ren, Protein Sci., 5: 1833 (1996); Efimov et al.,
Virus Genes, 10: 173 (1995)) and
T7 phage display systems (Smith and Scott, Methods in Enzymology, 217: 228-257
(1993); U.S. 5,766,905) are
also known.
Many other improvements and variations of the basic phage display concept have
now been developed.
These improvements enhance the ability of display systems to screen peptide
libraries for binding to selected target
molecules and to display functional proteins with the potential of screening
these proteins for desired properties.
Combinatorial reaction devices for phage display reactions have been developed
(WO 98/14277) and phage
display libraries have been used to analyze and control bimolecular
interactions (WO 98/20169; WO 98/20159)
and properties of constrained helical peptides (WO 98/20036). WO 97/35196
describes a method of isolating an
affinity ligand in which a phage display library is contacted with one
solution in which the ligand will bind to a
target molecule and a second solution in which the affinity ligand will not
bind to the target molecule, to selectively
isolate binding ligands. WO 97/46251 describes a method of biopanning a random
phage display library with an
affinity purified antibody and then isolating binding phage, followed by a
micropanning process using microplate
wells to isolate high affinity binding phage. The use of Staphlylococcus
aureus protein A as an affinity tag has
also been reported (Li et al. (1998) Mol Biotech., 9:187). WO 97/47314
describes the use of substrate subtraction
libraries to distinguish enzyme specificities using a combinatorial library
which may be a phage display library.
A method for selecting enzymes suitable for use in detergents using phage
display is described in WO 97/09446.
Additional methods of selecting specific binding proteins are described in
U.S. Patent Nos. 5,498,538,5,432,018,
and WO 98/15833.
Methods of generating peptide libraries and screening these libraries are also
disclosed in U.S. PatentNos.
5,723,286, 5,432,018, 5,580,717, 5,427,908, 5,498,530, 5,770,434, 5,734,018,
5,698,426, 5,763,192, and
5,723,323.
C. TAT Binding Organic Molecules
TAT binding organic molecules are organic molecules other than oligopeptides
or antibodies as defined
herein that bind, preferably specifically, to a TAT polypeptide as described
herein. TAT binding organic
molecules may be identified and chemically synthesized using known methodology
(see, e.g., PCT Publication
Nos. W000/00823 and W000/39585). TAT binding organic molecules are usually
less than about 2000 daltons
in size, alternatively less than about 1500, 750, 500, 250 or 200 daltons in
size, wherein such organic molecules
that are capable of binding, preferably specifically, to a TAT polypeptide as
described herein may be identified
without undue experimentation using well known techniques. In this regard, it
is noted that techniques for
screening organic molecule libraries for molecules that are capable of binding
to a polypeptide target are well
known in the art (see, e.g., PCT Publication Nos. W000/00823 and W000/39585).
TAT binding organic
molecules may be, for example, aldehydes, ketones, oximes, hydrazones,
semicarbazones, carbazides, primary
amines, secondary amines, tertiary amines, N-substituted hydrazines,
hydrazides, alcohols, ethers, thiols, thioethers,
76


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
disulfides, carboxylic acids, esters, amides, ureas, carbamates, carbonates,
ketals, thioketals, acetals, thioacetals,
aryl halides, aryl sulfonates, alkyl halides, alkyl sulfonates, aromatic
compounds, heterocyclic compounds, anilines,
alkenes, alkynes, diols, amino alcohols, oxazolidines, oxazolines,
thiazolidines, thiazolines, enamines,
sulfonamides, epoxides, aziridines, isocyanates, sulfonyl chlorides, diazo
compounds, acid chlorides, or the like.
D. . Screening for Anti-TAT Antibodies, TAT Binding Oliaopeptides and TAT
Binding Organic
Molecules With the Desired Pronerties
Techniques for generating antibodies, oligopeptides and organic molecules that
bind to TAT polypeptides
have been described above. One may further select antibodies, oligopeptides or
other organic molecules with
certain biological characteristics, as desired.
The growth inhibitory effects of an anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or other
organic molecule of the
invention may be assessed by methods known in the art, e.g., using cells which
express a TAT polypeptide either
endogenously or following transfection with the TAT gene. For example,
appropriate tumor cell lines and TAT-
transfected cells inay treated with an anti-TAT monoclonal antibody,
oligopeptide or other organic molecule of
the invention at various concentrations for a few days (e.g., 2-7) days and
stained with crystal violet or MTT or
analyzed by some other colorimetric assay. Another method of measuring
proliferation would be by comparing
3H-thymidine uptake by the cells treated in the presence or absence an anti-
TAT antibody, TAT binding
oligopeptide or TAT binding organic molecule of the invention. After
treatment, the cells are harvested and the
amount of radioactivity incorporated into the DNA quantitated in a
scintillation counter. Appropriate positive
controls include treatment of a selected cell line with a growth inhibitory
antibody known to inhibit growth of that
cell line. Growth inhibition of tumor cells in vivo can be deterniined in
various ways known in the art. Preferably,
the tumor cell is one that overexpresses a TAT polypeptide. Preferably, the
anti-TAT antibody, TAT binding
oligopeptide or TAT binding organic molecule will inhibit cell proliferation
of a TAT-expressing tumor cell in
vitro or in vivo by about 25-100% compared to the untreated tumor cell, more
preferably, by about 30-100%, and
even more preferably by about 50-100% or 70-100%, in one embodiment, at an
antibody concentration of about
0.5 to 30 g/ml. Growth inhibition can be measured at an antibody
concentration of about 0.5 to 30 g/m1 or about
0.5 nM to 200 nM in cell culture, where the growth inhibition is determined 1-
10 days after exposure of the tumor
cells to the antibody. The antibody is growth inhibitory in vivo if
administration of the anti-TAT antibody at about
1 g/lcg to about 100 mg/kg body weight results in reduction in tumor size or
reduction of tumor cell proliferation
within about 5 days to 3 months from the first administration of the antibody,
preferably within about 5 to 30 days.
To select for an anti-TAT antibody, TAT binding oligopeptide or TAT binding
organic molecule which
induces cell death, loss of membrane integrity as indicated by, e.g.,
propidium iodide (PI), trypan blue or 7AAD
uptake may be assessed relative to control. A PI uptake assay can be performed
in the absence of complement and
immune effector cells. TAT polypeptide-expressing tumor cells are incubated
with medium alone or medium
containing the appropriate anti-TAT antibody (e.g, at about 10 g/ml), TAT
binding oligopeptide or TAT binding
organic molecule. The cells are incubated for a 3 day time period. Following
each treatment, cells are washed
and aliquoted into 35 mm strainer-capped 12 x 75 tubes (lml per tube, 3 tubes
per treatment group) for removal
of cell clumps. Tubes then receive PI (10 g/ml). Samples may be analyzed using
a FACSCANO flow cytometer
and FACSCONVERT CellQuest software (Becton Dickinson). Those anti-TAT
antibodies, TAT binding
oligopeptides or TAT binding organic molecules that induce statistically
significant levels of cell death as
77


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
determined by PI uptake may be selected as cell death-inducing anti-TAT
antibodies, TAT binding oligopeptides
or TAT binding organic molecules.
To screen for antibodies, oligopeptides or other organic molecules which bind
to an epitope on a TAT
polypeptide bound by an antibody of interest, a routine cross-blocking assay
such as that described in Antibodies,
A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, Ed Harlow and David Lane
(1988), can be performed.
This assay can be used to determine if a test antibody, oligopeptide or other
organic molecule binds the same site
or epitope as a known anti-TAT antibody. Alternatively, or additionally,
epitope mapping can be performed by
methods known in the art. For example, the antibody sequence can be
mutagenized such as by alanine scanning,
to identify contact residues. The mutant antibody is initailly tested for
binding with polyclonal antibody to ensure
proper folding. In a different method, peptides corresponding to different
regions of a TAT polypeptide can be
used in competition assays with the test antibodies or with a test antibody
and an antibody with a characterized or
known epitope.
E. Antibody Dependent Enzyme Mediated Prodrug Therapy (ADEPT)
The antibodies of the present invention may also be used in ADEPT by
conjugating the antibody to a
prodrug-activating enzyme which converts a prodrug (e.g., a peptidyl
chemotherapeutic agent, see W08 1/01145)
to an active anti-cancer drug. See, for example, WO 88/07378 and U.S. Patent
No. 4,975,278.
The enzyme component of the immunoconjugate useful for ADEPT includes any
enzyme capable of
acting on a prodrug in such a way so as to covert it into its more active,
cytotoxic form.
Enzymes that are useful in the method of this invention include, but are not
limited to, alkaline
phosphatase useful for converting phosphate-containing prodrugs into free
drugs; arylsulfatase useful for
converting sulfate-containing prodrugs into free drugs; cytosine deaniinase
useful for converting non-toxic 5-
fluorocytosine into the anti-cancer drug, 5-fluorouracil; proteases, such as
serratia protease, thermolysin, subtilisin,
carboxypeptidases and cathepsins (such as cathepsins B and L), that are useful
for converting peptide-containing
prodrugs into free drugs; D-alanylcarboxypeptidases, useful for converting
prodrugs that contain D-amino acid
substituents; carbohydrate-cleaving enzymes such as (3-galactosidase and
neuraminidase useful for converting
glycosylated prodrugs into free drugs; (3-lactamase useful for converting
drugs derivatized with (3-lactams into free
drugs; and penicillin amidases, such as penicillin V amidase or penicillin G
amidase, useful for converting drugs
derivatized at their amine nitrogens with phenoxyacetyl or phenylacetyl
groups, respectively, into free drugs.
Alternatively, antibodies with enzymatic activity, also known in the art as
"abzymes", can be used to convert the
prodrugs of the invention into free active drugs (see, e.g., Massey, Nature
328:457-458 (1987)). Antibody-abzyme
conjugates can be prepared as described herein for delivery of the abzyme to a
tumor cell population.
The enzymes of this invention can be covalently bound to the anti-TAT
antibodies by techniques well
known in the art such as the use of the heterobifunctional crosslinking
reagents discussed above. Alternatively,
fusion proteins comprising at least the antigen binding region of an antibody
of the invention linked to at least a
functionally active portion of an enzyme of the invention can be constructed
using recombinant DNA techniques
well known in the art (see, e.g., Neuberger et al., Nature 312:604-608 (1984).
F. Full-Length TAT Polypeptides
The present invention also provides newly identified and isolated nucleotide
sequences encoding
polypeptides referred to in the present application as TAT polypeptides. In
particular, cDNAs (partial and full-
78


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
length) encoding various TAT polypeptides have been identified and isolated,
as disclosed in further detail in the
Examples below.
As disclosed in the Examples below, various cDNA clones have been deposited
with the ATCC. The
actual nucleotide sequences of those clones can readily be determined by the
skilled artisan by sequencing of the
deposited clone using routine methods in the art. The predicted amino acid
sequence can be determined from the
nucleotide sequence using routine skill. For the TAT polypeptides and encoding
nucleic acids described herein,
in some cases, Applicants have identified what is believed to be the reading
frame best identifiable with the
sequence information available at the time.
G. Anti-TAT Antibody and TAT Polyaeptide Variants
In addition to the anti-TAT antibodies and full-length native sequence TAT
polypeptides described
herein, it is contemplated that anti-TAT antibody and TAT polypeptide variants
can be prepared. Anti-TAT
antibody and TAT polypeptide variants can be prepared by introducing
appropriate nucleotide changes into the
encoding DNA, and/or by synthesis of the desired antibody or polypeptide.
Those skilled in the art will appreciate
that amino acid changes may alter post-translational processes of the anti-TAT
antibody or TAT polypeptide, such
as changing the number or position of glycosylation sites or altering the
membrane anchoring characteristics.
Variations in the anti-TAT antibodies and TAT polypeptides described herein,
can be made, for example,
using any of the techniques and guidelines for conservative and non-
conservative mutations set forth, for instance,
in U.S. Patent No. 5,364,934. Variations may be a substitution, deletion or
insertion of one or more codons
encoding the antibody or polypeptide that results in a change in the amino
acid sequence as compared with the
native sequence antibody or polypeptide. Optionally the variation is by
substitution of at least one amino acid with
any other amino acid in one or more of the domains of the anti-TAT antibody or
TAT polypeptide. Guidance in
determining which amino acid residue may be inserted, substituted or deleted
without adversely affecting the
desired activity may be found by comparing the sequence of the anti-TAT
antibody or TAT polypeptide with that
of homologous known protein molecules and ndnimizing the number of amino acid
sequence changes made in
regions of high homology. Amino acid substitutions can be the result of
replacing one amino acid with another
amino acid having similar structural and/or chemical properties, such as the
replacement of a leucine with a serine,
i.e., conservative amino acid replacements. Insertions or deletions may
optionally be in the range of about 1 to
5 amino acids. The variation allowed may be determined by systematically
making insertions, deletions or
substitutions of amino acids in the sequence and testing the resulting
variants for activity exhibited by the full-
length or mature native sequence.
Anti-TAT antibody and TAT polypeptide fragments are provided herein. Such
fragments may be
truncated at the N-terminus or C-terminus, or may lack internal residues, for
example, when compared with a full
length native antibody or protein. Certain fragments lack amino acid residues
that are not essential for a desired
biological activity of the anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide.
Anti-TAT antibody and TAT polypeptide fragments may be prepared by any of a
number of conventional
techniques. Desired peptide fragments may be chemically synthesized. An
alternative approach involves
generating antibody or polypeptide fragments by enzymatic digestion, e.g., by
treating the protein with an enzyme
known to cleave proteins at sites defined by particular amino acid residues,
or by digesting the DNA with suitable
restriction enzymes and isolating the desired fragment. Yet another suitable
technique involves isolating and
79


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
amplifying a DNA fragment encoding a desired antibody or polypeptide fragment,
by polymerase chain reaction
(PCR). Oligonucleotides that define the desired termini of the DNA fragment
are employed at the 5' and 3' primers
in the PCR. Preferably, anti-TAT antibody and TAT polypeptide fragments share
at least one biological and/or
immunological activity with the native anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide
disclosed herein.
In particular embodiments, conservative substitutions of interest are shown in
Table 6 under the heading
of preferred substitutions. If such substitutions result in a change in
biological activity, then more substantial
changes, denominated exemplary substitutions in Table 6, or as further
described below in reference to amino acid
classes, are introduced and the products screened.
Table 6
Original Exemplary Preferred
Residue Substitutions Substitutions
Ala (A) Val; Leu; Ile Val
Arg (R) Lys; Gln; Asn Lys
Asn (N) Gln; His; Asp; Lys; Arg Gln
Asp (D) Glu; Asn Glu
Cys (C) Ser, Ala Ser
Gln (Q) Asn; Glu Asn
Glu (E) Asp, Gln Asp
Gly (G) Pro; Ala Ala
His (H) Asn; Gln; Lys; Arg Arg
Ile (1) Leu; Val; Met; Ala; Phe; Leu
Norleucine
Leu (L) Norleucine; Ile; Val; Ile
Met; Ala; Phe
Lys (K) Arg; Gln; Asn Arg
Met (M) Leu; Phe; Ile Leu
Phe (F) Trp; Leu; Val; Ile; Ala; Tyr Leu
Pro (P) Ala Ala
Ser (S) Thr Thr
Thr (T) Val; Ser Ser
Trp (W) Tyr; Phe Tyr
Tyr (Y) Trp; Phe; Thr; Ser Phe
Val (V) Ile; Leu; Met; Phe; Leu
Ala; Norleucine
Substantial modifications in function or immunological identity of the anti-
TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide are accomplished by selecting substitutions that differ
significantly in their effect on maintaining (a)
the structure of the polypeptide backbone in the area of the substitution, for
example, as a sheet or helical
conformation, (b) the charge or hydrophobicity of the molecule at the target
site, or (c) the bulk of the side chain.
Naturally occurring residues are divided into groups based on common side-
chain properties:
(1) hydrophobic: Norleucine, Met, Ala, Val, Leu, Ile;
(2) neutral hydrophilic: Cys, Ser, Thr; Asn; Gln
(3) acidic: Asp, Glu;
(4) basic: His, Lys, Arg;
(5) residues that influence chain orientation: Gly, Pro; and
(6) aromatic: Trp, Tyr, Phe.



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Non-conservative substitutions will entail exchanging a member of one of these
classes for another class.
Such substituted residues also may be introduced into the conservative
substitution sites or, more preferably, into
the remaining (non-conserved) sites.
The variations can be made using methods known in the art such as
oligonucleotide-mediated (site-
directed) mutagenesis, alanine scanning, and PCR mutagenesis. Site-directed
mutagenesis [Carter et al., Nucl.
Acids Res., 13:4331 (1986); Zoller et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 10:6487 (1987)],
cassette mutagenesis [Wells et al.,
Gene, 34:315 (1985)], restriction selection mutagenesis [Wells et al., Philos.
Trans. R. Soc. London SerA, 317:415
(1986)] or other known techniques can be performed on the cloned DNA to
produce the anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide variant DNA.
Scanning amino acid analysis can also be employed to identify one or more
amino acids along a
contiguous sequence. Among the preferred scanning amino acids are relatively
small, neutral amino acids. Such
amino acids include alanine, glycine, serine, and cysteine. Alanine is
typically a preferred scanning amino acid
among this group because it eliminates the side-chain beyond the beta-carbon
and is less likely to alter the main-
chain conformation of the variant [Cunningham and Wells, Science, 244:1081-
1085 (1989)]. Alanine is also
typically preferred because it is the most common amino acid. Further, it is
frequently found in both buried and
exposed positions [Creighton, The Proteins, (W.H. Freeman & Co., N.Y.);
Chothia, J. Mol. Biol., 150:1(1976)].
If alanine substitution does not yield adequate amounts of variant, an
isoteric amino acid can be used.
Any cysteine residue not involved in maintaining the proper conformation of
the anti-TAT antibody or
TAT polypeptide also may be substituted, generally with serine, to improve the
oxidative stability of the molecule
and prevent aberrant crosslinking. Conversely, cysteine bond(s) may be added
to the anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide to improve its stability (particularly where the antibody is an
antibody fragment such as an Fv
fragment).
A particularly preferred type of substitutional variant involves substituting
one or more hypervariable
region residues of a parent antibody (e.g., a humanized or human antibody).
Generally, the resulting variant(s)
selected for further development will have improved biological properties
relative to the parent antibody from
which they are generated. A convenient way for generating such substitutional
variants involves affinity maturation
using phage display. Briefly, several hypervariable region sites (e.g., 6-7
sites) are mutated to generate all possible
amino substitutions at each site. The antibody variants thus generated are
displayed in a monovalent fashion from
filamentous phage particles as fusions to the gene III product of M13 packaged
within each particle. The phage-
displayed variants are then screened for their biological activity (e.g.,
binding affinity) as herein disclosed. In order
to identify candidate hypervariable region sites for modification, alanine
scanning mutagenesis can be performed
to identify hypervariable region residues contributing significantly to
antigen binding. Alternatively, or
additionally, it may be beneficial to analyze a crystal structure of the
antigen-antibody complex to identify contact
points between the antibody and human TAT polypeptide. Such contact residues
and neighboring residues are
candidates for substitution according to the techniques elaborated herein.
Once such variants are generated, the
panel of variants is subjected to screening as described herein and antibodies
with superior properties in one or
more relevant assays may be selected for further development.
Nucleic acid molecules encoding amino acid sequence variants of the anti-TAT
antibody are prepared
by a variety of methods known in the art. These methods include, but are not
limited to, isolation from a natural
81


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
source (in the case of naturally occurring amino acid sequence variants) or
preparation by oligonucleotide-
mediated (or site-directed) mutagenesis, PCR mutagenesis, and cassette
mutagenesis of an earlier prepared variant
or a non-variant version of the anti-TAT antibody.
H. Modifications of Anti-TAT Antibodies and TAT Polyueptides
Covalent modifications of anti-TAT antibodies and TAT polypeptides are
included within the scope of
this invention. One type of covalent modification includes reacting targeted
amino acid residues of an anti-TAT
antibody or TAT polypeptide with an organic derivatizing agent that is capable
of reacting with selected side
chains or the N- or C- terminal residues of the anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide. Derivatization with
bifunctional agents is useful, for instance, for crosslinking anti-TAT
antibody or TAT polypeptide to a water-
insoluble support matrix or surface for use in the method for purifying anti-
TAT antibodies, and vice-versa.
Commonly used crosslinking agents include, e.g., 1,1-bis(diazoacetyl)-2-
phenylethane, glutaraldehyde, N-
hydroxysuccinimide esters, for example, esters with 4-azidosalicylic acid,
homobifunctional imidoesters, including
disuccinimidyl esters such as 3,3'-dithiobis(succinimidylpropionate),
bifunctional maleimides such as bis-N-
maleimido-1,8-octane and agents such as methyl-3-[(p-
azidophenyl)dithio]propioimidate.
Other modifications include deamidation of glutaminyl and asparaginyl residues
to the corresponding
glutamyl and aspartyl residues, respectively, hydroxylation of proline and
lysine, phosphorylation of hydroxyl
groups of seryl or threonyl residues, methylation of the ce-amino groups of
lysine, arginine, and histidine side
chains [T.E. Creighton, Proteins: Structure and Molecular Properties, W.H.
Freeman & Co., San Francisco, pp.
79-86 (1983)], acetylation of the N-terminal amine, and amidation of any C-
terminal carboxyl group.
Another type of covalent modification of the anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide included within the
scope of this invention comprises altering the native glycosylation pattern of
the antibody or polypeptide.
"Altering the native glycosylation pattern" is intended for purposes herein to
mean deleting one or more
carbohydrate moieties found in native sequence anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide (either by removing the
underlying glycosylation site or by deleting the glycosylation by chemical
and/or enzymatic means), and/or adding
one or more glycosylation sites that are not present in the native sequence
anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide.
In addition, the phrase includes qualitative changes in the glycosylation of
the native proteins, involving a change
in the nature and proportions of the various carbohydrate moieties present.
Glycosylation of antibodies and other polypeptides is typically either N-
linked or 0-linked. N-linked
refers to the attachment of the carbohydrate moiety to the side chain of an
asparagine residue. The tripeptide
sequences asparagine-X-serine and asparagine-X-threonine, where X is any amino
acid except proline, are the
recognition sequences for enzymatic attachment of the carbohydrate moiety to
the asparagine side chain. Thus,
the presence of either of these tripeptide sequences in a polypeptide creates
a potential glycosylation site. 0-linked
glycosylation refers to the attachment of one of the sugars N-
aceylgalactosamine, galactose, or xylose to a
hydroxyamino acid, most commonly serine or threonine, although 5-
hydroxyproline or 5-hydroxylysine may also
be used.
Addition of glycosylation sites to the anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide is
conveniently
accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence such that it contains one or
more of the above-described
tripeptide sequences (for N-linked glycosylation sites). The alteration may
also be made by the addition of, or
substitution by, one or more serine or threonine residues to the sequence of
the original anti-TAT antibody or TAT
82


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
polypeptide (for 0-linked glycosylation sites). The anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide amino acid sequence
may optionally be altered through changes at the DNA level, particularly by
mutating the DNA encoding the anti-
TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide at preselected bases such that codons are
generated that will translate into the
desired amino acids.
Another means of increasing the number of carbohydrate moieties on the anti-
TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide is by chemical or enzymatic coupling of glycosides to the
polypeptide. Such methods are described
in the art, e.g., in WO 87/05330 published 11 September 1987, and in Aplin and
Wriston, CRC Crit. Rev.
Biochem., pp. 259-306 (1981).
Removal of carbohydrate moieties present on the anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide may be
accomplished chemically or enzymatically or by mutational substitution of
codons encoding for amino acid
residues that serve as targets for glycosylation. Chemical deglycosylation
techniques are known in the art and
described, for instance, by Hakimuddin, et al., Arch. Biochem. Biophys.,
259:52 (1987) and by Edge et al., Anal.
Biochem., 118: 131 (198 1). Enzymatic cleavage of carbohydrate moieties on
polypeptides can be achieved by the
use of a variety of endo- and exo-glycosidases as described by Thotakura et
al., Meth. Enzymo1.,138:350 (1987).
Another type of covalent modification of anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide
comprises linking the
antibody or polypeptide to one of a variety of nonproteinaceous polymers,
e.g., polyethylene glycol (PEG),
polypropylene glycol, or polyoxyalkylenes, in the manner set forth in U.S.
Patent Nos. 4,640,835; 4,496,689;
4,301,144; 4,670,417; 4,791,192 or 4,179,337. The antibody or polypeptide also
may be entrapped in
microcapsules prepared, for example, by coacervation techniques or by
interfacial polymerization (for example,
hydroxymethylcellulose or gelatin-microcapsules and poly-(methylmethacylate)
microcapsules, respectively), in
colloidal drug delivery systems (for example, liposomes, albumin microspheres,
niicroemulsions, nano-particles
and nanocapsules), or in macroemulsions. Such techniques are disclosed in
Reminaton's Pharmaceutical Sciences,
16th edition, Oslo, A., Ed., (1980).
The anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide of the present invention may also be
modified in a way to
form chimeric molecules comprising an anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide
fused to another, heterologous
polypeptide or amino acid sequence.
In one embodiment, such a chimeric molecule comprises a fusion of the anti-TAT
antibody or TAT
polypeptide with a tag polypeptide which provides an epitope to which an anti-
tag antibody can selectively bind.
The epitope tag is generally placed at the amino- or carboxyl- terminus of the
anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide. The presence of such epitope-tagged forms of the anti-TAT
antibody or TAT polypeptide can be
detected using an antibody against the tag polypeptide. Also, provision of the
epitope tag enables the anti-TAT
antibody or TAT polypeptide to be readily purified by affinity purification
using an anti-tag antibody or another
type of affinity matrix that binds to the epitope tag. Various tag
polypeptides and their respective antibodies are
well known in the art. Examples include poly-histidine (poly-his) or poly-
histidine-glycine (poly-his-gly) tags; the
flu HA tag polypeptide and its antibody 12CA5 [Field et al., Mol. Cell. Biol.,
8:2159-2165 (1988)]; the c-myc tag
and the 8F9, 3C7, 6E10, G4, B7 and 9E10 antibodies thereto [Evan et al.,
Molecular and Cellular Biology, 5:3610-
3616 (1985)]; and the Herpes Simplex virus glycoprotein D (gD) tag and its
antibody [Paborsky et al., Protein
Engineering, 3(6):547-553 (1990)]. Other tag polypeptides include the Flag-
peptide [Hopp et al., BioTechnology,
6:1204-1210 (1988)]; the KT3 epitope peptide [Martin et al., Science, 255:192-
194 (1992)]; an ec-tubulin epitope
83


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
peptide [Skinner et al., J. Biol. Chem., 266:15163-15166 (1991)]; and the T7
gene 10 protein peptide tag [Lutz-
Freyermuth et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 87:6393-6397 (1990)].
In an alternative embodiment, the chimeric molecule may comprise a fusion of
the anti-TAT antibody or
TAT polypeptide with an immunoglobulin or a particular region of an
immunoglobulin. For a bivalent form of
the chimeric molecule (also referred to as an "innnunoadhesin"), such a fusion
could be to the Fc region of an IgG
molecule. The Ig fusions preferably include the substitution of a soluble
(transmembrane domain deleted or
inactivated) form of an anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide in place of at
least one variable region within an
Ig molecule. In a particularly preferred embodiment, the immunoglobulin fusion
includes the hinge, CH2 and CH31
or the hinge, CHI, CH2 and CH3 regions of an IgGi molecule. For the production
of immunoglobulin fusions see
also US Patent No. 5,428,130 issued June 27, 1995.
I. Preparation of Anti-TAT Antibodies and TAT Polypeptides
The description below relates primarily to production of anti-TAT antibodies
and TAT polypeptides by
culturing cells transformed or transfected with a vector containing anti-TAT
antibody- and TAT polypeptide-
encoding nucleic acid. It is, of course, contemplated that alternative
methods, which are well known in the art, may
be employed to prepare anti-TAT antibodies and TAT polypeptides. For instance,
the appropriate amino acid
sequence, or portions thereof, may be produced by direct peptide synthesis
using solid-phase techniques [see, e.g.,
Stewart et al., Solid-Phase Peptide Synthesis, W.H. Freeman Co., San
Francisco, CA (1969); Merrifield, J. Am.
Chem. Soc., 85:2149-2154 (1963)]. In vitro protein synthesis may be performed
using manual techniques or by
automation. Automated synthesis may be accomplished, for instance, using an
Applied Biosystems Peptide
Synthesizer (Foster City, CA) using manufacturer's instructions. Various
portions of the anti-TAT antibody or
TAT polypeptide may be chemically synthesized separately and combined using
chemical or enzymatic metliods
to produce the desired anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide.
1. Isolation of DNA Encoding Anti-TAT Antibody or TAT Polypeptide
DNA encoding anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide may be obtained from a cDNA
library prepared
from tissue believed to possess the anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide mRNA
and to express it at a detectable
level. Accordingly, human anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide DNA can be
conveniently obtained from a
cDNA library prepared from human tissue. The anti-TAT antibody- or TAT
polypeptide-encoding gene may also
be obtained from a genomic library or by known synthetic procedures (e.g.,
automated nucleic acid synthesis).
Libraries can be screened with probes (such as oligonucleotides of at least
about 20-80 bases) designed
to identify the gene of interest or the protein encoded by it. Screening the
cDNA or genomic library with the
selected probe may be conducted using standard procedures, such as described
in Sambrook et al., Molecular
Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (New York: Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press,
1989). An alternative means
to isolate the gene encoding anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide is to use
PCR methodology [Sambrook et al.,
sunra; Dieffenbach et al., PCR Primer: A Laboratory Manual (Cold Spring Harbor
Laboratory Press, 1995)].
Techniques for screening a cDNA library are well known in the art. The
oligonucleotide sequences
selected as probes should be of sufficient length and sufficiently unambiguous
that false positives are minimized.
The oligonucleotide is preferably labeled such that it can be detected upon
hybridization to DNA in the library
being screened. Methods of labeling are well known in the art, and include the
use of radiolabels like 32P-labeled
ATP, biotinylation or enzyme labeling. Hybridization conditions, including
moderate stringency and high
84


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
stringency, are provided in Sambrook et al., su ra.
Sequences identified in such library screening methods can be compared and
aligned to other known
sequences deposited and available in public databases such as GenBank or other
private sequence databases.
Sequence identity (at either the amino acid or nucleotide level) within
defined regions of the molecule or across
the full-length sequence can be determined using methods known in the art and
as described herein.
Nucleic acid having protein coding sequence may be obtained by screening
selected cDNA or genomic
libraries using the deduced amino acid sequence disclosed herein for the first
time, and, if necessary, using
conventional primer extension procedures as described in Sambrook et al.,
supr, to detect precursors and
processing intermediates of mRNA that may not have been reverse-transcribed
into cDNA.
2. Selection and Transformation of Host Cells
Host cells are transfected or transformed with expression or cloning vectors
described herein for anti-TAT
antibody or TAT polypeptide production and cultured in conventional nutrient
media modified as appropriate for
inducing promoters, selecting transformants, or amplifying the genes encoding
the desired sequences. The culture
conditions, such as media, temperature, pH and the like, can be selected by
the skilled artisan without undue
experimentation. In general, principles, protocols, and practical techniques
for maxinuzing the productivity of cell
cultures can be found in Mammalian Cell Bioteclinology: a Practical Approach,
M. Butler, ed. (IRL Press, 1991)
and Sambrook et al., supr.
Metliods of eukaryotic cell transfection and prokaryotic cell transformation
are known to the ordinarily
skilled artisan, for example, CaClZ, CaPO4, liposome-mediated and
electroporation. Depending on the host cell
used, transformation is performed using standard techniques appropriate to
such cells. The calcium treatment
employing calcium chloride, as described in Sambrook et al., supra, or
electroporation is generally used for
prokaryotes. Infection with Agrobacterium tuan.efaciens is used for
transformation of certain plant cells, as
described by Shaw et al., Gene, 23:315 (1983) and WO 89/05859 published 29
June 1989. For mammalian cells
without such cell walls, the calcium phosphate precipitation method of Graham
and van der Eb, Virology, 52:456-
457 (1978) can be employed. General aspects of mammalian cell host system
transfections have been described
in U. S. Patent No. 4,399,216. Transformations into yeast are typically
carried out according to the method of Van
Solingen et al., J. Bact.,130:946 (1977) and Hsiao et al., Proc. Natl. Acad.
Sci. (USA), 76:3829 (1979). However,
other methods for introducing DNA into cells, such as by nuclear
microinjection, electroporation, bacterial
protoplast fusion with intact cells, or polycations, e.g., polybrene,
polyornithine, may also be used. For various
techniques for transforming mammalian cells, see Keown et al., Methods in
EnzymoloQy,185:527-537 (1990) and
Mansour et al., Nature, 336:348-352 (1988).
Suitable host cells for cloning or expressing the DNA in the vectors herein
include prokaryote, yeast, or
higher eukaryote cells. Suitable prokaryotes include but are not limited to
eubacteria, such as Gram-negative or
Gram-positive organisms, for example, Enterobacteriaceae such as E. coli.
Various E. coli strains are publicly
available, such as E. coli K12 strain MM294 (ATCC 31,446); E. coli X1776 (ATCC
31,537); E. coli strain W3110
(ATCC 27,325) and K5 772 (ATCC 53,635). Other suitable prokaryotic host cells
include Enterobacteriaceae
such as Escherichia, e.g., E. coli, Enterobacter, Erwizzia, Klevsiella,
Proteus, Salinonella, e.g., Salmonella
typlzitnuriuzn, Serratia, e.g., Serratia marcescans, and Shigella, as well as
Bacilli such as B. subtilis and B.
lichezziforrnis (e.g., B. licheniformis 41P disclosed in DD 266,710 published
12 Apri11989), Pseudoznonas such


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
as P. aerugiraosa, and Streptomyces. These examples are illustrative rather
than limiting. Strain W3110 is one
particularly preferred host or parent host because it is a common host strain
for recombinant DNA product
fermentations. Preferably, the host cell secretes minimal amounts of
proteolytic enzymes. For example, strain
W31 10 may be modified to effect a genetic mutation in the genes encoding
proteins endogenous to the host, with
examples of such hosts including E. coli W31 10 strain 1A2, which has the
complete genotype torzA ; E. coli
W3110 strain 9E4, which has the complete genotype tonA ptr3; E. coli W3110
strain 27C7 (ATCC 55,244), which
has the complete genotype tonA ptr3 phoA E15 (argF-lac)169 degP ompT karz ; E.
coli W3110 strain 37D6, which
has the complete genotype toraA ptr3 phoA E15 (argF-lac)169 degP oinpT rbs7
ilvG kaur; E. coli W3110 strain
40B4, which is strain 37D6 with a non-kanamycin resistant degP deletion
mutation; and an E. coli strain having
mutant periplasmic protease disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 4,946,783 issued 7
August 1990. Alternatively, in vitro
methods of cloning, e.g., PCR or other nucleic acid polymerase reactions, are
suitable.
Full length antibody, antibody fragments, and antibody fusion proteins can be
produced in bacteria, in
particular when glycosylation and Fc effector function are not needed, such as
when the therapeutic antibody is
conjugated to a cytotoxic agent (e.g., a toxin) and the immunoconjugate by
itself shows effectiveness in tumor cell
destruction. Full length antibodies have greater half life in circulation.
Production in E. coli is faster and more
cost efficient. For expression of antibody fragments and polypeptides in
bacteria, see, e.g., U.S. 5,648,237 (Carter
et. al.), U.S. 5,789,199 (Joly et al.), and U.S. 5,840,523 (Simmons et al.)
which describes translation initiation
regio (TIR) and signal sequences for optimizing expression and secretion,
these patents incorporated herein by
reference. After expression, the antibody is isolated from the E. coli cell
paste in a soluble fraction and can be
purified through, e.g., a protein A or G column depending on the isotype.
Final purification can be carried out
similar to the process for purifying antibody expressed e.g,, in CHO cells.
In addition to prokaryotes, eukaryotic microbes such as filamentous fungi or
yeast are suitable cloning
or expression hosts for anti-TAT antibody- or TAT polypeptide-encoding
vectors. Saccharoryayces cerevisiae is
a commonly used lower eukaryotic host microorganism. Others include
Schi.zosaccharornyces pornbe (Beach and
Nurse, Nature, 290: 140 [1981]; EP 139,383 published 2 May 1985);
Kluyveroinyces hosts (U.S. Patent No.
4,943,529; Fleer et al., Bio/Technology, 9:968-975 (1991)) such as, e.g., K.
lactis (MW98-8C, CBS683, CBS4574;
Louvencourt et al., J. Bacteriol., 154(2):737-742 [1983]), K. fragilis (ATCC
12,424), K bulgaricus (ATCC
16,045), K. wickerarnii (ATCC 24,178), K. waltii (ATCC 56,500), K.
drosophilarum (ATCC 36,906; Van den
Berg et al., Bio/TechnoloQV, 8:135 (1990)), K. thermotolerans, and K.
marxianus; yarrowia (EP 402,226); Pichia
pastoris (EP 183,070; Sreekrishna et al., J. Basic Microbiol., 28:265-278
[1988]); Candida; Trichoderina reesia
(EP 244,234); Neurospora crassa (Case et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA,
76:5259-5263 [1979]);
Schwanraiomyces such as Schwanraiomyces occidentalis (EP 394,538 published 31
October 1990); and filamentous
fungi such as, e.g., Neurospora, Petzicilliuna, Tolypocladiurn (WO 91/00357
published 10 January 1991), and
Aspergillus hosts such as A. nidularzs (Ballance et al., Biochem. Biophys.
Res. Commun., 112:284-289 [1983];
Tilburn et al., Gene, 26:205-221 [1983]; Yelton et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci.
USA, 81: 1470-1474 [1984]) and A.
rziger (Kelly and Hynes, EMBO J., 4:475-479 [1985]). Methylotropic yeasts are
suitable herein and include, but
are not limited to, yeast capable of growth on methanol selected from the
genera consisting of Hanseuula,
Candida, Kloeckera, Pichia, Saccharoinyces, Torulopsis, and Rhodotorula. A
list of specific species that are
exemplary of this class of yeasts may be found in C. Anthony, The Biochemistry
of Methylotrophs, 269 (1982).
86


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Suitable host cells for the expression of glycosylated anti-TAT antibody or
TAT polypeptide are derived
from multicellular organisms. Examples of invertebrate cells include insect
cells such as Drosophila S2 and
Spodoptera Sf9, as well as plant cells, such as cell cultures of cotton, corn,
potato, soybean, petunia, tomato, and
tobacco. Numerous baculoviral strains and variants and corresponding
permissive insect host cells from hosts such
as Spodoptera frugiperda (caterpillar), Aedes aegypti (mosquito), Aedes
albopictus (mosquito), Drosophila
inelanogaster (fruitfly), and Bombyx inori have been identified. A variety of
viral strains for transfection are
publicly available, e.g., the L-1 variant of Autagrapha californica NPV and
the Bm-5 strain of Boinbyx naori NPV,
and such viruses may be used as the virus herein according to the present
invention, particularly for transfection
of Spodopterafrugiperda cells.
However, interest has been greatest in vertebrate cells, and propagation of
vertebrate cells in culture
(tissue culture) has become a routine procedure. Examples of useful mammalian
host cell lines are monkey kidney
CV1 line transformed by SV40 (COS-7, ATCC CRL 1651); human embryonic kidney
line (293 or 293 cells
subcloned for growth in suspension culture, Graham et al., J. Gen Virol. 36:59
(1977)); baby hamster kidney cells
(BHK, ATCC CCL 10); Chinese liamster ovary cells/-DHFR (CHO, Urlaub et al.,
Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA
77:4216 (1980)); mouse sertoli cells (TM4, Mather, Biol. Reprod. 23:243-
251(1980)); monkey kidney cells (CV1
ATCC CCL 70); African green monkey kidney cells (VERO-76, ATCC CRL-1587);
human cervical carcinoma
cells (HELA, ATCC CCL 2); canine kidney cells (MDCK, ATCC CCL 34); buffalo rat
liver cells (BRL 3A, ATCC
CRL 1442); human lung cells (W138, ATCC CCL 75); human liver cells (Hep G2, HB
8065); mouse mammary
tumor (MMT 060562, ATCC CCL51); TRI cells (Mather et al., Annals N.Y. Acad.
Sci. 383:44-68 (1982)); MRC
5 cells; FS4 cells; and a human hepatoma line (Hep G2).
Host cells are transformed with the above-described expression or cloning
vectors for anti-TAT antibody
or TAT polypeptide production and cultured in conventional nutrient media
modified as appropriate for inducing
promoters, selecting transformants, or amplifying the genes encoding the
desired sequences.
3. Selection and Use of a Replicable Vector
The nucleic acid (e.g., cDNA or genomic DNA) encoding anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide may
be inserted into a replicable vector for cloning (amplification of the DNA) or
for expression. Various vectors are
publicly available. The vector may, for example, be in the form of a plasmid,
cosmid, viral particle, or phage. The
appropriate nucleic acid sequence may be inserted into the vector by a variety
of procedures. In general, DNA is
inserted into an appropriate restriction endonuclease site(s) using techniques
known in the art. Vector components
generally include, but are not limited to, one or more of a signal sequence,
an origin of replication, one or more
marker genes, an enhancer element, a promoter, and atranscription termination
sequence. Construction of suitable
vectors containing one or more of these components employs standard ligation
techniques which are known to the
skilled artisan.
The TAT may be produced recombinantly not only directly, but also as a fusion
polypeptide with a
heterologous polypeptide, which may be a signal sequence or other polypeptide
having a specific cleavage site at
the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide. In general, the signal
sequence may be a component of the
vector, or it may be a part of the anti-TAT antibody- or TAT polypeptide-
encoding DNA that is inserted into the
vector. The signal sequence may be a prokaryotic signal sequence selected, for
example, from the group of the
alkaline phosphatase, penicillinase, lpp, or heat-stable enterotoxin II
leaders. For yeast secretion the signal
87


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
sequence may be, e.g., the yeast invertase leader, alpha factor leader
(including Saccharoinyces and Kluyveronryces
a-factor leaders, the latter described in U.S. Patent No. 5,010,182), or acid
phosphatase leader, the C. albicaus
glucoamylase leader (EP 362,179 published 4 Apri11990), or the signaldescribed
in WO 90/13646 published 15
November 1990. In mammalian cell expression, mammalian signal sequences may be
used to direct secretion of
the protein, such as signal sequences from secreted polypeptides of the same
or related species, as well as viral
secretory leaders.
Both expression and cloning vectors contain a nucleic acid sequence that
enables the vector to replicate
in one or more selected host cells. Such sequences are well known for a
variety of bacteria, yeast, and viruses.
The origin of replication from the plasmid pBR322 is suitable for most Gram-
negative bacteria, the 2 plasmid
origin is suitable for yeast, and various viral origins (SV40, polyoma,
adenovirus, VSV or BPV) are useful for
cloning vectors in mammalian cells.
Expression and cloning vectors wilf typically contain a selection gene, also
termed a selectable marker.
Typical selection genes encode proteins that (a) confer resistance to
antibiotics or other toxins, e.g., ampicillin,
neomycin, methotrexate, or tetracycline, (b) complement auxotrophic
deficiencies, or (c) supply critical nutrients
not available from complex media, e.g., the gene encoding D-alanine racemase
for Bacilli.
An example of suitable selectable markers for mammalian cells are those that
enable the identification
of cells competent to take up the anti-TAT antibody- or TAT polypeptide-
encoding nucleic acid, such as DHFR
or thymidine kinase. An appropriate host cell when wild-type DHFR is employed
is the CHO cell line deficient
in DHFR activity, prepared and propagated as described by Urlaub et al., Proc.
Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:4216
(1980). A suitable selection gene for use in yeast is the trpl gene present in
the yeast plasmid YRp7 [Stinchcomb
et al., Nature, 282:39 (1979); Kingsman et al., Gene, 7:141 (1979); Tschemper
et al., Gene, 10:157 (1980)]. The
trpl gene provides a selection marker for a mutant strain of yeast lacking the
ability to grow in tryptophan, for
example, ATCC No. 44076 or PEP4-1 [Jones, Genetics, 85:12 (1977)].
Expression and cloning vectors usually contain a promoter operably linked to
the anti-TAT antibody- or
TAT polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid sequence to direct mRNA synthesis.
Promoters recognized by a variety
of potential host cells are well known. Promoters suitable for use with
prokaryotic hosts include the (3-lactamase
and lactose promoter systems [Chang et al., Nature, 275:615 (1978); Goeddel et
al., Nature, 281:544 (1979)],
alkaline pliosphatase, a tryptophan (trp) promoter system [Goeddel, Nucleic
Acids Res., 8:4057 (1980); EP
36,776], and hybrid promoters such as the tac promoter [deBoer et al., Proc.
Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 80:21-25
(1983)]. Promoters for use in bacterial systems also will contain a Shine-
Dalgarno (S.D.) sequence operably linked
to the DNA encoding anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide.
Examples of suitable promoting sequences for use with yeast hosts include the
promoters for 3-
phosphoglycerate kinase [Hitzeman et al., J. Biol. Chem., 255:2073 (1980)] or
other glycolytic enzymes [Hess et
al., J. Adv. Enzyme Reg., 7:149 (1968); Holland, Biochemistry,17:4900 (1978)],
such as enolase, glyceraldehyde-
3-phosphate dehydrogenase, hexokinase, pyruvate decarboxylase,
phosphofructokinase, glucose-6-phosphate
isomerase, 3-phosphoglycerate mutase, pyruvate kinase, triosephosphate
isomerase, phosphoglucose isomerase,
and glucokinase.
Other yeast promoters, which are inducible promoters having the additional
advantage of transcription
controlled by growth conditions, are the promoter regions for alcohol
dehydrogenase 2, isocytochrome C, acid
88


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
phosphatase, degradative enzymes associated with nitrogen metabolism,
metallothionein, glyceraldehyde-3-
phosphate dehydrogenase, and enzymes responsible for maltose and galactose
utilization. Suitable vectors and
promoters for use in yeast expression are further described in EP 73,657.
Anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide transcription from vectors in mammalian
host cells is controlled,
for example, by promoters obtained from the genomes of viruses such as polyoma
virus, fowlpox virus (UK
2,211,504 published 5 July 1989), adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), bovine
papilloma virus, avian sarcoma virus,
cytomegalovirus, a retrovirus, hepatitis-B virus and Simian Virus 40 (SV40),
from heterologous mammalian
promoters, e.g., the actin promoter or an immunoglobulin promoter, and from
heat-shock promoters, provided such
promoters are compatible with the host cell systems.
Transcription of a DNA encoding the anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide by
higher eukaryotes may
be increased by inserting an enhancer sequence into the vector. Enhancers are
cis- acting elements of DNA, usually
about from 10 to 300 bp, that act on a promoter to increase its transcription.
Many enhancer sequences are now
known from mammalian genes (globin, elastase, albumin, a-fetoprotein, and
insulin). Typically, however, one
will use an enhancer from a eukaryotic cell virus. Examples include the SV40
enhancer on the late side of the
replication origin (bp 100-270), the cytomegalovirus early promoter enhancer,
the polyoma enhancer on the late
side of the replication origin, and adenovirus enhancers. The enhancer may be
spliced into the vector at a position
5' or 3' to the anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide coding sequence, but is
preferably located at a site 5' from
the promoter.
Expression vectors used in eukaryotic host cells (yeast, fungi, insect, plant,
animal, human, or nucleated
cells from other multicellular organisms) will also contain sequences
necessary for the termination of transcription
and for stabilizing the mRNA. Such sequences are commonly available from the
5' and, occasionally 3',
untranslated regions of eukaryotic or viral DNAs or cDNAs. These regions
contain nucleotide segments
transcribed as polyadenylated fragments in the untranslated portion of the
mRNA encoding anti-TAT antibody or
TAT polypeptide.
Still other methods, vectors, and host cells suitable for adaptation to the
synthesis of anti-TAT antibody
or TAT polypeptide in recombinant vertebrate cell culture are described in
Gething et al., Nature, 293:620-625
(1981); Mantei et al., Nature, 281:40-46 (1979); EP 117,060; and EP 117,058.
4. Culturing the Host Cells
The host cells used to produce the anti-TAT antibody or TAT polypeptide of
this invention may be
cultured in a variety of media. Commercially available media such as Ham's F10
(Sigma), Minimal Essential
Medium ((MEM), (Sigma), RPMI-1640 (Sigma), and Dulbecco's Modified Eagle's
Medium ((DMEM), Sigma)
are suitable for culturing the host cells. In addition, any of the media
described in Ham et al., Meth. Enz. 58:44
(1979), Barnes et al., Anal. Biochem.102:255 (1980), U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,767,704;
4,657,866; 4,927,762; 4,560,655;
or 5,122,469; WO 90/03430; WO 87/00195; or U.S. Patent Re. 30,985 may be used
as culture media for the host
cells. Any of these media may be supplemented as necessary with hormones
and/or other growth factors (such as
insulin, transferrin, or epidermal growth factor), salts (such as sodium
chloride, calcium, magnesium, and
phosphate), buffers (such as HEPES), nucleotides (such as adenosine and
thymidine), antibiotics (such as
GENTAMYCINTM drug), trace elements (defined as inorganic compounds usually
present at final concentrations
in the micromolar range), and glucose or an equivalent energy source. Any
other necessary supplements may also
89


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
be included at appropriate concentrations that would be known to those skilled
in the art. The culture conditions,
such as temperature, pH, and the like, are those previously used with the host
cell selected for expression, and will
be apparent to the ordinarily skilled artisan.
5. Detecting Gene Amulification/Expression
Gene amplification and/or expression may be measured in a sample directly, for
example, by conventional
Southern blotting, Northern blotting to quantitate the transcription of mRNA
[Thomas, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA,
77:5201-5205 (1980)], dot blotting (DNA analysis), or in situ hybridization,
using an appropriately labeled probe,
based on the sequences provided herein. Alternatively, antibodies may be
employed that can recognize specific
duplexes, including DNA duplexes, RNA duplexes, and DNA-RNA hybrid duplexes or
DNA-protein duplexes.
The antibodies in turn may be labeled and the assay may be carried out where
the duplex is bound to a surface, so
that upon the formation of duplex on the surface, the presence of antibody
bound to the duplex can be detected.
Gene expression, alternatively, may be measured by immunological methods, such
as
immunohistochemical staining of cells or tissue sections and assay of cell
culture or body fluids, to quantitate
directly the expression of gene product. Antibodies useful for
immunohistochemical staining and/or assay of
sample fluids may be either monoclonal or polyclonal, and may be prepared in
any mammal. Conveniently, the
antibodies may be prepared against a native sequence TAT polypeptide or
against a synthetic peptide based on
the DNA sequences provided herein or against exogenous sequence fused to TAT
DNA and encoding a specific
antibody epitope.
6. Purification of Anti-TAT Antibody and TAT Polypeptide
Forms of anti-TAT antibody and TAT polypeptide may be recovered from culture
medium or from host
cell lysates. If membrane-bound, it can be released from the membrane using a
suitable detergent solution (e.g.
Triton-X 100) or by enzymatic cleavage. Cells employed in expression of anti-
TAT antibody and TAT
polypeptide can be disrupted by various physical or chemical means, such as
freeze-thaw cycling, sonication,
mechanical disruption, or cell lysing agents.
It may be desired to purify anti-TAT antibody and TAT polypeptide from
recombinant cell proteins or
polypeptides. The following procedures are exemplary of suitable purification
procedures: by fractionation on an
ion-exchange column; ethanol precipitation; reverse phase HPLC; chromatography
on silica or on a cation-
exchange resin such as DEAE; chromatofocusing; SDS-PAGE; amznonium sulfate
precipitation; gel filtration
using, for example, Sephadex G-75; protein A Sepharose columns to remove
contaminants such as IgG; and metal
chelating columns to bind epitope-tagged forms of the anti-TAT antibody and
TAT polypeptide. Various methods
of protein purification may be employed and such methods are known in the art
and described for example in
Deutscher, Methods in Enzymology,182 (1990); Scopes, Protein Purification:
Principles and Practice, Springer-
Verlag, New York (1982). The purification step(s) selected will depend, for
example, on the nature of the
production process used and the particular anti-TAT antibody or TAT
polypeptide produced.
When using recombinant techniques, the antibody can be produced
intracellularly, in the periplasmic
space, or directly secreted into the medium. If the antibody is produced
intracellularly, as a first step, the particulate
debris, either host cells or lysed fragments, are removed, for example, by
centrifugation or ultrafiltration. Carter
et al., Bio/Technology 10:163-167 (1992) describe a procedure for isolating
antibodies which are secreted to the
periplasmic space of E. coli. Briefly, cell paste is thawed in the presence of
sodium acetate (pH 3.5), EDTA, and


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
phenylmethylsulfonylfluoride (PMSF) over about 30 min. Cell debris can be
removed by centrifugation. Where
the antibody is secreted into the medium, supernatants from such expression
systems are generally first
concentrated using a commercially available protein concentration filter, for
example, an Amicon or Millipore
Pellicon ultrafiltration unit. A protease inhibitor such as PMSF may be
included in any of the foregoing steps to
inhibit proteolysis and antibiotics may be included to prevent the growth of
adventitious contaminants.
The antibody composition prepared from the cells can be purified using, for
example, hydroxylapatite
chromatography, gel electrophoresis, dialysis, and affinity chromatography,
with affinity chromatography being
the preferred purification technique. The suitability of protein A as an
affinity ligand depends on the species and
isotype of any immunoglobulin Fc domain that is present in the antibody.
Protein A can be used to purify
antibodies that are based on human yl, y2 or y4 heavy chains (Lindmark et al.,
J. Iminunol. Meth. 62:1-13
(1983)). Protein G is recommended for all mouse isotypes and for human y3
(Guss et al., EMBO J. 5:15671575
(1986)). The matrix to which the affinity ligand is attached is most often
agarose, but other matrices are available.
Mechanically stable matrices such as controlled pore glass or
poly(styrenedivinyl)benzene allow for faster flow
rates and shorter processing times than can be achieved with agarose. Where
the antibody comprises a CH3
domain, the Bakerbond ABXTMresin (J. T. Baker, Phillipsburg, NJ) is useful for
purification. Other techniques
for protein purification such as fractionation on an ion-exchange column,
ethanol precipitation, Reverse Phase
HPLC, chromatography on silica, chromatography on heparin SEPHAROSETM
chromatography on an anion or
cation exchange resin (such as a polyaspartic acid column), chromatofocusing,
SDS-PAGE, and ammonium sulfate
precipitation are also available depending on the antibody to be recovered.
Following any preliminary purification step(s), the mixture comprising the
antibody of interest and
contaminants may be subjected to low pH hydrophobic interaction chromatography
using an elution buffer at a
pH between about 2.5-4.5, preferably performed at low salt concentrations
(e.g., from about 0-0.25M salt).
J. Pharmaceutical Formulations
Therapeutic formulations of the anti-TAT antibodies, TAT binding
oligopeptides, TAT binding organic
molecules and/or TAT polypeptides used in accordance with the present
invention are prepared for storage by
mixing the antibody, polypeptide, oligopeptide or organic molecule having the
desired degree of purity with
optional pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients or stabilizers
(Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences 16th
edition, Osol, A. Ed. (1980)), in the form of lyophilized formulations or
aqueous solutions. Acceptable carriers,
excipients, or stabilizers are nontoxic to recipients at the dosages and
concentrations employed, and include buffers
such as acetate, Tris, phosphate, citrate, and other organic acids;
antioxidants including ascorbic acid and
methionine; preservatives (such as octadecyldimethylbenzyl ammonium chloride;
hexamethonium chloride;
benzalkonium chloride, benzethonium chloride; phenol, butyl or benzyl alcohol;
alkyl parabens such as methyl
or propyl paraben; catechol; resorcinol; cyclohexanol; 3-pentanol; and m-
cresol); low molecular weight (less than
about 10 residues) polypeptides; proteins, such as serum albumin, gelatin, or
immunoglobulins; hydrophilic
polymers such as polyvinylpyrrolidone; amino acids such as glycine, glutamine,
asparagine, histidine, arginine,
or lysine; monosaccharides, disaccharides, and other carbohydrates including
glucose, mannose, or dextrins;
chelating agents such as EDTA; tonicifiers such as trehalose and sodium
chloride; sugars such as sucrose, mannitol,
trehalose or sorbitol; surfactant such as polysorbate; salt-forming counter-
ions such as sodium; metal complexes
(e.g., Zn-protein complexes); and/or non-ionic surfactants such as TWEEN ,
PLURONICS or polyethylene
91


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
glycol (PEG). The antibody preferably comprises the antibody at a
concentration of between 5-200 mg/ml,
preferably between 10-100 mg/ml.
The formulations herein may also contain more than one active compound as
necessary for the particular
indication being treated, preferably those with complementary activities that
do not adversely affect each other.
For example, in addition to an anti-TAT antibody, TAT binding oligopeptide, or
TAT binding organic molecule,
it may be desirable to include in the one formulation, an additional antibody,
e.g., a second anti-TAT antibody
which binds a different epitope on the TAT polypeptide, or an antibody to some
other target such as a growth
factor that affects the growth of the particular cancer. Alternatively, or
additionally, the composition may further
comprise a chemotherapeutic agent, cytotoxic agent, cytokine, growth
inhibitory agent, anti-hormonal agent, and/or
cardioprotectant. Such molecules are suitably present in combination in
amounts that are effective for the purpose
intended.
The active ingredients may also be entrapped in microcapsules prepared, for
example, by coacervation
techniques or by interfacial polymerization, for example,
hydroxymethylcellulose or gelatin-microcapsules and
poly-(methylmethacylate) microcapsules, respectively, in colloidal drug
delivery systems (for example, liposomes,
albumin microspheres, microemulsions, nano-particles and nanocapsules) or in
macroemulsions. Such techniques
are disclosed in Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 16th edition, Osol, A.
Ed. (1980).
Sustained-release preparations may be prepared. Suitable examples of sustained-
release preparations
include semi-permeable matrices of solid hydrophobic polymers containing the
antibody, which matrices are in
the form of shaped articles, e.g., films, or microcapsules. Examples of
sustained-release matrices include
polyesters, hydrogels (for example, poly(2-hydroxyethyl-methacrylate),
orpoly(vinylalcohol)), polylactides (U.S.
Pat. No. 3,773,919), copolymers of L-glutanuc acid and y ethyl-L-glutamate,
non-degradable ethylene-vinyl
acetate, degradable lactic acid-glycolic acid copolymers such as the LUPRON
DEPOT (injectable microspheres
composed of lactic acid-glycolic acid copolymer and leuprolide acetate), and
poly-D-(-)-3-hydroxybutyric acid.
The formulations to be used for in vivo administration must be sterile. This
is readily accomplished by
filtration through sterile filtration membranes.
K. Diagnosis and Treatment with Anti-TAT Antibodies, TAT Binding Oligoueptides
and TAT
Binding Organic Molecules
To determine TAT expression in the cancer, various diagnostic assays are
available. In one embodiment,
TAT polypeptide overexpression may be analyzed by immunohistochemistry (IHC).
Parrafin embedded tissue
sections from a tumor biopsy may be subjected to the IHC assay and accorded a
TAT protein staining intensity
criteria as follows:
Score 0 - no staining is observed or membrane staining is observed in less
than 10% of tumor cells.
Score 1+ - a faint/barely perceptible membrane staining is detected in more
than 10% of the tumor cells.
The cells are only stained in part of their membrane.
Score 2+ - a weak to moderate complete membrane staining is observed in more
than 10% of the tumor
cells.
Score 3+ - a moderate to strong complete membrane staining is observed in more
than 10% of the tumor
cells.

92


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Those tumors with 0 or 1+ scores for TAT polypeptide expression may be
characterized as not
overexpressing TAT, whereas those tumors with 2+ or 3+ scores may be
characterized as overexpressing TAT.
Alternatively, or additionally, FISH assays such as the INFORM (sold by
Ventana, Arizona) or
PATHVISION (Vysis, Illinois) may be carried out on formalin-fixed, paraffin-
embedded tumor tissue to
determine the extent (if any) of TAT overexpression in the tumor.
TAT overexpression or amplification may be evaluated using an in vivo
diagnostic assay, e.g., by
administering a molecule (such as an antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule) which binds the molecule to be
detected and is tagged with a detectable label (e.g., a radioactive isotope or
a fluorescent label) and externally
scanning the patient for localization of the label.
As described above, the anti-TAT antibodies, oligopeptides and organic
molecules of the invention have
various non-therapeutic applications. The anti-TAT antibodies, oligopeptides
and organic molecules of the present
invention can be useful for diagnosis and staging of TAT polypeptide-
expressing cancers (e.g., in radioimaging).
The antibodies, oligopeptides and organic molecules are also useful for
purification or inununoprecipitation of
TAT polypeptide from cells, for detection and quantitation of TAT polypeptide
in vitro, e.g., in an ELISA or a
Western blot, to kill and eliminate TAT-expressing cells from a population of
mixed cells as a step in the
purification of other cells.
Currently, depending on the stage of the cancer, cancer treatment involves one
or a combination of the
following therapies: surgery to remove the cancerous tissue, radiation
therapy, and chemotherapy. Anti-TAT
antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule therapy may be especially desirable
in elderly patients who do not
tolerate the toxicity and side effects of chemotherapy well and in metastatic
disease where radiation therapy has
limited usefulness. The tumor targeting anti-TAT antibodies, oligopeptides and
organic molecules of the invention
are useful to alleviate TAT-expressing cancers upon initial diagnosis of the
disease or during relapse. For
therapeutic applications, the anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule can be used alone, or in
combination therapy with, e.g., hormones, antiangiogens, or radiolabelled
compounds, or with surgery,
cryotherapy, and/or radiotherapy. Anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule treatment can be
administered in conjunction witli other forms of conventional therapy, either
consecutively with, pre- or post-
conventional therapy. Chemotherapeutic drugs such as TAXOTERE (docetaxel),
TAXOL (palictaxel),
estramustine and mitoxantrone are used in treating cancer, in particular, in
good risk patients. In the present
method of the invention for treating or alleviating cancer, the cancer patient
can be administered anti-TAT
antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule in conjuction with treatment with
the one or more of the preceding
chemotherapeutic agents. In particular, combination therapy with palictaxel
and modified derivatives (see, e.g.,
EP0600517) is contemplated. The anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule will be administered with
a therapeutically effective dose of the chemotherapeutic agent. In another
embodiment, the anti-TAT antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule is administered in conjunction with
chemotherapy to enhance the activity and
efficacy of the chemotherapeutic agent, e.g., paclitaxel. The Physicians' Desk
Reference (PDR) discloses dosages
of these agents that have been used in treatment of various cancers. The
dosing regimen and dosages of these
aforementioned chemotherapeutic drugs that are therapeutically effective will
depend on the particular cancer being
treated, the extent of the disease and other factors familiar to the physician
of skill in the art and can be determined
by the physician.

93


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
In one particular embodiment, a conjugate comprising an anti-TAT antibody,
oligopeptide or organic
molecule conjugated with a cytotoxic agent is administered to the patient.
Preferably, the immunoconj ugate bound
to the TAT protein is internalized by the cell, resulting in increased
therapeutic efficacy of the immunoconjugate
in killing the cancer cell to which it binds. In a preferred embodiment, the
cytotoxic agent targets or interferes with
the nucleic acid in the cancer cell. Examples of such cytotoxic agents are
described above and include
maytansinoids, calicheamicins, ribonucleases and DNA endonucleases.
The anti-TAT antibodies, oligopeptides, organic molecules or toxin conjugates
thereof are administered
to a human patient, in accord with known methods, such as intravenous
administration, e.g.,, as a bolus or by
continuous infusion over a period of time, by intramuscular, intraperitoneal,
intracerobrospinal, subcutaneous,
intra-articular, intrasynovial, intrathecal, oral, topical, or inhalation
routes. Intravenous or subcutaneous
administration of the antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule is preferred.
Other therapeutic regimens may be combined with the administration of the anti-
TAT antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule. The combined administration includes co-
administration, using separate
formulations or a single pharmaceutical formulation, and consecutive
administration in either order, wherein
preferably there is a time period while both (or all) active agents
simultaneously exert their biological activities.
Preferably such combined therapy results in a synergistic therapeutic effect.
It may also be desirable to combine administration of the anti-TAT antibody or
antibodies, oligopeptides
or organic molecules, with administration of an antibody directed against
another tumor antigen associated with
the particular cancer.
In another embodiment, the therapeutic treatment methods of the present
invention involves the combined
administration of an anti-TAT antibody (or antibodies), oligopeptides or
organic molecules and one or more
chemotherapeutic agents or growth inhibitory agents, including co-
administration of cocktails of different
chemotherapeutic agents. Chemotherapeutic agents include estramustine
phosphate, prednimustine, cisplatin, 5-
fluorouracil, melphalan, cyclophosphamide, hydroxyurea and hydroxyureataxanes
(such as paclitaxel and
doxetaxel) and/or anthracycline antibiotics. Preparation and dosing schedules
for such chemotherapeutic agents
may be used according to manufacturers' instructions or as determined
empirically by the skilled practitioner.
Preparation and dosing schedules for such chemotherapy are also described in
Chemotherapy Service Ed., M.C.
Perry, Williams & Willcins, Baltimore, MD (1992).
The antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule may be combined with an anti-
hormonal compound; e.g.,
an anti-estrogen compound such as tamoxifen; an anti-progesterone such as
onapristone (see, EP 616 812); or an
anti-androgen such as flutamide, in dosages known for such molecules. Where
the cancer to be treated is androgen
independent cancer, the patient may previously have been subjected to anti-
androgen therapy and, after the cancer
becomes androgen independent, the anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule (and optionally other
agents as described herein) may be administered to the patient.
Sometimes, it may be beneficial to also co-administer a cardioprotectant (to
prevent or reduce myocardial
dysfunction associated with the therapy) or one or more cytokines to the
patient. In addition to the above
therapeutic regimes, the patient may be subjected to surgical removal of
cancer cells and/or radiation therapy,
before, simultaneously with, or post antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule therapy. Suitable dosages for any
of the above co-adnlinistered agents are those presently used and may be
lowered due to the combined action
94


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
(synergy) of the agent and anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule.
For the prevention or treatment of disease, the dosage and mode of
administration will be chosen by the
physician according to known criteria. The appropriate dosage of antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule will
depend on the type of disease to be treated, as defined above, the severity
and course of the disease, whether the
antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule is administered for preventive or
therapeutic purposes, previous
therapy, the patient's clinical history and response to the antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule, and the
discretion of the attending physician. The antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is suitably administered to
the patient at one time or over a series of treatments. Preferably, the
antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule
is administered by intravenous infusion or by subcutaneous injections.
Depending on the type and severity of the
disease, about 1 g/kg to about 50 mg/kg body weight (e.g., about 0.1-
15mg/kg/dose) of antibody can be an initial
candidate dosage for administration to the patient, whether, for example, by
one or more separate administrations,
or by continuous infusion. A dosing regimen can comprise administering an
initial loading dose of about 4 mg/kg,
followed by a weekly maintenance dose of about 2 mglkg of the anti-TAT
antibody. However, other dosage
regimens may be useful. A typical daily dosage might range from about 1 g/kg
to 100 mg/kg or more, depending
on the factors mentioned above. For repeated administrations over several days
or longer, depending on the
condition, the treatment is sustained until a desired suppression of disease
symptoms occurs. The progress of this
therapy can be readily monitored by conventional methods and assays and based
on criteria known to the physician
or other persons of skill in the art.
Aside from administration of the antibody protein to the patient, the present
application contemplates
administration of the antibody by gene therapy. Such administration of nucleic
acid encoding the antibody is
encompassed by the expression "administering a therapeutically effective
amount of an antibody". See, for
example, W096/07321 published March 14, 1996 concerning the use of gene
therapy to generate intracellular
antibodies.
There are two major approaches to getting the nucleic acid (optionally
contained in a vector) into the
patient's cells; in vivo and ex vivo. For in vivo delivery the nucleic acid is
injected directly into the patient, usually
at the site where the antibody is required. For ex vivo treatment, the
patient's cells are removed, the nucleic acid
is introduced into these isolated cells and the modified cells are
administered to the patient either directly or, for
example, encapsulated within porous membranes which are implanted into the
patient (see, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos.
4,892,538 and 5,283,187). There are a variety of techniques available for
introducing nucleic acids into viable
cells. The techniques vary depending upon whether the nucleic acid is
transferred into cultured cells in vitro, or
in vivo in the cells of the intended host. Techniques suitable for the
transfer of nucleic acid into mammalian cells
iyz vitro include the use of liposomes, electroporation, microinjection, cell
fusion, DEAE-dextran, the calcium
phosphate precipitation method, etc. A commonly used vector for ex vivo
delivery of the gene is a retroviral
vector.
The currently preferred in vivo nucleic acid transfer techniques include
transfection with viral vectors
(such as adenovirus, Herpes simplex I virus, or adeno-associated virus) and
lipid-based systems (useful lipids for
lipid-mediated transfer of the gene are DOTMA, DOPE and DC-Chol, for example).
For review of the currently
known gene marking and gene therapy protocols see Anderson et al., Science
256:808-813 (1992). See also WO
93/25673 and the references cited therein.



CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
The anti-TAT antibodies of the invention can be in the different forms
encompassed by the definition of
"antibody" herein. Thus, the antibodies include full length or intact
antibody, antibody fragments, native sequence
antibody or amino acid variants, humanized, chimeric or fusion antibodies,
immunoconjugates, and functional
fragments thereof. In fusion antibodies an antibody sequence is fused to a
heterologous polypeptide sequence.
The antibodies can be modified in the Fe region to provide desired effector
functions. As discussed in more detail
in the sections herein, with the appropriate Fc regions, the naked antibody
bound on the cell surface can induce
cytotoxicity, e.g., via antibody-dependent cellular cytotoxicity (ADCC) or by
recruiting complement in
complement dependent cytotoxicity, or some other mechanism. Alternatively,
where it is desirable to eliminate
or reduce effector function, so as to minimize side effects or therapeutic
complications, certain other Fc regions
may be used.
In one embodiment, the antibody competes for binding or bind substantially to,
the same epitope as the
antibodies of the invention. Antibodies having the biological characteristics
of the present anti-TAT antibodies
of the invention are also contemplated, specifically including the in vivo
tumor targeting and any cell proliferation
inhibition or cytotoxic characteristics.
Methods of producing the above antibodies are described in detail herein.
The present anti-TAT antibodies, oligopeptides and organic molecules are
useful for treating a TAT-
expressing cancer or alleviating one or more symptoms of tlie cancer in a
mammal. Such a cancer includes prostate
cancer, cancer of the urinary tract, lung cancer, breast cancer, colon cancer
and ovarian cancer, more specifically,
prostate adenocarcinoma, renal cell carcinomas, colorectal adenocarcinomas,
lung adenocarcinomas, lung
squamous cell carcinomas, and pleural mesothelioma. The cancers encompass
metastatic cancers of any of the
preceding. The antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule is able to bind to
at least a portion of the cancer cells
that express TAT polypeptide in the mammal. In a preferred embodiment, the
antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule is effective to destroy or kill TAT-expressing tumor cells or inhibit
the growth of such tumor cells, in
vitro or in vivo, upon binding to TAT polypeptide on the cell. Such an
antibody includes a naked anti-TAT
antibody (not conjugated to any agent). Naked antibodies that have cytotoxic
or cell growth inhibition properties
can be further harnessed with a cytotoxic agent to render them even more
potent in tumor cell destruction.
Cytotoxic properties can be conferred to an anti-TAT antibody by, e.g.,
conjugating the antibody with a cytotoxic
agent, to form an immunoconjugate as described herein. The cytotoxic agent or
a growth inhibitory agent is
preferably a small molecule. Toxins such as calicheamicin or a maytansinoid
and analogs or derivatives thereof,
are preferable.
The invention provides a composition comprising an anti-TAT antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule
of the invention, and a carrier. For the purposes of treating cancer,
compositions can be administered to the patient
in need of such treatment, wherein the composition can comprise one or more
anti-TAT antibodies present as an
immunoconjugate or as the naked antibody. In a further embodiment, the
compositions can comprise these
antibodies, oligopeptides or organic molecules in combination with other
therapeutic agents such as cytotoxic or
growth inhibitory agents, including chemotherapeutic agents. The invention
also provides formulations comprising
an anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule of the invention, and a
carrier. In one embodiment, the
formulation is a therapeutic formulation comprising a pharmaceutically
acceptable carrier.

96


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Another aspect of the invention is isolated nucleic acids encoding the anti-
TAT antibodies. Nucleic acids
encoding both the H and L chains and especially the hypervariable region
residues, chains which encode the native
sequence antibody as well as variants, modifications and humanized versions of
the antibody, are encompassed.
The invention also provides methods useful for treating a TAT polypeptide-
expressing cancer or
alleviating one or more symptoms of the cancer in a mammal, comprising
administering a therapeutically effective
amount of an anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule to the
mammal. The antibody, oligopeptide
or organic molecule therapeutic compositions can be administered short term
(acute) or chronic, or intermittent
as directed by physician. Also provided are methods of inhibiting the growth
of, and killing a TAT polypeptide-
expressing cell.
The invention also provides kits and articles of manufacture comprising at
least one anti-TAT antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule. Kits containing anti-TAT antibodies,
oligopeptides or organic molecules find
use, e.g., for TAT cell killing assays, for purification or
immunoprecipitation of TAT polypeptide from cells. For
example, for isolation and purification of TAT, the kit can contain an anti-
TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule coupled to beads (e.g., sepharose beads). Kits can be provided which
contain the antibodies,
oligopeptides or organic molecules for detection and quantitation of TAT in
vitro, e.g., in an ELISA or a Western
blot. Such antibody, oligopeptide or organic molecule useful for detection may
be provided with a label such as
a fluorescent or radiolabel.
L. Articles of Manufacture and Kits
Another embodiment of the invention is an article of manufacture containing
materials useful for the
treatment of anti-TAT expressing cancer. The article of manufacture comprises
a container and a label or package
insert on or associated with the container. Suitable containers include, for
example, bottles, vials, syringes, etc.
The containers may be formed from a variety of materials such as glass or
plastic. The container holds a
composition which is effective for treating the cancer condition and may have
a sterile access port (for example
the container may be an intravenous solution bag or a vial having a stopper
pierceable by a hypodermic injection
needle). At least one active agent in the composition is an anti-TAT antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule
of the invention. The label or package insert indicates that the composition
is used for treating cancer. The label
or package insert will further comprise instructions for administering the
antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule composition to the cancer patient. Additionally, the article
ofmanufacture may further comprise a second
container comprising a pharmaceutically-acceptable buffer, such as
bacteriostatic water for injection (BWFI),
phosphate-buffered saline, Ringer's solution and dextrose solution. It may
further include other materials desirable
from a conunercial and user standpoint, including other buffers, diluents,
filters, needles, and syringes.
Kits are also provided that are useful for various purposes, e.g., for TAT-
expressing cell killing assays,
for purification or immunoprecipitation of TAT polypeptide from cells. For
isolation and purification of TAT
polypeptide, the kit can contain an anti-TAT antibody, oligopeptide or organic
molecule coupled to beads (e.g.,
sepharose beads). Kits can be provided which contain the antibodies,
oligopeptides or organic molecules for
detection and quantitation of TAT polypeptide in vitro, e.g., in an ELISA or a
Western blot. As with the article
of manufacture, the kit comprises a container and a label or package insert on
or associated with the container.
The container holds a composition comprising at least one anti-TAT antibody,
oligopeptide or organic molecule
of the invention. Additional containers may be included that contain, e.g.,
diluents and buffers, control antibodies.
97


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
The label or package insert may provide a description of the composition as
well as instructions for the intended
in vitro or diagnostic use.
M. Uses for TAT Polypeptides and TAT-Polypeptide Encodiniz Nucleic Acids
Nucleotide sequences (or their complement) encoding TAT polypeptides have
various applications in the
art of molecular biology, including uses as hybridization probes, in
chromosome and gene mapping and in the
generation of anti-sense RNA and DNA probes. TAT-encoding nucleic acid will
also be useful for the preparation
of TAT polypeptides by the recombinant techniques described herein, wherein
those TAT polypeptides may find
use, for 6xample, in the preparation of anti-TAT antibodies as described
herein.
The full-length native sequence TAT gene, or portions thereof, may be used as
hybridization probes for
a cDNA library to isolate the full-length TAT eDNA or to isolate still other
cDNAs (for instance, those encoding
naturally-occurring variants of TAT or TAT from other species) which have a
desired sequence identity to the
native TAT sequence disclosed herein. Optionally, the length of the probes
will be about 20 to about 50 bases.
The hybridization probes may be derived from at least partially novel regions
of the full length native nucleotide
sequence wherein those regions may be determined without undue experimentation
or from genomic sequences
including promoters, enhancer elements and introns of native sequence TAT. By
way of example, a screening
metliod will comprise isolating the coding region of the TAT gene using the
known DNA sequence to synthesize
a selected probe of about 40 bases. Hybridization probes may be labeled by a
variety of labels, including
radionucleotides such as 32P or 35S, or enzymatic labels such as alkaline
phosphatase coupled to the probe via
avidin/biotin coupling systems. Labeled probes having a sequence complementary
to that of the TAT gene of the
present invention can be used to screen libraries of human cDNA, genomic DNA
or mRNA to determine which
members of such libraries the probe hybridizes to. Hybridization techniques
are described in further detail in the
Examples below. Any EST sequences disclosed in the present application may
similarly be employed as probes,
using the methods disclosed herein.
Other useful fragments of the TAT-encoding nucleic acids include antisense or
sense oligonucleotides
comprising a singe-stranded nucleic acid sequence (either RNA or DNA) capable
of binding to target TAT mRNA
(sense) or TAT DNA (antisense) sequences. Antisense or sense oligonucleotides,
according to the present
invention, comprise a fragment of the coding region of TAT DNA. Such a
fragment generally comprises at least
about 14 nucleotides, preferably from about 14 to 30 nucleotides. The ability
to derive an antisense or a sense
oligonucleotide, based upon a cDNA sequence encoding a given protein is
described in, for example, Stein and
Cohen (Cancer Res. 48:2659, 1988) and van der Krol et al. (BioTechnigues
6:958, 1988).
Binding of antisense or sense oligonucleotides to target nucleic acid
sequences results in the formation
of duplexes that block transcription or translation of the target sequence by
one of several means, including
enhanced degradation of the duplexes, premature termination of transcription
or translation, or by other means.
Such methods are encompassed by the present invention. The antisense
oligonucleotides thus may be used to block
expression of TAT proteins, wherein those TAT proteins may play a role in the
induction of cancer in mammals.
Antisense or sense oligonucleotides further comprise oligonucleotides having
modified sugar-phosphodiester
backbones (or other sugar linkages, such as those described in WO 91/06629)
and wherein such sugar linkages
are resistant to endogenous nucleases. Such oligonucleotides with resistant
sugar linkages are stable in vivo (i.e.,
capable of resisting enzymatic degradation) but retain sequence specificity to
be able to bind to target nucleotide
98


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
sequences.
Preferred intragenic sites for antisense binding include the region
incorporating the translation
initiation/start codon (5'-AUG / 5'-ATG) or termination/stop codon (5'-UAA, 5'-
UAG and 5-UGA / 5'-TAA,
5'-TAG and 5'-TGA) of the open reading frame (ORF) of the gene. These regions
refer to a portion of the mRNA
or gene that encompasses from about 25 to about 50 contiguous nucleotides in
either direction (i.e., 5' or 3') from
a translation initiation or termination codon. Otlier preferred regions for
antisense binding include: introns; exons;
intron-exon junctions; the open reading frame (ORF) or "coding region," which
is the region between the
translation initiation codon and the translation terniination codon; the 5'
cap of an mRNA which comprises an
N7-methylated guanosine residue joined to the 5-most residue of the mRNA via a
5'-5' triphosphate linkage and
includes 5' cap structure itself as well as the first 50 nucleotides adjacent
to the cap; the 5' untranslated region
(5'UTR), the portion of an mRNA in the 5' direction from the translation
initiation codon, and thus including
nucleotides between the 5' cap site and the translation initiation codon of an
mRNA or corresponding nucleotides
on the gene; and the 3' untranslated region (3'UTR), the portion of an mRNA in
the 3' direction from the translation
termination codon, and thus including nucleotides between the translation
termination codon and 3' end of an
mRNA or corresponding nucleotides on the gene.
Specific examples of preferred antisense compounds useful for inhibiting
expression of TAT proteins
include oligonucleotides containing modified backbones or non-natural
internucleoside linkages. Oligonucleotides
having modified backbones include those that retain a phosphorus atom in the
backbone and those that do not have
a phosphorus atom in the backbone. For the purposes of this specification, and
as sometimes referenced in the art,
modified oligonucleotides that do not have a phosphorus atom in their
internucleoside backbone can also be
considered to be oligonucleosides. Preferred modified oligonucleotide
backbones include, for example,
phosphorothioates, chiral phosphorothioates, phosphorodithioates,
phosphotriesters, aminoalkylphosphotri-esters,
methyl and other alkyl phosphonates including 3'-alkylene phosplionates, 5'-
alkylene phosphonates and chiral
phosphonates, phosphinates, phosphoramidates including 3'-amino
phosphoramidate and
aminoalkylphosphoramidates, thionophosphoramidates, thionoalkylphosphonates,
thionoalkylphosphotriesters,
selenophosphates and borano-phosphates having normal 3'-5' linkages, 2'-5'
linked analogs of these, and those
having inverted polarity wherein one or more internucleotide linkages is a 3'
to 3', 5' to 5' or 2' to 2' linkage.
Preferred oligonucleotides having inverted polarity comprise a single 3' to 3'
linkage at the 3'-most internucleotide
linkage i.e. a single inverted nucleoside residue which may be abasic (the
nucleobase is missing or has a hydroxyl
group in place thereof). Various salts, mixed salts and free acid forms are
also included. Representative United
States patents that teach the preparation of phosphorus-containing linkages
include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat.
Nos.: 3,687,808; 4,469,863; 4,476,301; 5,023,243; 5,177,196; 5,188,897;
5,264,423; 5,276,019; 5,278,302;
5,286,717; 5,321,131; 5,399,676; 5,405,939; 5,453,496; 5,455,233; 5,466,677;
5,476,925; 5,519,126; 5,536,821;
5,541,306; 5,550,111; 5,563,253; 5,571,799; 5,587,361; 5,194,599; 5,565,555;
5,527,899; 5,721,218; 5,672,697
and 5,625,050, each of which is herein incorporated by reference.
Preferred modified oligonucleotide backbones that do not include a phosphorus
atom therein have
backbones that are formed by short chain alkyl or cycloalkyl internucleoside
linkages, mixed heteroatom and alkyl
or cycloalkyl internucleoside linkages, or one or more short chain
heteroatomic or heterocyclic internucleoside
linkages. These include those having morpholino linkages (formed in part from
the sugar portion of a nucleoside);
99


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
siloxane backbones; sulfide, sulfoxide and sulfone backbones; formacetyl and
thioformacetyl backbones;
methylene formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones; riboacetyl backbones;
alkene containing backbones;
sulfamate backbones; methyleneimino and methylenehydrazino backbones;
sulfonate and sulfonamide backbones;
amide backbones; and others having mixed N, 0, S and CH2 component parts.
Representative United States
patents that teach the preparation of such oligonucleosides include, but are
not limited to,. U.S. Pat. Nos.:
5,034,506; 5,166,315; 5,185,444; 5,214,134; 5,216,141; 5,235,033; 5,264,562;
5,264,564; 5,405,938; 5,434,257;
5,466,677; 5,470,967; 5,489,677; 5,541,307; 5,561,225; 5,596,086; 5,602,240;
5,610,289; 5,602,240; 5,608,046;
5,610,289; 5,618,704; 5,623,070; 5,663,312; 5,633,360; 5,677,437; 5,792,608;
5,646,269 and 5,677,439, each
of which is herein incorporated by reference.
In other preferred antisense oligonucleotides, both the sugar and the
internucleoside linkage, i.e., the
backbone, of the nucleotide units are replaced witli novel groups. The base
units are maintained for hybridization
with an appropriate nucleic acid target compound. One such oligomeric
compound, an oligonucleotide mimetic
that has been shown to have excellent hybridization properties, is referred to
as a peptide nucleic acid (PNA). In
PNA compounds, the sugar-backbone of an oligonucleotide is replaced with an
amide containing backbone, in
particular an aminoethylglycine backbone. The nucleobases are retained and are
bound directly or indirectly to aza
nitrogen atoms of the amide portion of the backbone. Representative United
States patents that teach the
preparation of PNA compounds include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos.:
5,539,082; 5,714,331; and
5,719,262, each of which is herein incorporated by reference. Further teaching
of PNA compounds can be found
in Nielsen et al., Science, 1991, 254, 1497-1500.
Preferred antisense oligonucleotides incorporate phosphorothioate backbones
and/or heteroatom
backbones, and in particular -CHz NH-O-CHZ-, -CHZ N(CH3)-O-CHZ [known as a
methylene (methylimino) or
MMI backbone], -CHZ-O-N(CH3)-CH2-,-CHZ N(CH3)-N(CH3)-CHZ and -O-N(CH3)-CHZ CHZ
[wherein the native
phosphodiester backbone is represented as -O-P-O-CHZ-] described in the above
referenced U.S. Pat. No.
5,489,677, and the amide backbones of the above referenced U.S. Pat. No.
5,602,240. Also preferred are antisense
oligonucleotides having morpholino backbone structures of the above-referenced
U.S. Pat. No. 5,034,506.
Modified oligonucleotides may also contain one or more substituted sugar
moieties. Preferred
oligonucleotides comprise one of the following at the 2' position: OH; F; 0-
alkyl, S-alkyl, or N-alkyl; 0-alkenyl,
S-alkeynyl, or N-alkenyl; 0-alkynyl, S-alkynyl or N-alkynyl; or O-alkyl-O-
alkyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl and
alkynyl may be substituted or unsubstituted Cl to Clo alkyl or CZ to Clo
alkenyl and alkynyl. Particularly preferred
are O[(CH?)oO]mCH3, O(CHZ)õOCH3, O(CH2)õNH1, O(CHZ)õCH3, O(CHz)õONHZ, and
O(CHZ)nON[(CHZ)õCH3)]Z,
where n and m are from 1 to about 10. Other preferred antisense
oligonucleotides comprise one of the following
at the 2' position: Ci to Cla lower alkyl, substituted lower alkyl, alkenyl,
alkynyl, alkaryl, aralkyl, 0-alkaryl or
O-aralkyl, SH, SCH3, OCN, Cl, Br, CN, CF3, OCF3, SOCH3, SO2 CH31 ONOz, NOZ,
N3, NHZ, heterocycloalkyl,
heterocycloalkaryl, aminoalkylamino, polyalkylamino, substituted silyl, an RNA
cleaving group, a reporter group,
an intercalator, a group for improving the pharmacokinetic properties of an
oligonucleotide, or a group for
improving the pharmacodynamic properties ofan oligonucleotide, and other
substituents having similar properties.
A preferred modification includes 2'-methoxyethoxy (2'-O-CHZCH2OCH3, also
known as 2'-O-(2-methoxyethyl)
or 2'-MOE) (Martin et al., Helv. Chim. Acta, 1995, 78, 486-504) i.e., an
alkoxyalkoxy group. A further preferred
modification includes 2'-dimethylaminooxyethoxy, i.e., a O(CH2)20N(CH3)2
group, also known as 2'-DMAOE,
100


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
as described in examples hereinbelow, and 2'-dimethylaminoethoxyethoxy (also
known in the art as
2'-O-dimethylaminoethoxyethyl or 2'-DMAEOE), i.e., 2'-O-CH2-O-CHZ-N(CHZ).
A further prefered modification includes Locked Nucleic Acids (LNAs) in which
the 2'-hydroxyl group
is linked to the 3' or 4' carbon atom of the sugar ring thereby forming a
bicyclic sugar moiety. The linkage is
preferably a methelyne (-CHZ ),, group bridging the 2' oxygen atom and the 4'
carbon atom wherein n is 1 or 2.
LNAs and preparation thereof are described in WO 98/39352 and WO 99/14226.
Other preferred modifications include 2'-methoxy (2'-O-CH3), 2'-aminopropoxy
(2'-OCHZCH2CH2 NHZ),
2'-allyl (2'-CH2-CH=CH2), 2'-O-allyl (2'-O-CHZ CH=CH2) and 2'-fluoro (2'-F).
The 2'-modification may be in the
arabino (up) position or ribo (down) position. A preferred 2'-arabino
modification is 2'-F. Similar modifications
may also be made at other positions on the oligonucleotide, particularly the
3' position of the sugar on the 3'
terminal nucleotide or in 2'-5' linked oligonucleotides and the 5' position of
5'terminal nucleotide. Oligonucleotides
may also have sugar mimetics such as cyclobutyl moieties in place of the
pentofuranosyl sugar. Representative
United States patents that teach the preparation of such modified sugar
structures include, but are not limited to,
U.S. Pat. Nos.: 4,981,957; 5,118,800; 5,319,080; 5,359,044; 5,393,878;
5,446,137; 5,466,786; 5,514,785;
5,519,134; 5,567,811; 5,576,427; 5,591,722; 5,597,909; 5,610,300; 5,627,053;
5,639,873; 5,646,265; 5,658,873;
5,670,633; 5,792,747; and 5,700,920, each of which is herein incorporated by
reference in its entirety.
Oligonucleotides may also include nucleobase (often referred to in the art
simply as "base") modifications
or substitutions. As used herein, "unmodified" or "natural" nucleobases
include the purine bases adenine (A) and
guanine (G), and the pyrimidine bases thymine (T), cytosine (C) and uracil
(U). Modified nucleobases include
other synthetic and natural nucleobases such as 5-methylcytosine (5-me-C), 5-
hydroxymethyl cytosine, xanthine,
hypoxanthine, 2-aminoadenine, 6-methyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine
and guanine, 2-propyl and other
alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2-thiouracil, 2-thiothymine and 2-
thiocytosine, 5-halouracil and cytosine,
5-propynyl (-C_C-CH3 or -CHZ C=CH) uracil and cytosine and other alkynyl
derivatives of pyrimidine bases,
6-azo uracil, cytosine and thymine, 5-uracil (pseudouracil), 4-thiouracil, 8-
halo, 8-amino, 8-thiol, 8-thioalkyl,
8-hydroxyl and other 8-substituted adenines and guanines, 5-halo particularly
5-bromo, 5-trifluoromethyl and other
5-substituted uracils and cytosines, 7-methylguanine and 7-methyladenine, 2-F-
adenine, 2-amino-adenine,
8-azaguanine and 8-azaadenine, 7-deazaguanine and 7-deazaadenine and 3-
deazaguanine and 3-deazaadenine.
Further modified nucleobases include tricyclic pyrimidines such as phenoxazine
cytidine(1H-pyrimido[5,4-b][1,4]benzoxazin-2(3H)-one), phenothiazine cytidine
(1H-pyrimido[5,4-b][1,4]benzothiazin-2(3H)-one), G-clamps such as a
substituted phenoxazine cytidine (e.g.
9-(2-aminoethoxy)-H-pyrimido[5,4-b][1,4]benzoxazin-2(3H)-one), carbazole
cytidine
(2H-pyrimido[4,5-b]indol-2-one), pyridoindole cytidine (H-
pyrido[3',2':4,5]pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-2-one).
Modified nucleobases may also include those in which the purine or pyrimidine
base is replaced with other
heterocycles, for example 7-deaza-adenine, 7-deazaguanosine, 2-aminopyridine
and 2-pyridone. Further
nucleobases include those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 3,687,808, those
disclosed in The Concise Encyclopedia Of
Polymer Science And Engineering, pages 858-859, Kroschwitz, J. I., ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1990, and those
disclosed by Englisch et aL, Angewandte Chemie, International Edition, 1991,
30, 613. Certain of these
nucleobases are particularly useful for increasing the binding affinity of the
oligomeric compounds of the
invention. These include 5-substituted pyrimidines, 6-azapyrimidines and N-2,
N-6 and 0-6 substituted purines,
101


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
including 2-aminopropyladenine, 5-propynyluracil and 5-propynylcytosine. 5-
methylcytosine substitutions have
been shown to increase nucleic acid duplex stability by 0.6-1.2° C.
(Sanghvi et al, Antisense Research and
Applications, CRC Press, Boca Raton, 1993, pp. 276-278) and are preferred base
substitutions, even more
particularly when combined with 2'-O-methoxyethyl sugar modifications.
Representative United States patents
that teach the preparation of modified nucleobases include, but are not
limited to: U.S. Pat. No. 3,687,808, as well
as U.S. Pat. Nos.: 4,845,205; 5,130,302; 5,134,066; 5,175,273; 5,367,066;
5,432,272; 5,457,187; 5,459,255;
5,484,908; 5,502,177; 5,525,711; 5,552,540; 5,587,469; 5,594,121, 5,596,091;
5,614,617; 5,645,985; 5,830,653;
5,763,588; 6,005,096; 5,681,941 and 5,750,692, each of which is herein
incorporated by reference.
Another modification of antisense oligonucleotides chemically linking to the
oligonucleotide one or more
moieties or conjugates which enhance the activity, cellular distribution or
cellular uptake of the oligonucleotide.
The compounds of the invention can include conjugate groups covalently bound
to functional groups such as
primary or secondary hydroxyl groups. Conjugate groups of the invention
include intercalators, reporter molecules,
polyamines, polyamides, polyethylene glycols, polyethers, groups that enhance
the pharmacodynamic properties
of oligomers, and groups that enhance the pharmacokinetic properties of
oligomers. Typical conjugates groups
include cholesterols, lipids, cation lipids, phospholipids, cationic
phospholipids, biotin, phenazine, folate,
phenanthridine, anthraquinone, acridine, fluoresceins, rhodamines, coumarins,
and dyes. Groups that enhance the
pharmacodynamic properties, in the context of this invention, include groups
that improve oligomer uptake,
enhance oligomer resistance to degradation, and/or strengthen sequence-
specific hybridization with RNA. Groups
that enhance the pharmacokinetic properties, in the context of this invention,
include groups that improve oligomer
uptake, distribution, metabolism or excretion. Conjugate moieties include but
are not limited to lipid moieties such
as a cholesterol moiety (Letsinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 1989,
86, 6553-6556), cholic acid
(Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Let., 1994,4,1053-1060), a thioether,
e.g., hexyl-S-tritylthiol (Manoharan
et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci., 1992, 660, 306-309; Manoharan et al., Bioorg.
Med. Chem. Let., 1993, 3,
2765-2770), a thiocholesterol (Oberhauser et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 1992, 20,
533-538), an aliphatic chain, e.g.,
dodecandiol or undecyl residues (Saison-Behmoaras et al., EMBO J.,
1991,10,1111-1118; Kabanov et al., FEBS
Lett., 1990, 259, 327-330; Svinarchuk et al., Biochimie, 1993, 75, 49-54), a
phospholipid, e.g.,
di-hexadecyl-rac-glycerol or triethyl-ammonium 1,2-di-0-hexadecyl-rac-glycero-
3-H-phosphonate (Manoharan
et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36, 3651-3654; Shea et al., Nucl. Acids Res.,
1990, 18, 3777-3783), a polyamine
or a polyethylene glycol chain (Manoharan et al., Nucleosides & Nucleotides,
1995, 14, 969-973), or adamantane
acetic acid (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36, 3651-3654), a
palniityl moiety (Mishra et al., Biochim.
Biophys. Acta, 1995, 1264, 229-237), or an octadecylamine or hexylamino-
carbonyl-oxycholesterol moiety.
Oligonucleotides of the invention may also be conjugated to active drug
substances, for example, aspirin, warfarin,
phenylbutazone, ibuprofen, suprofen, fenbufen, ketoprofen, (S)-(+)-
pranoprofen, carprofen, dansylsarcosine,
2,3,5-triiodobenzoic acid, flufenamic acid, folinic acid, a benzothiadiazide,
chlorothiazide, a diazepine,
indomethicin, a barbiturate, a cephalosporin, a sulfa drug, an antidiabetic,
an antibacterial or an antibiotic.
Oligonucleotide-drug conjugates and their preparation are described in U.S.
patent application Ser. No. 09/334,130
(filed Jun. 15, 1999) and United States patents Nos.: 4,828,979; 4,948,882;
5,218,105; 5,525,465; 5,541,313;
5,545,730; 5,552,538; 5,578,717,5,580,731; 5,580,731; 5,591,584; 5,109,124;
5,118,802; 5,138,045; 5,414,077;
5,486,603; 5,512,439; 5,578,718; 5,608,046; 4,587,044; 4,605,735; 4,667,025;
4,762,779; 4,789,737; 4,824,941;
102


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
4,835,263; 4,876,335; 4,904,582; 4,958,013; 5,082,830; 5,112,963; 5,214,136;
5,082,830; 5,112,963; 5,214,136;
5,245,022; 5,254,469; 5,258,506; 5,262,536; 5,272,250; 5,292,873; 5,317,098;
5,371,241, 5,391,723; 5,416,203,
5,451,463; 5,510,475; 5,512,667; 5,514,785; 5,565,552; 5,567,810; 5,574,142;
5,585,481; 5,587,371; 5,595,726;
5,597,696; 5,599,923; 5,599,928 and 5,688,941, each of which is herein
incorporated by reference.
It is not necessary for all positions in a given compound to be uniformly
modified, and in fact more than
one of the aforementioned modifications may be incorporated in a single
compound or even at a single nucleoside
within an oligonucleotide. The present invention also includes antisense
compounds which are chimeric
compounds. "Chimeric" antisense compounds or "chimeras," in the context of
this invention, are antisense
compounds, particularly oligonucleotides, which contain two or more chemically
distinct regions, each made up
of at least one monomer unit, i.e., a nucleotide in the case of an
oligonucleotide compound. These oligonucleotides
typically contain at least one region wherein the oligonucleotide is modified
so as to confer upon the
oligonucleotide increased resistance to nuclease degradation, increased
cellular uptake, and/or increased binding
affinity for the target nucleic acid. An additional region of the
oligonucleotide may serve as a substrate for enzymes
capable of cleaving RNA:DNA or RNA:RNA hybrids. By way of example, RNase H is
a cellular endonuclease
which cleaves the RNA strand of an RNA:DNA duplex. Activation of RNase H,
therefore, results in cleavage of
the RNA target, thereby greatly enhancing the efficiency of oligonucleotide
inhibition of gene expression.
Consequently, comparable results can often be obtained with shorter
oligonucleotides when chimeric
oligonucleotides are used, compared to phosphorothioate deoxyoligonucleotides
hybridizing to the same target
region. Chimeric antisense compounds of the invention may be formed as
composite structures of two or more
oligonucleotides, modified oligonucleotides, oligonucleosides and/or
oligonucleotide mimetics as described above.
Preferred chimeric antisense oligonucleotides incorporate at least one 2'
modified sugar (preferably 2'-O-(CH?)2 O-
CH3) at the 3' terminal to confer nuclease resistance and a region with at
least 4 contiguous 2'-H sugars to confer
RNase H activity. Such compounds have also been referred to in the art as
hybrids or gapmers. Preferred gapmers
have a region of 2' modified sugars (preferably 2'-O-(CHz)2 O-CH3) at the 3'-
terminal and at the 5' terminal
separated by at least one region having at least 4 contiguous 2'-H sugars and
preferably incorporate
phosphorothioate backbone linkages. Representative United States patents that
teach the preparation of such hybrid
structures include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,013,830;
5,149,797; 5,220,007; 5,256,775; 5,366,878;
5,403,711; 5,491,133; 5,565,350; 5,623,065; 5,652,355; 5,652,356; and
5,700,922, each of which is herein
incorporated by reference in its entirety.
The antisense compounds used in accordance with this invention may be
conveniently and routinely made
through the well-known technique of solid phase synthesis. Equipment for such
synthesis is sold by several
vendors including, for example, Applied Biosystems (Foster City, Calif.). Any
other means for such synthesis
known in the art may additionally or alternatively be employed. It is well
known to use similar techniques to
prepare oligonucleotides such as the phosphorothioates and alkylated
derivatives. The compounds of the invention
may also be admixed, encapsulated, conjugated or otherwise associated with
other molecules, molecule structures
or mixtures of compounds, as for example, liposomes, receptor targeted
molecules, oral, rectal, topical or other
formulations, for assisting in uptake, distribution and/or absorption.
Representative United States patents that teach
the preparation of such uptake, distribution and/or absorption assisting
formulations include, but are not limited
to, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,108,921; 5,354,844; 5,416,016; 5,459,127; 5,521,291;
5,543,158; 5,547,932; 5,583,020;
103


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
5,591,721; 4,426,330; 4,534,899; 5,013,556; 5,108,921; 5,213,804; 5,227,170;
5,264,221; 5,356,633; 5,395,619;
5,416,016; 5,417,978; 5,462,854; 5,469,854; 5,512,295; 5,527,528; 5,534,259;
5,543,152; 5,556,948; 5,580,575;
and 5,595,756, each of which is herein incorporated by reference.
Other examples of sense or antisense oligonucleotides include those
oligonucleotides which are covalently
linked to organic moieties, such as those described in WO 90/10048, and other
moieties that increases affinity of
the oligonucleotide for a target nucleic acid sequence, such as poly-(L-
lysine). Further still, intercalating agents,
such as ellipticine, and alkylating agents or metal complexes may be attached
to sense or antisense oligonucleotides
to modify binding specificities of the antisense or sense oligonucleotide for
the target nucleotide sequence.
Antisense or sense oligonucleotides may be introduced into a cell containing
the target nucleic acid
sequence by any gene transfermethod, including, for example, CaP04-mediated
DNA transfection, electroporation,
or by using gene transfer vectors such as Epstein-Barr virus. In a preferred
procedure, an antisense or sense
oligonucleotide is inserted into a suitable retroviral vector. A cell
containing the target nucleic acid sequence is
contacted with the recombinant retroviral vector, either in vivo or ex vivo.
Suitable retroviral vectors include, but
are not limited to, those derived from the murine retrovirus M-MuLV, N2 (a
retrovirus derived from M-MuLV),
or the double copy vectors designated DCT5A, DCT5B and DCT5C (see WO
90/13641).
Sense or antisense oligonucleotides also may be introduced into a cell
containing the target nucleotide
sequence by formation of a conjugate with a ligand binding molecule, as
described in WO 91/04753. Suitable
ligand binding molecules include, but are not limited to, cell surface
receptors, growth factors, other cytokines,
or other ligands that bind to cell surface receptors. Preferably, conjugation
of the ligand binding molecule does
not substantially interfere with the ability of the ligand binding molecule to
bind to its corresponding molecule or
receptor, or block entry of the sense or antisense oligonucleotide or its
conjugated version into the cell.
Alternatively, a sense or an antisense oligonucleotide may be introduced into
a cell containing the target
nucleic acid sequence by formation of an oligonucleotide-lipid complex, as
described in WO 90/10448. The sense
or antisense oligonucleotide-lipid complex is preferably dissociated within
the cell by an endogenous lipase.
Antisense or sense RNA or DNA molecules are generally at least about 5
nucleotides in length,
alternatively at least about 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18,
19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29,
30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, 65, 70, 75, 80, 85, 90, 95, 100, 105, 110, 115,
120, 125, 130, 135, 140, 145, 150, 155,
160, 165, 170,175, 180, 185, 190,195, 200, 210, 220, 230, 240, 250, 260, 270,
280, 290, 300, 310, 320, 330, 340,
350, 360, 370, 380, 390, 400, 410, 420, 430, 440, 450, 460, 470, 480, 490,
500, 510, 520, 530, 540, 550, 560, 570,
580, 590, 600, 610, 620, 630, 640, 650, 660, 670, 680, 690, 700, 710, 720,
730, 740, 750, 760, 770, 780, 790, 800,
810, 820, 830, 840, 850, 860, 870, 880, 890, 900, 910, 920, 930, 940, 950,
960, 970, 980, 990, or 1000
nucleotides in length, wherein in this context the term "about" means the
referenced nucleotide sequence length
plus or minus 10% of that referenced length.
The probes may also be employed in PCR techniques to generate a pool of
sequences for identification
of closely related TAT coding sequences.
Nucleotide sequences encoding a TAT can also be used to construct
hybridization probes for mapping
the gene which encodes that TAT and for the genetic analysis of individuals
with genetic disorders. The nucleotide
sequences provided herein may be mapped to a chromosome and specific regions
of a chromosome using known
techniques, such as in situ hybridization, linkage analysis against known
chromosomal markers, and hybridization
104


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
screening with libraries.
When the coding sequences for TAT encode a protein which binds to another
protein (example, where
the TAT is a receptor), the TAT can be used in assays to identify the other
proteins or molecules involved in the
binding interaction. By such methods, inhibitors of the receptor/ligand
binding interaction can be identified.
Proteins involved in such binding interactions can also be used to screen for
peptide or small molecule inhibitors
or agonists of the binding interaction. Also, the receptor TAT can be used to
isolate correlative ligand(s).
Screening assays can be designed to find lead compounds that miniic the
biological activity of a native TAT or
a receptor for TAT. Such screening assays will include assays amenable to high-
throughput screening of chemical
libraries, making them particularly suitable for identifying small molecule
drug candidates. Small molecules
contemplated include synthetic organic or inorganic compounds. The assays can
be performed in a variety of
formats, including protein-protein binding assays, biochemical screening
assays, immunoassays and cell based
assays, which are well characterized in the art.
Nucleic acids which encode TAT or its modified forms can also be used to
generate either transgenic
animals or "knock out" animals which, in turn, are useful in the development
and screening of therapeutically
useful reagents. A transgenic animal (e.g., a mouse or rat) is an animal
having cells that contain a transgene, which
transgene was introduced into the animal or an ancestor of the animal at a
prenatal, e.g., an embryonic stage. A
transgene is a DNA which is integrated into the genome of a cell from which a
transgenic animal develops. In one
embodiment, cDNA encoding TAT can be used to clone genomic DNA encoding TAT in
accordance with
established techniques and the genoniic sequences used to generate transgenic
animals that contain cells which
express DNA encoding TAT. Methods for generating transgenic animals,
particularly animals such as mice or rats,
have become conventional in the art and are described, for example, in U.S.
Patent Nos. 4,736,866 and 4,870,009.
Typically, particular cells would be targeted for TAT transgene incorporation
with tissue-specific enhancers.
Transgenic animals that include a copy of a transgene encoding TAT introduced
into the germ line of the animal
at an einbryonic stage can be used to examine the effect of increased
expression of DNA encoding TAT. Such
animals can be used as tester animals for reagents thought to confer
protection from, for example, pathological
conditions associated with its overexpression. In accordance with this facet
of the invention, an animal is treated
with the reagent and a reduced incidence of the pathological condition,
compared to untreated animals bearing the
transgene, would indicate a potential therapeutic intervention for the
pathological condition.
Alternatively, non-human homologues of TAT can be used to construct a TAT
"knock out" animal which
has a defective or altered gene encoding TAT as a result of homologous
recombination between the endogenous
gene encoding TAT and altered genomic DNA encoding TAT introduced into an
embryonic stem cell of the
animal. For example, cDNA encoding TAT can be used to clone genomic DNA
encoding TAT in accordance with
established techniques. A portion of the genomic DNA encoding TAT can be
deleted or replaced with another
gene, such as a gene encoding a selectable marker which can be used to monitor
integration. Typically, several
kilobases of unaltered flanking DNA (both at the 5' and 3' ends) are included
in the vector [see e.g., Thomas and
Capecchi, Cell, 51:503 (1987) for a description of homologous recombination
vectors]. The vector is introduced
into an embryonic stem cell line (e.g., by electroporation) and cells in which
the introduced DNA has
homologously recombined with the endogenous DNA are selected [see e.g., Li et
al., Cell, 69:915 (1992)]. The
selected cells are then injected into a blastocyst of an animal (e.g., a mouse
or rat) to form aggregation chimeras
105


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
[see e.g., Bradley, in TeratocarcinonTas and Enibryonic Stena Cells: A
Practical Approach, E. J. Robertson, ed.
(IRL, Oxford, 1987), pp. 113-152]. A chimeric embryo can then be implanted
into a suitable pseudopregnant
female foster animal and the embryo brought to term to create a "knock out"
animal. Progeny harboring the
homologously recombined DNA in their germ cells can be identified by standard
techniques and used to breed
animals in which all cells of the animal contain the homologously recombined
DNA. Knockout animals can be
characterized for instance, for their ability to defend against certain
pathological conditions and for their
development of pathological conditions due to absence of the TAT polypeptide.
Nucleic acid encoding the TAT polypeptides may also be used in gene tlierapy.
In gene therapy
applications, genes are introduced into cells in order to achieve in vivo
synthesis of a therapeutically effective
genetic product, for example for replacement of a defective gene. "Gene
therapy" includes both conventional gene
therapy where a lasting effect is achieved by a single treatment, and the
administration of gene therapeutic agents,
which involves the one time or repeated administration of a therapeutically
effective DNA or mRNA. Antisense
RNAs and DNAs can be used as therapeutic agents for blocking the expression of
certain genes in vivo. It has
already been shown that short antisense oligonucleotides can be imported into
cells where they act as inhibitors,
despite their low intracellular concentrations caused by their restricted
uptake by the cell membrane. (Zamecnik
et al., Proc. Nati. Acad. Sci. USA 83:4143-4146 [1986]). The oligonucleotides
can be modified to enhance their
uptake, e.g. by substituting their negatively charged phosphodiester groups by
uncharged groups.
There are a variety of techniques available for introducing nucleic acids into
viable cells. The techniques
vary depending upon whether the nucleic acid is transferred into cultured
cells in vitro, or in vivo in the cells of
the intended host. Techniques suitable for the transfer of nucleic acid into
mammalian cells in vitro include the
use of liposomes, electroporation, microinjection, cell fusion, DEAE-dextran,
the calcium phosphate precipitation
method, etc. The currently preferred in vivo gene transfer techniques include
transfection with viral (typically
retroviral) vectors and viral coat protein-liposome mediated transfection
(Dzau et al., Trends in Biotechnology 11,
205-210 [1993]). In some situations it is desirable to provide the nucleic
acid source with an agent that targets the
target cells, such as an antibody specific for a cell surface membrane protein
or the target cell, a ligand for a
receptor on the target cell, etc. Where liposomes are employed, proteins which
bind to a cell surface membrane
protein associated with endocytosis may be used for targeting and/or to
facilitate uptake, e.g. capsid proteins or
fragments thereof tropic for a particular cell type, antibodies for proteins
which undergo internalization in cycling,
proteins that target intracellular localiza6on and enhance intracellular half-
life. The technique of receptor-
mediated endocytosis is described, for example, by Wu et al., J. Biol. Chem.
262, 4429-4432 (1987); and Wagner
et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 87, 3410-3414 (1990). For review of gene
marking and gene therapy protocols
see Anderson et al., Science 256, 808-813 (1992).
The nucleic acid molecules encoding the TAT polypeptides or fragments thereof
described herein are
useful for chromosome identification. In this regard, there exists an ongoing
need to identify new chrornosome
markers, since relatively few chromosome marking reagents, based upon actual
sequence data are presently
available. Each TAT nucleic acid molecule of the present invention can be used
as a chromosome marker.
The TAT polypeptides and nucleic acid molecules of the present invention may
also be used
diagnostically for tissue typing, wherein the TAT polypeptides of the present
invention may be differentially
expressed in one tissue as compared to another, preferably in a diseased
tissue as compared to a normal tissue of
106


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
the same tissue type. TAT nucleic acid molecules will find use for generating
probes for PCR, Northern analysis,
Southern analysis and Western analysis.
This invention encompasses methods of screening compounds to identify those
that mimic the TAT
polypeptide (agonists) or prevent the effect of the TAT polypeptide
(antagonists). Screening assays for antagonist
drug candidates are designed to identify compounds that bind or complex with
the TAT polypeptides encoded by
the genes identified herein, or otherwise interfere with the interaction of
the encoded polypeptides with other
cellular proteins, including e.g., inhibiting the expression of TAT
polypeptide from cells. Such screening assays
will include assays amenable to high-throughput screening of chemical
libraries, making them particularly suitable
for identifying small molecule drug candidates.
The assays can be performed in a variety of formats, including protein-protein
binding assays,
biochemical screening assays, immunoassays, and cell-based assays, which are
well characterized in the art.
All assays for antagonists are common in that they call for contacting the
drug candidate with a TAT
polypeptide encoded by a nucleic acid identified herein under conditions and
for a time sufficient to allow these
two components to interact.
In binding assays, the interaction is binding and the complex formed can be
isolated or detected in the
reaction mixture. In a particular embodiment, the TAT polypeptide encoded by
the gene identified herein or the
drug candidate is immobilized on a solid phase, e.g., on a microtiter plate,
by covalent or non-covalent attachments.
Non-covalent attachment generally is accomplished by coating the solid surface
with a solution of the TAT
polypeptide and drying. Alternatively, an in-tnobilized antibody, e.g.,
amonoclonal antibody, specific for the TAT
polypeptide to be immobilized can be used to anchor it to a solid surface. The
assay is performed by adding the
non-immobilized component, which may be labeled by a detectable label, to the
immobilized component, e.g., the
coated surface containing the anchored component. When the reaction is
complete, the non-reacted components
are removed, e.g., by washing, and complexes anchored on the solid surface are
detected. When the originally non-
immobilized component carries a detectable label, the detection of label
immobilized on the surface indicates that
complexing occurred. Where the originally non-immobilized component does not
carry a label, complexing can
be detected, for example, by using a labeled antibody specifically binding the
immobilized complex.
If the candidate compound interacts with but does not bind to a particular TAT
polypeptide encoded by
a gene identified herein, its interaction with that polypeptide can be assayed
by methods well known for detecting
protein-protein interactions. Such assays include traditional approaches, such
as, e.g., cross-linking, co-
immunoprecipitation, and co-purification through gradients or chromatographic
columns. In addition, protein-
protein interactions can be monitored by using a yeast-based genetic system
described by Fields and co-workers
(Fields and Song, Nature (London), 340:245-246 (1989); Chien et al., Proc.
Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 88:9578-9582
(1991)) as disclosed by Chevray and Nathans, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 89:
5789-5793 (1991). Many
transcriptional activators, such as yeast GAL4, consist of two physically
discrete modular domains, one acting as
the DNA-binding domain, the other one functioning as the transcription-
activation domain. The yeast expression
system described in the foregoing publications (generally referred to as the
"two-hybrid system") takes advantage
of this property, and employs two hybrid proteins, one in which the target
protein is fused to the DNA-binding
domain of GAIA, and another, in which candidate activating proteins are fused
to the activation domain. The
expression of a GALl-lacZ reporter gene under control of a GAL4-activated
promoter depends on reconstitution
107


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
of GAL4 activity via protein-protein interaction. Colonies containing
interacting polypeptides are detected with
a chromogenic substrate for (3-galactosidase. A complete kit (MATCHMAKERT"')
for identifying protein-protein
interactions between two specific proteins using the two-hybrid technique is
commercially available from Clontech.
This system can also be extended to map protein domains involved in specific
protein interactions as well as to
pinpoint amino acid residues that are crucial for these interactions.
Compounds that interfere with the interaction of a gene encoding a TAT
polypeptide identified herein
and other intra- or extracellular components can be tested as follows: usually
a reaction mixture is prepared
containing the product of the gene and the intra- or extracellular component
under conditions and for a time
allowing for the interaction and binding of the two products. To test the
ability of a candidate compound to inhibit
binding, the reaction is run in the absence and in the presence of the test
compound. In addition, a placebo may
be added to a third reaction mixture, to serve as positive control. The
binding (complex formation) between the
test compound and the intra- or extracellular component present in the mixture
is monitored as described
hereinabove. The formation of a complex in the control reaction(s) but not in
the reaction mixture containing the
test compound indicates that the test compound interferes with the interaction
of the test compound and its reaction
partner.
To assay for antagonists, the TAT polypeptide may be added to a cell along
with the compound to be
screened for a particular activity and the ability of the compound to inhibit
the activity of interest in the presence
of the TAT polypeptide indicates that the compound is an antagonist to the TAT
polypeptide. Alternatively,
antagonists may be detected by combining the TAT polypeptide and a potential
antagonist with membrane-bound
TAT polypeptide receptors or recombinant receptors under appropriate
conditions for a competitive inhibition
assay. The TAT polypeptide can be labeled, such as by radioactivity, such that
the number of TAT polypeptide
molecules bound to the receptor can be used to determine the effectiveness of
the potential antagonist. The gene
encoding the receptor can be identified by numerous methods known to those of
skill in the art, for example, ligand
panning and FACS sorting. Coligan et al., Current Protocols in Immun., 1(2):
Chapter 5 (1991). Preferably,
expression cloning is employed wherein polyadenylated RNA is prepared from a
cell responsive to the TAT
polypeptide and a cDNA library created from this RNA is divided into pools and
used to transfect COS cells or
other cells that are not responsive to the TAT polypeptide. Transfected cells
that are grown on glass slides are
exposed to labeled TAT polypeptide. The TAT polypeptide can be labeled by a
variety of means including
iodination or inclusion of a recognition site for a site-specific protein
kinase. Following fixation and incubation,
the slides are subjected to autoradiographic analysis. Positive pools are
identified and sub-pools are prepared and
re-transfected using an interactive sub-pooling and re-screening process,
eventually yielding a single clone that
encodes the putative receptor.
As an alternative approach for receptor identification, labeled TAT
polypeptide can be photoaffinity-
linked with cell membrane or extract preparations that express the receptor
molecule. Cross-linked material is
resolved by PAGE and exposed to X-ray fihn. The labeled complex containing the
receptor can be excised,
resolved into peptide fragments, and subjected to protein micro-sequencing.
The amino acid sequence obtained
from micro- sequencing would be used to design a set of degenerate
oligonucleotide probes to screen a cDNA
library to identify the gene encoding the putative receptor.

108


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
In another assay for antagonists, mammalian cells or a membrane preparation
expressing the receptor
would be incubated with labeled TAT polypeptide in the presence of the
candidate compound. The ability of the
compound to enhance or block this interaction could then be measured.
More specific examples of potential antagonists include an oligonucleotide
that binds to the fusions of
immunoglobulin with TAT polypeptide, and, in particular, antibodies including,
without limitation, poly- and
monoclonal antibodies and antibody fragments, single-chain antibodies, anti-
idiotypic antibodies, and chimeric
or humanized versions of such antibodies or fragments, as well as human
antibodies and antibody fragments.
Alternatively, a potential antagonist may be a closely related protein, for
example, a mutated form of the TAT
polypeptide that recognizes the receptor but imparts no effect, thereby
competitively inhibiting the action of the
TAT polypeptide.
Another potential TAT polypeptide antagonist is an antisense RNA or DNA
construct prepared using
antisense technology, wliere, e.g., an antisense RNA or DNA molecule acts to
block directly the translation of
mRNA by hybridizing to targeted mRNA and preventing protein translation.
Antisense technology can be used
to control gene expression through triple-helix formation or antisense DNA or
RNA, both of which methods are
based on binding of a polynucleotide to DNA or RNA. For example, the 5' coding
portion of the polynucleotide
sequence, which encodes the mature TAT polypeptides herein, is used to design
an antisense RNA oligonucleotide
of from about 10 to 40 base pairs in lengtli. A DNA oligonucleotide is
designed to be complementary to a region
of the gene involved in transcription (triple helix - see Lee et al., Nucl.
Acids Res., 6:3073 (1979); Cooney et al.,
Science, 241: 456 (1988); Dervan et al., Science, 251:1360 (1991)), thereby
preventing transcription and the
production of the TAT polypeptide. The antisense RNA oligonucleotide
hybridizes to the mRNA in vivo and
blocks translation of the mRNA molecule into the TAT polypeptide (antisense -
Okano, Neurochen-L, 56:560
(1991); Oligodeoxynucleotides as Antisense Inhibitors of Gene Expression (CRC
Press: Boca Raton, FL, 1988).
The oligonucleotides described above can also be delivered to cells such that
the antisense RNA or DNA may be
expressed in vivo to inhibit production of the TAT polypeptide. When antisense
DNA is used,
oligodeoxyribonucleotides derived from the translation-initiation site, e.g.,
between about -10 and +10 positions
of the target gene nucleotide sequence, are preferred.
Potential antagonists include small molecules that bind to the active site,
the receptor binding site, or
growth factor or other relevant binding site of the TAT polypeptide, thereby
blocking the normal biological activity
of the TAT polypeptide. Examples of small molecules include, but are not
limited to, small peptides or peptide-
like molecules, preferably soluble peptides, and synthetic non-peptidyl
organic or inorganic compounds.
Ribozymes are enzymatic RNA molecules capable of catalyzing the specific
cleavage of RNA.
Ribozymes act by sequence-specific hybridization to the complementary target
RNA, followed by endonucleolytic
cleavage. Specific ribozyme cleavage sites within a potential RNA target can
be identified by known techniques.
For further details see, e.g., Rossi, Current Biology, 4:469-471 (1994), and
PCT publication No. WO 97/33551
(published September 18, 1997).
Nucleic acid molecules in triple-helix formation used to inhibit transcription
should be single-stranded
and composed of deoxynucleotides. The base composition of these
oligonucleotides is designed such that it
promotes triple-helix formation via Hoogsteen base-pairing rules, which
generally require sizeable stretches of
purines or pyrimidines on one strand of a duplex. For further details see,
e.g., PCT publication No. WO 97/33551,
109


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
supra.
These small molecules can be identified by any one or more of the screening
assays discussed hereinabove
and/or by any other screening techniques well known for those skilled in the
art.
Isolated TAT polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid can be used herein for
recombinantly producing TAT
polypeptide using techniques well known in the art and as described herein. In
turn, the produced TAT
polypeptides can be employed for generating anti-TAT antibodies using
techniques well known in the art and as
described herein.
Antibodies specifically binding a TAT polypeptide identified herein, as well
as other molecules identified
by the screening assays disclosed hereinbefore, can be administered for the
treatment of various disorders,
including cancer, in the form of pharmaceutical compositions.
If the TAT polypeptide is intracellular and whole antibodies are used as
inhibitors, internalizing
antibodies are preferred. However, lipofections or liposomes can also be used
to deliver the antibody, or an
antibody fragment, into cells. Where antibody fragments are used, the smallest
inhibitory fragment that specifically
binds to the binding domain of the target protein is preferred. For example,
based upon the variable-region
sequences of an antibody, peptide molecules can be designed that retain the
ability to bind the target protein
sequence. Such peptides can be syntllesized chemically and/or produced by
recombinant DNA technology. See,
e.g., Marasco et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 90: 7889-7893 (1993).
The formulation herein may also contain more than one active compound as
necessary for the particular
indication being treated, preferably those with complementary activities that
do not adversely affect each other.
Alternatively, or in addition, the composition may comprise an agent that
enhances its function, such as, for
example, a cytotoxic agent, cytolcine, chemotherapeutic agent, or growth-
inhibitory agent. Such molecules are
suitably present in combination in amounts that are effective for the purpose
intended.
The following examples are offered for illustrative purposes only, and are not
intended to limit the scope
of the present invention in any way.
All patent and literature references cited in the present specification are
liereby incorporated by reference
in their entirety.

EXAMPLES
Commercially available reagents referred to in the examples were used
according to manufacturer's
instructions unless otherwise indicated. The source of those cells identified
in the following examples, and
throughout the specification, by ATCC accession numbers is the American Type
Culture Collection, Manassas,
VA.

EXAMPLE 1: Tissue Expression Profiling Using GeneExpress
A proprietary database containing gene expression information (GeneExpress ,
Gene Logic Inc.,
Gaithersburg, MD) was analyzed in an attempt to identify polypeptides (and
their encoding nucleic acids) whose
expression is significantly and detectably upregulated in a particular human
tumor tissue(s) of interest as compared
to other human tumor(s) and/or normal human tissues. Specifically, analysis of
the GeneExpress database was
conducted using either software available through Gene Logic Inc.,
Gaithersburg, MD, for use with the
110


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
GeneExpress database or with proprietary software written and developed at
Genentech, Inc. for use with the
GeneExpress database. The rating of positive hits in the analysis is based
upon several criteria including, for
example, tissue specificity, tumor specificity and expression level in normal
essential and/or normal proliferating
tissues. The following molecule(s) exhibit a tissue expression profile showing
high tissue expression and
significant and reproducibly detectable upregulation of expression in a
specific human tumor or tumors as
compared to other human tumor(s) and/or normal human tissues and optionally
relatively low expression in normal
essential and/or normal proliferating human tissues.
Using the expression analysis described above, it was determined that mRNA
encoding the TAT113
polypeptide shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2 is significantly, reproducibly and
detectably overexpressed in certain
types of human cancerous colon and rectal tumors as compared to the
corresponding normal human colon and
rectal tissues, respectively.
A. Colon
In a first experiment, expression of TAT1 13 was analyzed in a group of 237
independent normal human
colon tissue samples. The results of these analyses demonstrated that the
level of TATI 13 mRNA expression in
all of the normal human colon tissue samples analyzed was remarkably
consistent and fell within a very tight
distribution, with no normal human colon tissue sample evidencing greater than
a 2-fold increase in TAT 113
expression as coinpared to the mean level of TAT1 13 expression for the group
of samples as a whole.
For purposes of quantitative comparison, avariety of independent and different
types of cancerous human
colon tissue samples were also analyzed for TAT113 expression. The results
obtained from these analyses
demonstrated that the level of expression of TAT113 in the cancerous samples
was quite variable, with a
significant number of the cancerous samples showing an at least 2-fold (to as
high as an about 16-fold) increase
in TAT113 expression when compared to the mean level of TATI13 expression for
the group of normal colon
tissue samples analyzed. More specifically, detectable and reproducible TAT1
13 overexpression was observed
for the following colon cancer types as compared to normal colon (wherein the
numbers shown in parentheses for
each cancer type represent the number of independent samples that exhibited at
least a 2-fold increase in TAT 113
expression when compared to the mean level of TAT113 expression for the group
of normal colon tissue samples
analyzed/the total number of independent tumor samples analyzed): colon
adenocarcinoma of unspecified location
(4/9), adenocarcinoma of the cecum and right ascending colon (25/35),
adenocarcinoma of the transverse colon
(5/6) and adenocarcinoma of the left descending colon and sigmoid (21/34).
Additional experiments were
conducted which confirmed these results.
B. Rectum
In another experiment, expression of TAT1 13 was analyzed in a group of 46
independent normal human
rectum tissue samples. The results of these analyses demonstrated that the
level of TAT113 mRNA expression
in all of the normal human rectum tissue samples analyzed was remarkably
consistent and fell within a very tight
distribution, with no normal human rectum tissue sample evidencing greater
than a 2-fold increase in TAT113
expression as compared to the mean level of TAT1 13 expression for the group
of samples as a whole.
For purposes of quantitative comparison, 25 independent human rectal
adenocarcinoma tissue samples
were also analyzed for TAT1 13 expression. The results obtained from these
analyses demonstrated that the level
of expression of TAT1 13 in the cancerous samples was quite variable, with 15
of the 25 samples tested showing
111


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
at least a 2-fold (to as high as an about 13-fold) increase in TAT113
expression when compared to the mean level
of TAT1 13 expression for the group of normal rectum tissue samples analyzed.
Given the above, the TAT 113 polypeptide shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2, and the
nucleic acid encoding
that polypeptide, are excellent targets which can be exploited for
quantitatively and qualitatively determining the
expression level of the TAT1 13 polypeptide shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2, and
the mRNA encoding it, in various
mammalian tissue samples, thereby allowing one to make quantitative and
qualitative comparisons therebetween.
Therefore, the TAT113 polypeptide shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2, and the nucleic
acid encoding that
polypeptide, are molecules whose unique expression profile can be exploited
for the diagnosis of certain types of
cancerous tumors in mammals as described above. Moreover, as this analysis
demonstrates that the TAT113
polypeptide is significantly, reproducibly and detectably overexpressed in
certain human tumors as compared to
their corresponding normal human tissues, the TAT113 polypeptide serves as an
excellent target that can be
exploited for the therapeutic treatment of such tumors in mammals.

EXAMPLE 2: Microarray Analysis to Detect Uprenlation of TAT Polypeptides in
Cancerous Tumors
Nucleic acid microarrays, often containing thousands of gene sequences, are
useful for identifying
differentially expressed genes in diseased tissues as compared to their normal
counterparts. Using nucleic acid
microarrays, test and control mRNA samples from test and control tissue
samples are reverse transcribed and
labeled to generate cDNA probes. The cDNA probes are then hybridized to an
array of nucleic acids immobilized
on a solid support. The array is configured such that the sequence and
position of each member of the array is
known. For example, a selection of genes known to be expressed in certain
disease states may be arrayed on a
solid support. Hybridization of a labeled probe with a particular array member
indicates that the sample from
which the probe was derived expresses that gene. If the hybridization signal
of a probe from a test (disease tissue)
sample is greater than hybridization signal of a probe from a control (normal
tissue) sample, the gene or genes
overexpressed in the disease tissue are identified. The implication of this
result is that an overexpressed protein
in a diseased tissue is useful not only as a diagnostic marker for the
presence of the disease condition, but also as
a therapeutic target for treatment of the disease condition.
The methodology of hybridization of nucleic acids and microarray technology is
well known in the art.
In the present example, the specific preparation of nucleic acids for
hybridization and probes, slides, and
hybridization conditions are all detailed in PCT Patent Application Serial No.
PCT/US01/10482, filed on March
30, 2001 and which is herein incorporated by reference.
In the present example, cancerous tumors derived from various human tissues
were studied for
upregulated gene expression relative to cancerous tumors from different tissue
types and/or non-cancerous human
tissues in an attempt to identify those polypeptides which are overexpressed
in a particular cancerous tumor(s).
In certain experiments, cancerous human tumor tissue and non-cancerous human
tumor tissue of the same tissue
type (often from the same patient) were obtained and analyzed for TAT
polypeptide expression. Additionally,
cancerous human tumor tissue from any of a variety of different human tumors
was obtained and compared to a
"universal" epithelial control sample which was prepared by pooling non-
cancerous human tissues of epithelial
origin, including liver, kidney, and lung. mRNA isolated from the pooled
epithelial tissues represents a mixture
of expressed gene products fromvarious different epithelial tissues, thereby
providing an excellent negative control
112


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
against which to quantitatively compare gene expression levels in tumors of
epithelial origin. Microarray
hybridization experiments using the pooled control samples generated a linear
plot in a 2-color analysis. The slope
of the line generated in a 2-color analysis was then used to normalize the
ratios of (test:control detection) within
each experiment. The normalized ratios from various experiments were then
compared and used to identify
clustering of gene expression. Thus, the pooled "universal control" sample not
only allowed effective relative gene
expression determinations in a simple 2-sample comparison, it also allowed
multi-sample comparisons across
several experiments.
In the present experiments, nucleic acid probes derived from the herein
described TAT polypeptide-
encoding nucleic acid sequences were used in the creation of the microarray
and RNA from various tumor tissues
were used for the hybridization thereto. A value based upon the normalized
ratio:experimental ratio was
designated as a "cutoff ratio". Only values that were above this cutoff ratio
were determined to be significant.
Significance of ratios were estimated from the amount of noise or scatter
associated with each experiment, but
typically, a ratio cutoff of 1.8 fold - 2 fold or greater was used to identify
candidate genes relatively overexpressed
in tumor samples compared to the corresponding normal tissue and/or the pooled
normal epithelial universal
control. Ratios for genes identified in this way as being relatively
overexpressed in tumor samples varied from
2 fold to 40 fold, or even greater. By comparison, in a control experiment in
which the same RNA was labeled
in each color and hybridized against itself, for virtually all genes with
signals above background, the observed ratio
is significantly less than 1.8 fold. This indicates that experimental noise
above a ratio of 1.8 fold is extremely low,
and that an observed fold change of 1.8 fold or greater is significant and is
expected to represent a real, detectably
and reporducible difference in expression between the samples analyzed and
compared.
The results of these experiments demonstrated that mRNA encoding the TAT1 13
polypeptide shown in
the present application as SEQ ID NO:2 is significantly overexpressed (i.e.,
at least 2-fold) in greater than 50%
of the 75 independent human colon tumor samples tested when compared to both
normal human colon tissue and
the pooled epithelial control sample. These data also demonstrate that the
observed overexpression is significant,
detectable and reproducible across multiple human colon tumor samples when
compared to both normal
counterpart human colon samples as well as the pooled human epithelial control
sample. As described above, these
data demonstrate that the TAT113 polypeptide of the present invention, and the
encoding nucleic acid, are useful
not only as diagnostic markers for the presence of human colon tumors, but
also serve as potential therapeutic
targets for the treatment of those tumors in humans.

EXAMPLE 3: Ouantitative Analysis of TAT mRNA Expression
In this assay, a 5' nuclease assay (for example, TaqMan ) and real-time
quantitative PCR (for example,
ABI Prizm 7700 Sequence Detection System (Perkin Elmer, Applied Biosystems
Division, Foster City, CA)),
were used to find genes that are significantly overexpressed in a cancerous
tumor or tumors as compared to other
cancerous tumors or normal non-cancerous tissue. The 5' nuclease assay
reaction is a fluorescent PCR-based
technique which makes use of the 5' exonuclease activity of Taq DNA polymerase
enzyme to monitor gene
expression in real time. Two oligonucleotide primers (whose sequences are
based upon the gene or EST sequence
of interest) are used to generate an amplicon typical of a PCR reaction. A
third oligonucleotide, or probe, is
designed to detect nucleotide sequence located between the two PCR primers.
The probe is non-extendible by Taq
113


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
DNA polymerase enzyme, and is labeled with a reporter fluorescent dye and a
quencher fluorescent dye. Any
laser-induced emission from the reporter dye is quenched by the quenching dye
when the two dyes are located
close together as they are on the probe. During the PCR amplification
reaction, the Taq DNA polymerase enzyme
cleaves the probe in a template-dependent manner. The resultant probe
fragments disassociate in solution, and
signal from the released reporter dye is free from the quenching effect of the
second fluorophore. One molecule
of reporter dye is liberated for each new molecule synthesized, and detection
of the unquenched reporter dye
provides the basis for quantitative and quantitative interpretation of the
data. This assay is well known and
routinely used in the art to quantitatively identify gene expression
differences between two different human tissue
samples, see, e.g., Higuchi et al., Biotechnology 10:413-417 (1992); Livak et
al., PCR Methods Appl., 4:357-362
(1995); Heid et al., Genome Res. 6:986-994 (1996); Pennica et al., Proc. Natl.
Acad. Sci. USA
95(25):14717-14722 (1998); Pitti et al., Nature 396(6712):699-703 (1998) and
Biectie et al., Int. J. Cancer
78:661-666 (1998).
The 5' nuclease procedure is run on a real-time quantitative PCR device such
as the ABI Prism 7700TM
Sequence Detection. The system consists of a thermocycler, laser, charge-
coupled device (CCD) camera and
computer. The system amplifies samples in a 96-well format on a thermocycler.
During amplification,
laser-induced fluorescent signal is collected in real-time through fiber
optics cables for al196 wells, and detected
at the CCD. The system includes software for running the instrument and for
analyzing the data.
The starting material for the screen was mRNA isolated from a variety of
different cancerous tissues. The
mRNA is quantitated precisely, e.g., fluorometrically. As a negative control,
RNA was isolated from various
normal tissues of the same tissue type as the cancerous tissues being tested.
Frequently, tumor sample(s) are
directly compared to "matched" normal sample(s) of the same tissue type,
meaning that the tumor and normal
sample(s) are obtained from the same individual.
5' nuclease assay data are initially expressed as Ct, or the threshold cycle.
This is defined as the cycle
at which the reporter signal accumulates above the background level of
fluorescence. The ACt values are used
as quantitative measurement of the relative number of starting copies of a
particular target sequence in a nucleic
acid sample when comparing cancer mRNA results to normal human mRNA results.
As one Ct unit corresponds
to 1 PCR cycle or approximately a 2-fold relative increase relative to normal,
two units corresponds to a 4-fold
relative increase, 3 units corresponds to an 8-fold relative increase and so
on, one can quantitatively and
quantitatively measure the relative fold increase in mRNA expression between
two or more different tissues. In
this regard, it is well accepted in the art that this assay is sufficiently
technically sensitive to reproducibly detect
an at least 2-fold increase in mRNA expression in a human tumor sample
relative to a normal control.
Using this technique, it was determined that mRNA encoding the TAT113
polypeptide shown in the
present application as SEQ ID NO:2 is significantly and reproducibly
overexpressed (i.e., at least 2 fold) in a119
of 9 independent human colon tumor samples when compared to both normal human
colon samples from different
human tissue donors as well as various "matched" normal human colon tumor
samples derived from the same
human tissue donor as from which the tumor sample(s) was derived. As described
above, therefore, these data
demonstrate that the TAT1 13 polypeptide of the present invention, and the
encoding nucleic acid, are useful not
only as diagnostic markers for the presence of human colon tumors, but also
serve as potential therapeutic targets
for the treatment of those tumors in humans.

114


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
EXAMPLE 4: In situ Hybridization
In situ hybridization is a powerful and versatile technique for the detection
and localization of nucleic acid
sequences within cell or tissue preparations. It may be useful, for example,
to identify sites of gene expression,
analyze the tissue distribution of transcription, identify and localize viral
infection, follow changes in specific
mRNA synthesis and aid in chromosome mapping.
In situ hybridization was performed following an optimized version of the
protocol by Lu and Gillett, Cell
Vision 1:169-176 (1994), using PCR-generated 33P-labeled riboprobes. Briefly,
formalin-fixed, paraffin-
embedded human tissues were sectioned, deparaffinized, deproteinated in
proteinase K (20 g/ml) for 15 minutes
at 37 C, and further processed for in situ hybridization as described by Lu
and Gillett, supra. A[33-P] UTP-
labeled antisense riboprobe was generated from a PCR product and hybridized at
55 C overnight. The slides were
dipped in Kodak NTB2 nuclear track emulsion and exposed for 4 weeks.
33P-Riboprobe synthesis
6.0 l (125 mCi) of 33P-UTP (Amersham BF 1002, SA<2000 Cilmmol) were speed vac
dried. To each
tube containing dried 33P-UTP, the following ingredients were added:
2.0 15x transcription buffer
1.0 1DTT(100mM)
2.0 41 NTP mix (2.5 mM : 10 ; each of 10 mM GTP, CTP & ATP + 10 41 H20)
1.0 l UTP (50 M)
1.0 l Rnasin
1.0 l DNA template (1 g)
1.0 l H2O
1.0 l RNA polymerase (for PCR products T3 = AS, T7 = S, usually)
The tubes were incubated at 37 C for one hour. 1.0 l RQ1 DNase were added,
followed by incubation
at 37 C for 15 minutes. 90 l TE (10 mM Tris pH 7.6/1mM EDTA pH 8.0) were
added, and the mixture was
pipetted onto DE81 paper. The remaining solution was loaded in aMicrocon-50
ultrafiltration unit, and spun using
program 10 (6 minutes). The filtration unit was inverted over a second tube
and spun using program 2(3 minutes).
After the final recovery spin, 100 l TE were added. 1 l of the final product
was pipetted on DE81 paper and
counted in 6 ml of Biofluor II.
The probe was run on a TBE/urea gel. 1-3 l of the probe or 5 l of RNA Mrk
III were added to 3 41
of loading buffer. After heating on a 95 C heat block for three minutes, the
probe was immediately placed on ice.
The wells of gel were flushed, the sample loaded, and run at 180-250 volts for
45 minutes. The gel was wrapped
in saran wrap and exposed to XAR film with an intensifying screen in -70 C
freezer one hour to overnight.
33P-Hybridization
A. Pretreatment of frozen sections
The slides were removed from the freezer, placed on aluminium trays and thawed
at room temperature
for 5 minutes. The trays were placed in 55 C incubator for five minutes to
reduce condensation. The slides were
fixed for 10 minutes in 4% paraformaldehyde on ice in the fume hood, and
washed in 0.5 x SSC for 5 minutes, at
room temperature (25 m120 x SSC + 975 ml SQ HZO). After deproteination in 0.5
g/ml proteinase K for 10
minutes at 37 C (12.5 l of 10 mg/mi stock in 250 ml prewarmed RNase-free
RNAse buffer), the sections were
115


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
washed in 0.5 x SSC for 10 minutes at room temperature. The sections were
dehydrated in 70%, 95%, 100%
ethanol, 2 minutes each.
B. Pretreatment of paraffin-embedded sections
The slides were deparaffinized, placed in SQ H20, and rinsed twice in 2 x SSC
at room temperature, for
minutes each time. The sections were deproteinated in 20 g/ml proteinase K
(500 l of 10 mg/ml in 250 ml
5 RNase-free RNase buffer; 37 C,15 minutes) - human embryo, or 8 x proteinase
K (100 l in 250 ml Rnase buffer,
37 C, 30 minutes) - formalin tissues. Subsequent rinsing in 0.5 x SSC and
dehydration were performed as
described above.
C. Prehybridization
The slides were laid out in a plastic box lined with Box buffer (4 x SSC, 50%
formamide) - saturated filter
paper.
D. Hybridization
1.0 x 106 cpm probe and 1.0 l tRNA (50 mg/mi stock) per slide were heated at
95 C for 3 minutes. The
slides were cooled on ice, and 48 l hybridization buffer were added per
slide. After vortexing, 50 133P mix were
added to 50 l prehybridization on slide. The slides were incubated overnight
at 55 C.
E. Washes
Washing was done 2 x 10 minutes with 2xSSC, EDTA at room temperature (400 m120
x SSC + 16 ml
0.25M EDTA, Vf=4L), followed by RNaseA treatment at 37 C for 30 minutes (500
l of 10 mg/nzl in 250 ml
Rnase buffer = 20 g/ml), The slides were washed 2 x 10 minutes with 2 x SSC,
EDTA at room temperature. The
stringency wash conditions were as follows: 2 hours at 55 C, 0.1 x SSC, EDTA
(20 m120 x SSC + 16 ml EDTA,
VF4L).
F. Oligonucleotides
Ifa situ analysis was performed on a variety of DNA sequences disclosed
herein. The oligonucleotides
employed for these analyses were obtained so as to be complementary to the
nucleic acids (or the complements
thereof) as shown in the accompanying figures.
G. Results
In situ hybridization analyses were performed on the nucleic acid encoding the
TAT113 polypeptide
shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2. The results of these analyses showed strong
expression of the TAT113 gene in
10/22 independent primary human colon cancer samples and 6/9 independent
metastatic colon cancer samples
analyzed. To the contrary, no detectable expression (or significantly lower
expression) of TAT1 13 was observed
in all normal colon tissue samples analyzed.

EXAMPLE 5: Verification and Analysis of Differential TAT Polypeptide
Expression by GEPIS
TAT polypeptides which may have been identified as a tumor antigen as
described in one or more of the
above Examples were analyzed and verified as follows. An expressed sequence
tag (EST) DNA database
(LIFESEQ , Incyte Pharmaceuticals, Palo Alto, CA) was searched and interesting
EST sequences were identified
by GEPIS. Gene expression profiling itz silico (GEPIS) is a bioinformatics
tool developed at Genentech, Inc. that
characterizes genes of interest for new cancer therapeutic targets. GEPIS
takes advantage of large amounts of EST
sequence and library information to determine gene expression profiles. GEPIS
is capable of determining the
116


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
expression profile of a gene based upon its proportional correlation with the
number of its occurrences in EST
databases, and it works by integrating the LIFESEQ EST relational database
and Genentech proprietary
information in a stringent and statistically meaningful way. In this example,
GEPIS is used to identify and
cross-validate novel tumor antigens, although GEPIS can be configured to
perform either very specific analyses
or broad screening tasks. For the initial screen, GEPIS is used to identify
EST sequences from the LIFESEQ
database that correlate to expression in a particular tissue or tissues of
interest (often a tumor tissue of interest).
The EST sequences identified in this initial screen (or consensus sequences
obtained from aligning multiple related
and overlapping EST sequences obtained from the initial screen) were then
subjected to a screen intended to
identify the presence of at least one transmembrane domain in the encoded
protein. Finally, GEPIS was employed
to generate a complete tissue expression profile for the various sequences of
interest. Using this type of screening
bioinformatics, various TAT polypeptides (and their encoding nucleic acid
molecules) were identified as being
significantly overexpressed in a particular type of cancer or certain cancers
as compared to other cancers and/or
normal non-cancerous tissues. The rating of GEPIS hits is based upon several
criteria including, for example,
tissue specificity, tumor specificity and expression level in normal essential
and/or normal proliferating tissues.
Using the GEPIS expression analysis described above, it was determined that
niRNA encoding the
TAT113 polypeptide shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2 is significantly, reproducibly
and detectably overexpressed
in human colon tumor samples as compared to the corresponding normal colon
tissue. As such, the TAT113
polypeptide shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2, and the nucleic acid encoding that
polypeptide, are excellent targets
which can be exploited for quantitatively and qualitatively determining the
expression level of the TAT113
polypeptide shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2, and the mRNA encoding it, in various
mammalian tissue samples,
thereby allowing one to make quantitative and qualitative comparisons
therebetween. Therefore, the TAT113
polypeptide shown herein as SEQ ID NO:2, and the nucleic acid encoding that
polypeptide, are excellent targets
which can be exploited for the diagnosis of tumor in mammals. Moreover, as
this analysis demonstrates that the
TAT113 polypeptide is significantly, reproducibly and detectably overexpressed
in certain human tumors as
compared to their corresponding normal human tissues, the TAT113 polypeptide
serves as an excellent target ttiat
can be exploited for the therapeutic treatment of such tumors in mammals.

EXAMPLE 6: Prenaration of Antibodies that Bind TAT113
Techniques for producing monoclonal antibodies are known in the art and are
described, for instance, in
Goding, supra Immunogens that may be employed include purified TAT
polypeptides, fusion proteins containing
TAT polypeptides, and cells expressing recombinant TAT polypeptides on the
cell surface. Selection of the
immunogen can be made by the skilled artisan without undue experimentation.
Mice, such as Balb/c, are immunized with the TAT immunogen emulsified in
complete Freund's adjuvant
and injected subcutaneously or intraperitoneally in an amount from 1-100
micrograms. Alternatively, the
immunogen is emulsified in MPL-TDM adjuvant (Ribi Immunochemical Research,
Hamilton, MT) and injected
into the animal's hind foot pads. The immunized mice are then boosted 10 to 12
days later with additional
immunogen emulsified in the selected adjuvant. Thereafter, for several weeks,
the mice may also be boosted with
additional immunization injections. Serum samples may be periodically obtained
from the mice by retro-orbital
bleeding for testing in ELISA assays to detect anti-TAT antibodies.

117


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
After a suitable antibody titer has been detected, the animals "positive" for
antibodies can be injected
with a final intravenous injection of TAT. Three to four days later, the mice
are sacrificed and the spleen cells are
harvested. The spleen cells are then fused (using 35% polyethylene glycol) to
a selected murine myeloma cell line
such as P3X63AgU.1, available from ATCC, No. CRL 1597. The fusions generate
hybridoma cells which can
then be plated in 96 well tissue culture plates containing HAT (hypoxanthine,
aminopterin, and thymidine) medium
to inhibit proliferation of non-fused cells, myeloma hybrids, and spleen cell
hybrids.
The hybridoma cells are screened in an ELISA for reactivity against TAT.
Determination of "positive"
hybridoma cells secreting the desired monoclonal antibodies against TAT is
within the skill in the art.
The positive hybridoma cells can be injected intraperitoneally into syngeneic
Balb/c mice to produce
ascites containing the anti-TAT monoclonal antibodies. Alternatively, the
hybridoma cells can be grown in tissue
culture flasks or roller bottles. Purification of the monoclonal antibodies
produced in the ascites can be
accomplished using ammonium sulfate precipitation, followed by gel exclusion
chromatography. Alternatively,
affinity chromatography based upon binding of antibody to protein A or protein
G can be employed.
Using the above described technique, 12 separate and distinct hybridoma cell
lines have been generated,
each of which produce monoclonal antibodies that bind to the TAT113
polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2.
These 12 hybridoma cell lines are herein referred to as 12E5. 1.1 (producing
monoclonal antibody 12E5), 6G10.1.1
(producing monoclonal antibody 6G10),17C12.7.8 (producing monoclonal antibody
17C12),1B5.1.3 (producing
monoclonal antibody 1B5),
6H10.3.11(producingmonoclonalantibody6H10),17H5.25.1(producingmonoclonal
antibody 17H5), 15B6.4.1 (producing monoclonal antibody 15B6), 11A12.3.2
(producing monoclonal antibody
11A12), 13A7.1.8 (producing monoclonal antibody 13A7), 4D1.1.2.1 (producing
monoclonal antibody 4D1),
14A3.1.1(producing monoclonal antibody 14A3) and 1OF11.11.11.11 (producing
monoclonal antibody 1OF11).
The monoclonal antibodies produced by these 12 hybridoma lines liave been
shown to bind to the TAT1 13
polypeptide shown as SEQ ID NO:2 using well-known and routinely employed
techniques such as Western blot,
ELISA analysis, FACS sorting analysis of cells expressing the TAT 113
polypeptide and/or immunohistochemistry
analysis. Of the 12 hybridoma lines that produce functional anti-TAT113
monoclonal antibodies, two (hybridoma
clones 12E5.1.1 and 6G10.1.1) have been deposited under the terms of the
Budapest Treaty with the American
Tissue Type Collection, Manassas, VA as described in fiuther detail below.

EXAMPLE 7: Competitive Binding Analyses and Epitope Mappin~
The TAT113 epitopes bound by the monoclonal antibodies described were
determined by standard
competitive binding analysis (Fendly et al., Cancer Research 50:1550-1558
(1990)). Cross-blocking studies were
done on antibodies by direct fluorescence on intact PC3 cells engineered to
express TAT113 using the PANDEXTM
Screen Machine to quantitate fluorescence. Each monoclonal antibody was
conjugated with fluorescein
isothiocyanate (FITC), using established procedures (Wofsy et al., Selected
Methods in Cellular Immunology, p.
287, Mishel and Schiigi (eds.) San Francisco: W.J. Freeman Co. (1980)).
Confluent monolayers of TAT113-
expressing PC3 cells were trypsinized, washed once, and resuspended at 1.75 x
106 celllml in cold PBS containing
0.5% bovine serum albumin (BSA) and 0.1% NaN3. A final concentration of 1%
latex particles (IDC, Portland,
OR) was added to reduce clogging of the PANDEXTM plate membranes. Cells in
suspension, 20 l, and 20 l
of purified monoclonal antibodies (100 g/ml to 0.1 g/ml) were added to the
PANDEXTM plate wells and
118


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
incubated on ice for 30 minutes. A predetermined dilution of FITC-labeled
monoclonal antibodies in 20 l was
added to each well, incubated for 30 minutes, washed, and the fluorescence was
quantitated by the PANDEXTM
Screen Machine. Monoclonal antibodies were considered to share an epitope if
each blocked binding of the other
by 40% or greater in comparison to an irrelevant monoclonal antibody control
and at the same antibody
concentration. In this experiment, monoclonal antibodies 12E5, 17C12, 1B5,
6H10, 17H5,15B6, 11A12, 13A7,
4D1, 14A3 and 10F11 were assigned TAT113 epitopes B, A, D, E, F, A, B, A, A, A
and C, respectively. Using
this assay, one of ordinary skill in the art can identify other monoclonal
antibodies that bind to the same epitope
as those described above.

EXAMPLE 8: Preparation of Toxin-Conjugated Antibodies that Bind TAT113
The use of antibody-drug conjugates (ADC), i.e. immunoconjugates, for the
local delivery of cytotoxic
or cytostatic agents, i.e. drugs to kill or inhibit tumor cells in the
treatment of cancer (Payne (2003) Cancer Cell
3:207-212; Syrigos and Epenetos (1999) Anticancer Research 19:605-614;
Niculescu-Duvaz and Springer (1997)
Adv. Drug Del. Rev. 26:151-172; US 4,975,278) allows targeted delivery of the
drug moiety to tumors, and
intracellular accumulation therein, where systemic administration of these
unconjugated drug agents may result
in unacceptable levels of toxicity to normal cells as well as the tumor cells
sought to be eliminated (Baldwin et al.,
(1986) Lancet (Mar. 15, 1986) pp. 603-05; Thorpe, (1985) "Antibody Carriers Of
Cytotoxic Agents In Cancer
Therapy: A Review," in Monoclonal Antibodies '84: Biological And Clinical
Applications, Pinchera et al. (eds.),
pp. 475-506). Maximal efficacy with minimal toxicity is sought thereby.
Efforts to design and refine ADC have
focused on the selectivity of monoclonal antibodies (mAbs) as well as drug-
linking and drug-releasing properties.
Both polyclonal antibodies and monoclonal antibodies have been reported as
useful in these strategies (Rowland
et al., (1986) Cancer Immunol. Immunother., 21:183-87). Drugs used in these
methods include daunomycin,
doxorubicin, methotrexate, and vindesine (Rowland et al., (1986) supra).
Toxins used in antibody-toxin conjugates
include bacterial toxins such as diphtheria toxin, plant toxins such as ricin,
small molecule toxins such as
geldanamycin (Mandler et al. (2000) J. of the Nat. Cancer Inst. 92(19):1573-
1581; Mandler et al. (2000)
Bioorganic & Med. Chem. Letters 10:1025-1028; Mandler et al. (2002)
Bioconjugate Chem. 13:786-791),
maytansinoids (EP 1391213; Liu et al., (1996) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA
93:8618-8623), and calicheamicin
(Lode et al. (1998) Cancer Res. 58:2928; Hinman et al. (1993) Cancer Res.
53:333(5-3342).
Techniques for producing antibody-drug conjugates by linking toxins to
purified antibodies are well
known and routinely employed in the art. For example, conjugation of a
purified monoclonal antibody to the toxin
DM1 may be accomplished as follows. Purified antibody is derivatized with
N-succinimidyl-4-(2-pyridylthio)pentanoate to introduce dithiopyridyl groups.
Antibody (376.0 mg, 8 mg/mL)
in 44.7 ml of 50 mM potassium phosphate buffer (pH 6.5) containing NaC1(50 mM)
and EDTA (1 mM) is treated
with SPP (5.3 molar equivalents in 2.3 ml ethanol). After incubation for 90
minutes under argon at ambient
temperature, the reaction mixture is gel filtered through a Sephadex G25
column equilibrated with 35 mM sodium
citrate, 154 mM NaCl and 2 mM EDTA. Antibody containing fractions are then
pooled and assayed.
Antibody-SPP-Py (337.0 mg withreleasable 2-thiopyridine groups) is dilutedwith
the above 35 mM sodiumcitrate
buffer, pH 6.5, to a final concentration of 2.5 mg/ml. DM1 (1.7 equivalents,
16.1 mols) in 3.0 mM
dimethylacetamide (DMA, 3% v/v in the final reaction mixture) is then added to
the antibody solution. The
119


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
reaction is allowed to proceed at ambient temperature under argon for 20
hours. The reaction is loaded on a
Sephacryl S300 gel filtration column (5.0 cmx 90.0 em,1.77 L) equilibrated
with 35 mM sodium citrate, 154 mM
NaCl, pH 6.5. The flow rate is 5.0 ml/min and 65 fractions (20.0 ml each) are
collected. Fractions are pooled and
assayed, wherein the number of DM 1 drug molecules linked per antibody
molecule (p') is determined by measuring
the absorbance at 252 nm and 280 nm.
For illustrative purposes, conjugation of a purified monoclonal antibody to
the toxin DMl may also be
accomplished as follows. Purified antibody is derivatized with (Succinimidyl 4-
(N-maleimidomethyl)
cyclohexane-l-carboxylate (SMCC, Pierce Biotechnology, Inc) to introduce the
SMCC linker. The antibody is
treated at 20 mg/ml in 50mM potassium phosphate/ 50 mM sodium chloride/ 2 mM
EDTA, pH 6.5 with 7.5 molar
equivalents of SMCC (20 mM in DMSO, 6.7 mg/ml). After stirring for 2 hours
under argon at ambient
temperature, the reaction mixture is filtered through a Sephadex G25 column
equilibrated with 50mM potassium
phosphate/ 50 mM sodium chloride/ 2 mM EDTA, pH 6.5. Antibody containing
fractions are pooled and assayed.
Antibody-SMCC is then diluted with 50mM potassium phosphate/ 50 mM sodium
chloride/ 2 mM EDTA, pH 6.5,
to a final concentration of 10 mg/ml, and reacted with a 10 mM solution of DMl
(1.7 equivalents assuming 5
SMCC/antibody, 7.37 mg/ml) in dimethylacetaniide. The reaction is stirred at
ambient temperature under argon
16.5 hours. The conjugation reaction mixture is then filtered through a
Sephadex G25 gel filtration column (1.5
x 4.9 cm) with 1 x PB S at pH 6.5. The DM1/antibody ratio (p) is then measured
by the absorbance at 252 nm and
at 280 nm.
Cytotoxic drugs have typically been conjugated to antibodies through the often
numerous lysine residues
of the antibody. Conjugation through thiol groups present, or engineered into,
the antibody of interest has also
been accomplished. For example, cysteine residues have been introduced into
proteins by genetic engineering
techniques to form covalent attachment sites for ligands (Better et al. (1994)
J. Biol. Chem. 13:9644-9650;
Bernhard et al. (1994) BioconiulZate Chem. 5:126-132; Greenwood et al. (1994)
Therapeutic Immunology
1:247-255; Tu et al. (1999) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci USA 96:4862-4867; Kanno et
al. (2000) J. of Biotechnology,
76:207-214; Chmura et al. (2001) Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. USA 98(15):8480-8484;
U.S. Patent No. 6,248,564).
Once a free cysteine residue exists in the antibody of interest, toxins can be
linked to that site. As an example, the
drug linker reagents, maleimidocaproyl-monomethyl auristatin E(MMAE), i.e. MC-
MMAE,
maleimidocaproyl-monomethyl auristatin F (MMAF), i.e. MC-MMAF, MC-val-cit-PAB-
MMAE or
MC-val-cit-PAB-MMAF, dissolved in DMSO, is diluted in acetonitrile and water
at known concentration, and
added to chilled cysteine-derivatized antibody in phosphate buffered saline
(PBS). After about one hour, an excess
of maleimide is added to quench the reaction and cap any unreacted antibody
thiol groups. The reaction mixture
is concentrated by centrifugal ultrafiltration and the toxin conjugated
antibody is purified and desalted by elution
through G25 resin in PBS, filtered through 0.2m filters under sterile
conditions, and frozen for storage.
Moreover, a free cysteine on an antibody of choice may be modified by the bis-
maleimido reagent
BM(PEO)4 (Pierce Chemical), leaving an unreacted maleimido group on the
surface of the antibody. This may
be accomplished by dissolving BM(PEO)4 in a 50% ethanol/water niixture to a
concentration of 10 mM and
adding a tenfold molar excess to a solution containing the antibody in
phosphate buffered saline at a concentration
of approximately 1.6 mg/ml (10 micromolar) and allowing it to react for 1
hour. Excess BM(PEO)4 is removed
by gel filtration in 30 mM citrate, pH 6 with 150 mM NaCI buffer. An
approximate 10 fold molar excess DM1
120


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
is dissolved in dimethyl acetamide (DMA) and added to the antibody-BMPEO
intermediate. Dimethyl formamide
(DMF) may also be employed to dissolve the drug moiety reagent. The reaction
mixture is allowed to react
overnight before gel filtration or dialysis into PBS to remove unreacted drug.
Gel filtration on S200 columns in
PBS is used to remove high molecular weight aggregates and furnish purified
antibody-BMPEO-DM1 conjugate.
Using well known and routinely employed techniques described herein and
elsewhere, anti-TAT113
monoclonal antibody 12E5 (prepared as described in Example 6 above and
deposited with the ATCC as described
below) was conjugated to MC-val-cit-PAB-MMAE. The toxin-conjugated antibody
was purified and is herein
referred to as "12E5-MMAE".

EXAMPLE 9: In Vitro Cell Killing Assays
Mammalian cells expressing the TAT polypeptide of interest may be obtained
using standard expression
vector and cloning techniques. Alternatively, many tumor cell lines expressing
TAT polypeptides of interest are
publicly available, for example, through the ATCC and can be routinely
identified using standard ELISA or FACS
analysis. Anti-TAT polypeptide monoclonal antibodies (and toxin conjugated
derivatives thereof) may then be
employed in assays to determine the ability of the antibody to kill TAT
polypeptide expressing cells in vitro.
With specific regard to the present invention, a PC3-derived cell line that
stably expresses TAT113
polypeptide on its cells surface (herein called PC3-gD-MDP) was engineered
using standard techniques and
expression of the TAT1 13 polypeptide by the PC3-gD-MDP cells was confirmed
using standard FACS cell sorting,
ELISA and immunohistochemistry analyses. The ability of MMAE-conjugated
monoclonal antibody 12E5-
MMAE to cause the death of PC3-gD-MDP cells was determined using an in vitro
cell killing assay employing
the following protocol (Promega Corp. Technical Bulletin TB288; Mendoza et al
(2002) Cancer Res.
62:5485-5488):
1. An aliquot of 50 l of cell culture containing about 10' cells (either PC3-
gD-MDP cells or untransfected
PC3 cells which do not express TAT1 13) in growth medium is deposited in each
well of a 96-well, opaque-walled
plate. Additional control wells are set up which contain 50 l of growth
medium without cells.
2. Antibodies12E5-MMAE,oranMMAE-conjugatedanti-interleukin-
8monoclonalantibodythatdoesnot
bind to TAT113, is added to each well in a volume of 50 l and at various
concentrations ranging from 0.0001
to 100 g/ml and the plates are incubated at 37 C and 5% COZ for 3-5 days.
3. The plates are equilibrated to room temperature for approximately 30
minutes.
4. A volume of the Ce1lTiter-Glo Luminescent Cell Viability Reagent from
Promega Corp. equal to the
volume of cell culture medium present in each well is added and the plates are
shaken for 2 minutes on an orbital
shaker to induce cell lysis.
5. The plates are incubated at room temperature for 10 minutes to stabilize
the luminescence signal.
6. Luminescence is recorded on a luminometer with the Tropix Winglow
Programand reported as RLU =
relative luminescence units.
The results obtained from the above described assay demonstrate that the 12E5-
MMAE antibody is
capable of inducing the death of cells that express the TAT113 polypeptide in
an antibody-dependent fashion.
More specifically, neither 12E5-MMAE nor IL-8-MMAE induce significant death of
untransfected PC3 cells at
antibody concentrations of 1 g/rnl and below. At antibody concentrations
above 1 g/ml, the amount of
121


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
untransfected PC3 cell death increases linearly with antibody concentration
and does so in an antibody-independent
manner. Therefore, it appears that the death of untransfected PC3 cells at
antibody concentrations above 1 g/ml
is a non-specific result of the increasing levels of the MMAE toxin present in
the reaction mixture and is not a
function of the binding specificity of the antibody employed. With regard to
the PC3-gD-MDP cells that stably
express the TAT1 13 polypeptide, however, while IL-8-MMAE induces cell death
with a pattern that is identical
to that antibody's ability to kill untransfected PC3 ce11s,12E5-MMAE induces
significant cell killing at antibody
concentrations as low as 0.001 g/ml. In fact, at an antibody concentration of
1 g/ml (where the non-TAT1 13-
specific IL-8-MMAE antibody exhibits no significant cell killing), virtually
all of the PC3-gD-MDP cells are killed
by 12E5-MMAE. As such, these data demonstrate that monoclonal antibody 12E5
binds to the TAT113
polypeptide as it is expressed on the surface of cells and is capable of
inducing the death of those cells to which
it binds.
In a second experiment, the above described assay was employed to determine
the ability of monoclonal
antibody 12E5-MMAE to kill colon-cancer-derived COL0205 cells in vitro (cells
which Applicants have shown
by FACS cell sorting analysis express TAT1 13 polypeptide). Consistent with
the results presented above for the
PC3-derived cell lines, IL-8-MMAE does not begin to exhibit significant
COL0205 cell killing until above an
antibody concentration of about 1 g/ml, wherein the level of cell killing
increases linearly with antibody
concentration and in an antibody-independent manner. Monoclonal antibody 12E5-
MMAE, however, begins to
induce significant COL0205 cell death at antibody concentrations as low as
about 0.1 g/ml. In fact, at an
antibody concentration of 1 g/ml (where the non-TAT113-specific IL-8-MMAE
antibody exhibits no significant
cell killing), a very significant level of 12E5-MMAE-induced COL0205 cell
killing is observed. As such, these
data again demonstrate that monoclonal antibody 12E5 binds to the TAT 113
polypeptide as it is expressed on the
surface of cells and is capable of inducing the death of those cells to which
it binds.

EXAMPLE 10: In Vivo Tumor Cell Killing Assay
To test the efficacy of toxin-conjugated or unconjugated anti-TAT polypeptide
monoclonal antibodies
for the ability to induce the death of tumor cells in vivo, the following
protocol may be employed.
Inoculate a group of athymic nude nuce with 5 x 106 of the TAT polypeptide-
expressing tumor promoting
cells subcutaneously in the flank. When the tumors reach a mean tumor volume
of between 100-200 mm3, the mice
are grouped equally into 5 groups and are treated as follows:
Group 1 - PBS control vehicle administered once per week for 4 weeks;
Group 2 - non-specific control antibody administered at 1 mg/kg, once per week
for 4 weeks;
Group 3 - non-specific control antibody administered at 3 mg/kg, once per week
for 4 weeks;
Group 4 - specific anti-TAT polypeptide antibody administered at 1 mg/kg, once
per week for 4 weeks;
Group 5 - specific anti-TAT polypeptide antibody administered at 3 mg/kg, once
per week for 4 weeks.
Mean tumor volume may then be determined in the mice of each treatment group
at periodic intervals and the
efficacy of the antibodies determined.

122


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
EXAMPLE 11: Use of TAT as a hybridization probe
The following method describes use of a nucleotide sequence encoding TAT as a
hybridization probe for,
i.e., diagnosis of the presence of a tumor in a mammal.
DNA comprising the coding sequence of full-length or mature TAT as disclosed
herein can also be
employed as a probe to screen for homologous DNAs (such as those encoding
naturally-occurring variants of TAT)
in human tissue cDNA libraries or human tissue genomic libraries.
Hybridization and washing of filters containing either library DNAs is
performed under the following high
stringency conditions. Hybridization of radiolabeled TAT-derived probe to the
filters is performed in a solution
of 50% formamide, 5x SSC, 0.1% SDS, 0.1% sodium pyrophosphate, 50 mM sodium
phosphate, pH 6.8, 2x
Denhardt's solution, and 10% dextran sulfate at 42 C for 20 hours. Washing of
the filters is performed in an
aqueous solution of 0.1x SSC and 0.1% SDS at 42 C.
DNAs having a desired sequence identity with the DNA encoding full-length
native sequence TAT can
then be identified using standard techniques known in the art.

EXAMPLE 12: Expression of TAT in E. cali
This example illustrates preparation of an unglycosylated form of TAT by
recombinant expression in E.
coli.
The DNA sequence encoding TAT is initially amplified using selected PCR
primers. The primers should
contain restriction enzyme sites which correspond to the restriction enzyme
sites on the selected expression vector.
A variety of expression vectors may be employed. An example of a suitable
vector is pBR322 (derived from E.
coli=, see Bolivar et al., Gene, 2:95 (1977)) which contains genes for
ampicillin and tetracycline resistance. The
vector is digested with restriction enzyme and dephosphorylated. The PCR
amplified sequences are then ligated
into the vector. The vector will preferably include sequences which encode for
an antibiotic resistance gene, a trp
promoter, a polyhis leader (including the first six STII codons, polyhis
sequence, and enterokinase cleavage site),
the TAT coding region, lambda transcriptional terminator, and an argU gene.
The ligation mixture is then used to transform a selected E. coli strain using
the methods described in
Sambrook et al., supra. Transformants are identified by their ability to grow
on LB plates and antibiotic resistant
colonies are then selected. Plasmid DNA can be isolated and confirmed by
restriction analysis and DNA
sequencing.
Selected clones can be grown overnight in liquid culture medium such as LB
broth supplemented with
antibiotics. The overnight culture may subsequently be used to inoculate a
larger scale culture. The cells are then
grown to a desired optical density, during which the expression promoter is
turned on.
After culturing the cells for several more hours, the cells can be harvested
by centrifugation. The cell
pellet obtained by the centrifugation can be solubilized using various agents
known in the art, and the solubilized
TAT protein can then be purified using a metal chelating column under
conditions that allow tight binding of the
protein.
TAT may be expressed in E. coli in a poly-His tagged form, using the following
procedure. The DNA
encoding TAT is initially amplified using selected PCR primers. The primers
will contain restriction enzyme sites
which correspond to the restriction enzyme sites on the selected expression
vector, and other useful sequences
123


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
providing for efficient and reliable translation initiation, rapid
purification on a metal chelation column, and
proteolytic removal with enterokinase. The PCR-amplified, poly-His tagged
sequences are then ligated into an
expression vector, which is used to transform an E. coli host based on strain
52 (W3110 fuhA(tonA) lon galE
rpoHts(htpRts) c1pP(lacIq). Transformants are first grown in LB containing 50
mg/ml carbenicillin at 30 C with
shaking until an O.D.600 of 3-5 is reached. Cultures are then diluted 50-100
fold into CRAP media (prepared by
mixing 3.57 g(NH4)ZSO4, 0.71 g sodium citrate=2H20, 1.07 g KC1, 5.36 g Difco
yeast extract, 5.36 g Sheffield
hycase SF in 500 mL water, as well as 110 mM MPOS, pH 7.3, 0.55% (w/v) glucose
and 7 mM MgSO4) and
grown for approximately 20-30 hours at 30 C with shaking. Samples are removed
to verify expression by
SDS-PAGE analysis, and the bulk culture is centrifuged to pellet the cells.
Cell pellets are frozen until purification
and refolding.
E. coli paste from 0.5 to 1 L fermentations (6-10 g pellets) is resuspended in
10 volumes (w/v) in 7 M
guanidine, 20 mM Tris, pH 8 buffer. Solid sodium sulfite and sodium
tetrathionate is added to make final
concentrations of 0. 1M and 0.02 M, respectively, and the solution is stirred
overnight at 4 C. This step results in
a denatured protein with all cysteine residues blocked by sulfitolization. The
solution is centrifuged at 40,000 rpm
in a Beckman Ultracentifuge for 30 min. The supernatant is diluted with 3-5
volumes of metal chelate column
buffer (6 M guanidine, 20 mM Tris, pH 7.4) and filtered through 0.22 micron
filters to clarify. The clarified
extract is loaded onto a 5 ml QiagenNi-NTA metal chelate column equilibrated
in the metal chelate column buffer.
The column is washed with additional buffer containing 50 mM imidazole
(Calbiochem, Utrol grade), pH 7.4. The
protein is eluted with buffer containing 250 mM imidazole. Fractions
containing the desired protein are pooled
and stored at 4 C. Protein concentration is estimated by its absorbance at 280
nm using the calculated extinction
coefficient based on its amino acid sequence.
The proteins are refolded by diluting the sample slowly into freshly prepared
refolding buffer consisting
of: 20 mM Tris, pH 8.6, 0.3 M NaC1, 2.5 M urea, 5 mM cysteine, 20 n-ilvl
glycine and 1 mM EDTA. Refolding
volumes are chosen so that the final protein concentration is between 50 to
100 micrograms/ml. The refolding
solution is stirred gently at 4 C for 12-36 hours. The refolding reaction is
quenched by the addition of TFA to a
final concentration of 0.4% (pH of approximately 3). Before further
purification of the protein, the solution is
filtered through a 0.22 micron filter and acetonitrile is added to 2-10% final
concentration. The refolded protein
is chromatographed on a Poros Rl/H reversed phase column using a mobile buffer
of 0.1% TFA with elution with
a gradient of acetonitrile from 10 to 80%. Aliquots of fractions with A280
absorbance are analyzed on SDS
polyacrylamide gels and fractions containing homogeneous refolded protein are
pooled. Generally, the properly
refolded species of most proteins are eluted at the lowest concentrations of
acetonitrile since those species are the
most compact with their hydrophobic interiors shielded from interaction with
the reversed phase resin. Aggregated
species are usually eluted at higher acetonitrile concentrations. In addition
to resolving misfolded forms of proteins
from the desired form, the reversed phase step also removes endotoxin from the
samples.
Fractions containing the desired folded TAT polypeptide are pooled and the
acetonitrile removed using
a gentle stream of nitrogen directed at the solution. Proteins are formulated
into 20 mM Hepes, pH 6.8 with 0.14
M sodium chloride and 4% mannitol by dialysis or by gel filtration using G25
Superfine (Pharmacia) resins
equilibrated in the formulation buffer and sterile filtered.

124


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
EXAMPLE 13: Expression of TAT in mammalian cells
This example illustrates preparation of a potentially glycosylated form of TAT
by recombinant expression
in mammalian cells.
The vector, pRK5 (see EP 307,247, published March 15, 1989), is employed as
the expression vector.
Optionally, the TAT DNA is ligated into pRK5 with selected restriction enzymes
to allow insertion of the TAT
DNA using ligation methods such as described in Sambrook et al., sunr. The
resulting vector is called pRK5-
TAT.
In one embodiment, the selected host cells may be 293 cells. Human 293 cells
(ATCC CCL 1573) are
grown to confluence in tissue culture plates in medium such as DMEM
supplemented with fetal calf serum and
optionally, nutrient components and/or antibiotics. About 10 g pRK5-TAT DNA
is mixed with about 1 g DNA
encoding the VA RNA gene [Thimmappaya et al., Cell, 31:543 (1982)] and
dissolved in 500 1 of 1 mM Tris-HCI,
0.1 mM EDTA, 0.227 M CaC12. To this mixture is added, dropwise, 500 l of 50
mM HEPES (pH 7.35), 280 mM
NaCI, 1.5 mM NaPO4, and a precipitate is allowed to form for 10 minutes at 25
C. The precipitate is suspended
and added to the 293 cells and allowed to settle for about four hours at 37 C.
The culture medium is aspirated off
and 2 ml of 20% glycerol in PBS is added for 30 seconds. The 293 cells are
then washed with serum free medium,
fresh medium is added and the cells are incubated for about 5 days.
Approximately 24 hours after the transfections, the culture inedium is removed
and replaced with culture
medium (alone) or culture medium containing 200 Ci/m135S-cysteine and 200
Ci/m135S-methionine. After a
12 hour incubation, the conditioned medium is collected, concentrated on a
spin filter, and loaded onto a 15% SDS
gel. The processed gel may be dried and exposed to film for a selected period
of time to reveal the presence of
TAT polypeptide. The cultures containing transfected cells may undergo further
incubation (in serum free
medium) and the medium is tested in selected bioassays.
In an alternative technique, TAT may be introduced into 293 cells transiently
using the dextran sulfate
method described by Somparyrac et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., 12:7575 (1981).
293 cells are grown to maximal
density in a spinner flask and 700 g pRK5-TAT DNA is added. The cells are
first concentrated from the spinner
flask by centrifugation and washed with PBS. The DNA-dextran precipitate is
incubated on the cell pellet for four
hours. The cells are treated with 20% glycerol for 90 seconds, washed with
tissue culture medium, and re-
introduced into the spinner flask containing tissue culture medium, 5 g/ml
bovine insulin and 0.1 g/ml bovine
transferrin. After about four days, the conditioned media is centrifuged and
filtered to remove cells and debris.
The sample containing expressed TAT can then be concentrated and purified by
any selected method, such as
dialysis and/or column chromatography.
In another embodiment, TAT can be expressed in CHO cells. The pRK5-TAT can be
transfected into
CHO cells using known reagents such as CaPOa or DEAE-dextran. As described
above, the cell cultures can be
incubated, and the medium replaced with culture medium (alone) or medium
containing a radiolabel such as 35S-
methionine. After determining the presence of TAT polypeptide, the culture
medium may be replaced with serum
free medium. Preferably, the cultures are incubated for about 6 days, and then
the conditioned medium is
harvested. The medium containing the expressed TAT can then be concentrated
and purified by any selected
method.

125


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Epitope-tagged TAT may also be expressed in host CHO cells. The TAT may be
subcloned out of the
pRK5 vector. The subclone insert can undergo PCR to fuse in frame with a
selected epitope tag such as a poly-his
tag into a Baculovirus expression vector. The poly-his tagged TAT insert can
then be subcloned into a SV40
driven vector containing a selection marker such as DHFR for selection of
stable clones. Finally, the CHO cells
can be transfected (as described above) with the SV40 driven vector. Labeling
may be performed, as described
above, to verify expression. The culture medium containing the expressed poly-
His tagged TAT can then be
concentrated and purified by any selected method, such as by NiZ+-chelate
affinity chromatography.
TAT may also be expressed in CHO and/or COS cells by a transient expression
procedure or in CHO cells
by another stable expression procedure.
Stable expression in CHO cells is performed using the following procedure. The
proteins are expressed
as an IgG construct (immunoadhesin), in which the coding sequences for the
soluble forms (e.g. extracellular
domains) of the respective proteins are fused to an IgGl constant region
sequence containing the hinge, CH2 and
CH2 domains and/or is a poly-His tagged form.
Following PCR amplification, the respective DNAs are subcloned in a CHO
expression vector using
standard techniques as described in Ausubel et al., Current Protocols of
Molecular BioloUnit 3.16, John Wiley
and Sons (1997). CHO expression vectors are constructed to have compatible
restriction sites 5' and 3' of the
DNA of interest to allow the convenient shuttling of eDNA's. The vector used
expression in CHO cells is as
described in Lucas et al., NucL Acids Res. 24:9 (1774-1779 (1996), and uses
the SV40 early promoter/enhancer
to drive expression of the cDNA of interest and dihydrofolate reductase
(DHFR). DHFR expression permits
selection for stable maintenance of the plasmid following transfection.
Twelve micrograms of the desired plasmid DNA is introduced into approximately
10 million CHO cells
using commercially available transfection reagents SUPERFECTt (Quiagen),
DOSPER or FUGENE
(Boehringer Mannheim). The cells are grown as described in Lucas et al., sunr.
Approximately 3 x 1W cells are
frozen in an ampule for further growth and production as described below.
The ampules containing the plasmid DNA are thawed by placement into water bath
and mixed by
vortexing. The contents are pipetted into a centrifuge tube containing 10 mLs
of media and centrifuged at 1000
rpm for 5 minutes. The supernatant is aspirated and the cells are resuspended
in 10 mL of selective media (0.2
m filtered PS20 with 5% 0.2 m diafiltered fetal bovine serum). The cells are
then aliquoted into a 100 niL
spinner containing 90 niL, of selective media. After 1-2 days, the cells are
transferred into a 250 niL spinner filled
with 150 mL selective growth medium and incubated at 37 C. After another 2-3
days, 250 mL, 500 mL and 2000
mL spinners are seeded with 3 x 105 cells/mL. The cell media is exchanged with
fresh media by centrifugation
and resuspension in production medium. Although any suitable CHO media may be
employed, a production
medium described in U.S. Patent No. 5,122,469, issued June 16, 1992 may
actually be used. A 3L production
spinner is seeded at 1.2 x 106 cells/mL. On day 0, the cell number pH ie
determined. On day 1, the spinner is
sampled and sparging with filtered air is commenced. On day 2, the spinner is
sampled, the temperature shifted
to 33 C, and 30 mL of 500 g/L glucose and 0.6 mL of 10% antifoam (e.g., 35%
polydimethylsiloxane emulsion,
Dow Corning 365 Medical Grade Emulsion) taken. Throughout the production, the
pH is adjusted as necessary
to keep it at around 7.2. After 10 days, or until the viability dropped below
70%, the cell culture is harvested by
centrifugation and filtering through a 0.22 m filter. The filtrate was either
stored at 4 C or immediately loaded
126


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
onto columns for purification.
For the poly-His tagged constructs, the proteins are purified using a Ni-NTA
column (Qiagen). Before
purification, imidazole is added to the conditioned media to a concentration
of 5 mM. The conditioned media is
pumped onto a 6 n-d Ni-NTA column equilibrated in 20 mM Hepes, pH 7.4, buffer
containing 0.3 M NaCl and 5
mM imidazole at a flow rate of 4-5 ml/min. at 4 C. After loading, the column
is washed with additional
equilibration buffer and the protein eluted with equilibration buffer
containing 0.25 M imidazole. The highly
purified protein is subsequently desalted into a storage buffer containing 10
mM Hepes, 0.14 M NaCl and 4%
mannitol, pH 6.8, with a 25 ml G25 Superfine (Pharmacia) column and stored at -
80 C.
Immunoadhesin (Fc-containing) constructs are purified from the conditioned
media as follows.. The
conditioned medium is pumped onto a 5 ml Protein A column (Pharmacia) which
had been equilibrated in 20 mM
Na phosphate buffer, pH 6.8. After loading, the column is washed extensively
with equilibration buffer before
elution with 100 mM citric acid, pH 3.5. The eluted protein is immediately
neutralized by collecting 1 ml fractions
into tubes containing 275 L of 1 M Tris buffer, pH 9. The highly purified
protein is subsequently desalted into
storage buffer as described above for the poly-His tagged proteins. The
homogeneity is assessed by SDS
polyacrylamide gels and by N-terminal amino acid sequencing by Edman
degradation.
EXAMPLE 14: Expression of TAT in Yeast
The following method describes recombinant expression of TAT in yeast.
First, yeast expression vectors are constructed for intracellular production
or secretion of TAT from the
ADH2/GAPDH promoter. DNA encoding TAT and the promoter is inserted into
suitable restriction enzyme sites
in the selected plasmid to direct intracellular expression of TAT. For
secretion, DNA encoding TAT can be cloned
into the selected plasmid, together with DNA encoding the ADH2/GAPDH promoter,
a native TAT signal peptide
or other mammalian signal peptide, or, for example, a yeast alpha-factor or
invertase secretory signal/leader
sequence, and linker sequences (if needed) for expression of TAT.
Yeast cells, such as yeast strain AB 110, can ttien be transformed with the
expression plasmids described
above and cultured in selected fermentation media. The transformed yeast
supernatants can be analyzed by
precipitation with 10% trichloroacetic acid and separation by SDS-PAGE,
followed by staining of the gels with
Coomassie Blue stain.
Recombinant TAT can subsequently be isolated and purified by removing the
yeast cells from the
fermentation medium by centrifugation and then concentrating the medium using
selected cartridge filters. The
concentrate containing TAT may further be purified using selected column
chromatography resins.

EXAMPLE 15: Expression of TAT in Baculovirus-Infected Insect Cells
The following method describes recombinant expression of TAT in Baculovirus-
infected insect cells.
The sequence coding for TAT is fused upstream of an epitope tag contained
within a baculovirus
expression vector. Such epitope tags include poly-his tags and immunoglobulin
tags (like Fc regions of IgG). A
variety of plasmids may be employed, including plasmids derived from
commercially available plasmids such as
pVL1393 (Novagen). Briefly, the sequence encoding TAT or the desired portion
of the coding sequence of TAT
such as the sequence encoding an extracellular domain of a transmembrane
protein or the sequence encoding the
127


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
mature protein if the protein is extracellular is amplified by PCR with
primers complementary to the 5' and 3'
regions. The 5' primer may incorporate flanking (selected) restriction enzyme
sites. The product is then digested
with those selected restriction enzymes and subcloned into the expression
vector.
Recombinant baculovirus is generated by co-transfecting the above plasniid and
BACULOGOLD' virus
DNA (Pharmingen) into Spodoptera fi=ugiperda ("Sf9") cells (ATCC CRL 1711)
using lipofectin (commercially
available from GIBCO-BRL). After 4- 5 days of incubation at 28 C, the released
viruses are harvested and used
for further amplifications. Viral infection and protein expression are
performed as described by O'Reilley et al.,
Baculovirus expression vectors: A Laboratory Manual, Oxford: Oxford University
Press (1994).
Expressed poly-his tagged TAT can then be purified, for example, by Ni2-
chelate affinity
chromatography as follows. Extracts are prepared from recombinant virus-
infected Sf9 cells as described by
Rupert et al., Nature, 362:175-179 (1993). Briefly, Sf9 cells are washed,
resuspended in sonication buffer (25 mL
Hepes, pH 7.9; 12.5 mM MgCIZ; 0.1 mM EDTA; 10% glycerol; 0.1% NP-40; 0.4 M
KCl), and sonicated twice
for 20 seconds on ice. The sonicates are cleared by centrifugation, and the
supernatant is diluted 50-fold in loading
buffer (50 mM phosphate, 300 mM NaC1, 10% glycerol, pH 7.8) and filtered
through a 0.45 m filter. A Ni2+-
NTA agarose column (commercially available from Qiagen) is prepared with a bed
volume of 5 mL, washed with
25 mL of water and equilibrated with 25 mL of loading buffer. The filtered
cell extract is loaded onto the column
at 0.5 mL per minute. The column is washed to baseline AZgo with loading
buffer, at which point fraction collection
is started. Next, the column is washed with a secondary wash buffer (50 mM
phosphate; 300 mM NaCI, 10%
glycerol, pH 6.0), which elutes nonspecifically bound protein. After reaching
AZ$o baseline again, the column is
developed with a 0 to 500 mM Imidazole gradient in the secondary wash buffer.
One mL fractions are collected
and analyzed by SDS-PAGE and silver staining or Western blot with NiZ+-NTA-
conjugated to alkaline phosphatase
(Qiagen). Fractions containing the eluted Hislo tagged TAT are pooled and
dialyzed against loading buffer.
Alternatively, purification of the IgG tagged (or Fc tagged) TAT can be
performed using known
chromatography techniques, including for instance, Protein A or protein G
column chromatography.
EXAMPLE 16: Purification of TAT Polypeptides Using Specific Antibodies
Native or recombinant TAT polypeptides may be purified by a variety of
standard techniques in the art
of protein purification. For example, pro-TAT polypeptide, mature TAT
polypeptide, or pre-TAT polypeptide
is purified by immunoaffinity chromatography using antibodies specific for the
TAT polypeptide of interest. In
general, an immunoaffinity column is constructed by covalently coupling the
anti-TAT polypeptide antibody to
an activated chromatographic resin.
Polyclonal immunoglobulins are prepared from immune sera either by
precipitation with ammonium
sulfate or by purification on immobilized Protein A (Pharmacia LKB
Biotechnology, Piscataway, N.J.). Likewise,
monoclonal antibodies are prepared from mouse ascites fluid by ammonium
sulfate precipitation or
chromatography on immobilized Protein A. Partially purified immunoglobulin is
covalently attached to a
chromatographic resin such as CnBr-activated SEPHAROSETM (Pharmacia LKB
Biotechnology). The antibody
is coupled to the resin, the resin is blocked, and the derivative resin is
washed according to the manufacturer's
instructions.

128


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
Such an immunoaffinity column is utilized in the purification of TAT
polypeptide by preparing a fraction
from cells containing TAT polypeptide in a soluble form. This preparation is
derived by solubilization of the whole
cell or of a subcellular fraction obtained via differential centrifugation by
the addition of detergent or by other
methods well known in the art. Alternatively, soluble TAT polypeptide
containing a signal sequence may be
secreted in useful quantity into the medium in which the cells are grown.
A soluble TAT polypeptide-containing preparation is passed over the
immunoaffinity column, and the
column is washed under conditions that allow the preferential absorbance of
TAT polypeptide (e.g., high ionic
strength buffers in the presence of detergent). Then, the column is eluted
under conditions that disrupt
antibody/TAT polypeptide binding (e.g., a low pH buffer such as approximately
pH 2-3, or a high concentration
of a chaotrope such as urea or thiocyanate ion), and TAT polypeptide is
collected.
Deposit of Material
The following materials have been deposited with the American Type Culture
Collection, 10801
University Blvd., Manassas, VA 20110-2209, USA (ATCC):

Table 7
Material ATCC Dep. No. Deposit Date
Hybridoma cell line 12E5. 1.1 PTA-6625 March 3, 2005
Hybridoma cell line 6G10.1.1 PTA-6623 March 3, 2005

These deposits were made under the provisions of the Budapest Treaty on the
International Recognition
of the Deposit of Microorganisms for the Purpose of Patent Procedure and the
Regulations thereunder (Budapest
Treaty). This assures maintenance of a viable culture of the deposit for 30
years from the date of deposit. The
deposits will be made available by ATCC under the terms of the Budapest
Treaty, and subject to an agreement
between Genentech, Inc. and ATCC, which assures permanent and unrestricted
availability of the progeny of the
culture of the deposit to the public upon issuance of the pertinent U.S.
patent or upon laying open to the public of
any U.S. or foreign patent application, whichever comes first, and assures
availability of the progeny to one
determined by the U.S. Commissioner of Patents and Trademarks to be entitled
thereto according to 35 USC 122
and the Commissioner's rules pursuant thereto (including 37 CFR 1.14 with
particular reference to 886 OG 638).
The assignee of the present application has agreed that if a culture of the
materials on deposit should die
or be lost or destroyed when cultivated under suitable conditions, the
materials will be promptly replaced on
notification with another of the same. Availability of the deposited material
is not to be construed as a license to
practice the invention in contravention of the rights granted under the
authority of any government in accordance
with its patent laws.
The foregoing written specification is considered to be sufficient to enable
one skilled in the art to practice
the invention. The present invention is not to be limited in scope by the
construct deposited, since the deposited
embodiment is intended as a single illustration of certain aspects of the
invention and any constructs that are
functionally equivalent are within the scope of this invention. The deposit of
material herein does not constitute
an admission that the written description herein contained is inadequate to
enable the practice of any aspect of the
invention, including the best mode thereof, nor is it to be construed as
limiting the scope of the claims to the
specific illustrations that it represents. Indeed, various modifications of
the invention in addition to those shown
129


CA 02604377 2007-10-05
WO 2006/110760 PCT/US2006/013501
and described herein will become apparent to those skilled in the art from the
foregoing description and fall within
the scope of the appended claims.

130

Representative Drawing
A single figure which represents the drawing illustrating the invention.
Administrative Status

For a clearer understanding of the status of the application/patent presented on this page, the site Disclaimer , as well as the definitions for Patent , Administrative Status , Maintenance Fee  and Payment History  should be consulted.

Administrative Status

Title Date
Forecasted Issue Date Unavailable
(86) PCT Filing Date 2006-04-05
(87) PCT Publication Date 2006-10-19
(85) National Entry 2007-10-05
Dead Application 2011-04-05

Abandonment History

Abandonment Date Reason Reinstatement Date
2010-04-06 FAILURE TO PAY APPLICATION MAINTENANCE FEE

Payment History

Fee Type Anniversary Year Due Date Amount Paid Paid Date
Registration of a document - section 124 $100.00 2007-10-05
Application Fee $400.00 2007-10-05
Maintenance Fee - Application - New Act 2 2008-04-07 $100.00 2007-10-05
Maintenance Fee - Application - New Act 3 2009-04-06 $100.00 2009-03-11
Owners on Record

Note: Records showing the ownership history in alphabetical order.

Current Owners on Record
GENENTECH, INC.
Past Owners on Record
DOWD, PATRICK
FRANTZ, GRETCHEN
POLAKIS, PAUL
SMITH, VICTORIA
SPENCER, SUSAN
WU, THOMAS
ZHANG, ZEMIN
Past Owners that do not appear in the "Owners on Record" listing will appear in other documentation within the application.
Documents

To view selected files, please enter reCAPTCHA code :



To view images, click a link in the Document Description column. To download the documents, select one or more checkboxes in the first column and then click the "Download Selected in PDF format (Zip Archive)" or the "Download Selected as Single PDF" button.

List of published and non-published patent-specific documents on the CPD .

If you have any difficulty accessing content, you can call the Client Service Centre at 1-866-997-1936 or send them an e-mail at CIPO Client Service Centre.


Document
Description 
Date
(yyyy-mm-dd) 
Number of pages   Size of Image (KB) 
Abstract 2007-10-05 2 73
Claims 2007-10-05 1 24
Drawings 2007-10-05 2 78
Description 2007-10-05 130 8,614
Representative Drawing 2008-01-07 1 16
Cover Page 2008-01-07 1 44
PCT 2007-10-05 5 208
Assignment 2007-10-05 8 250
Prosecution-Amendment 2007-10-05 6 150

Biological Sequence Listings

Choose a BSL submission then click the "Download BSL" button to download the file.

If you have any difficulty accessing content, you can call the Client Service Centre at 1-866-997-1936 or send them an e-mail at CIPO Client Service Centre.

Please note that files with extensions .pep and .seq that were created by CIPO as working files might be incomplete and are not to be considered official communication.

BSL Files

To view selected files, please enter reCAPTCHA code :